Korg MicroArranger Owners Manual
Korg MicroArranger Owners Manual
Korg MicroArranger Owners Manual
E 1
PRECAUTIONS
LOCATION
Usingtheunitinthefollowinglocationscanresultina
malfunction.
Indirectsunlight
Locationsofextremetemperatureorhumidity
Excessivelydustyordirtylocations
Locationsofexcessivevibration
Closetomagneticfields
POWER SUPPLY
Please connect the designated AC adapter to an AC
outletofthecorrectvoltage.DonotconnectittoanAC
outletofvoltageotherthanthatforwhichyourunitis
intended.
HANDLING
Toavoidbreakage,donotapplyexcessiveforcetothe
switchesorcontrols.
CARE
Iftheexteriorbecomesdirty,wipeitwithaclean,dry
cloth. Do not use liquid cleaners such as benzene or
thinner,orcleaningcompoundsorflammablepolishes.
DATA HANDLING
Datastoredinmemorymayoccasionallybelostdueto
incorrect user action. Be sure to save your important
datatoamemorycard.KORGwillnotberesponsible
fordamagescausedbydataloss.
LCD DISPLAY
Some pages of the manuals show LCD screens along
withanexplanationofoperationandfunctionality.All
soundnames,parameternames,andvaluesaremerely
examplesandmaynotalwaysmatchtheactualdisplay
thatyouareworkingon.
TRADEMARKS
Mac,theMaclogoandtheAudioUnitslogoaretrade
marks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other
countries.
MSDOS and Windows are registered trademarks of
MicrosoftCorporation,registeredintheU.S.andother
countries.
Allproductnamesandcompanynamesarethetrade
marks or registered trademarks of their respective
owners.
HOW TO
Keyboard
select a Sound Program
select a Performance
play a Sound Program across the
whole keyboard, as with a piano
split the keyboard in two
add sounds to the right hand
mute/unmute sounds
Style Play mode
select a Style
start/stop the Style
select a Fill or a Break
select a Style Variation
see the Style tracks
create a new Style
25
25
24
24
24
24
26
27
27
27
41
52
31
74
73
18, 80
82
Song mode
record a new Song
edit a Standard MIDI File
90
88
In general
turn the speakers off
change the Damper polarity
select the Arabic Scale
125
126
34
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Introduction
Welcome! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Usefullinks .................................... 8
Aboutthismanual .............................. 9
Loadingtheoperatingsystem .................... 9
ReloadingtheFactoryData...................... 9
Start up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
ConnectingtheACpoweradapter ............... 10
Turningtheinstrumentonandoff ............... 10
ControllingtheVolume ........................ 10
TheBALANCEslider.......................... 10
Headphones.................................. 10
AudioOutputs ................................ 11
AudioInputs ................................. 11
MIDIconnections.............................. 11
DamperPedal................................. 11
Demo ........................................ 11
Themusicstand ............................... 11
Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Display and User Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Displaycontrols ............................... 19
Interfacestructure............................. 20
Messagewindows ............................. 21
SymbolsandIcons ............................. 21
Grayedoutnonavailableparameters............ 21
Rear panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Basic Guide
Basic operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Playingonthekeyboard........................ 24
Selecting,muting/unmutingandsoloingatrack... 24
SelectingaPerformance........................ 25
SelectingaProgram............................ 25
SelectingaStyle............................... 26
SelectingaSingleTouchSetting(STS)............ 26
Changingallkeyboardtracksatonce............. 26
Shortcuttoseetheoriginalbank
foraStyle,PerformanceorProgram ............ 26
Tutorial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
PlayingaStyle
(AutomaticAccompaniment) .................. 27
PlayinginRealtime
(WithoutusingAutomaticAccompaniment) .... 28
RecordingaSong
(Simultaneouslyrecording
theStyleandrealtimeperformance) ............ 30
PlayingaSongfromacard ..................... 31
EditingaSong ................................ 32
TheArabicScale............................... 34
MIDI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
WhatisMIDI?................................. 35
Midifiles...................................... 35
TheGeneralMIDIstandard ..................... 35
TheGlobalchannel ............................. 35
TheChord1andChord2channels............... 36
TheControlchannel ............................ 36
MIDISetup.................................... 36
Connecting
microARRANGERtoaMasterkeyboard ........ 36
Connecting
themicroARRANGERtoaMIDIaccordion...... 37
Connecting
themicroARRANGERtoanexternalsequencer .. 37
Playinganotherinstrument
withthemicroARRANGER .................... 38
Reference Guide
Style Play operating mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
WhatsaStyle?................................. 40
StylesandPerformances ........................ 40
ChangingandresettingtheTempo............... 40
TheDIRECTSDbank ........................... 40
Mainpage..................................... 41
Styletrackspage............................... 41
HowtoselectPrograms ......................... 41
TheWritewindow ............................. 42
Menu ......................................... 42
Editpagestructure............................. 42
Page1Mixer:Volume ......................... 43
Page2Mixer:Pan ............................. 43
Page3Mixer:FXSend ......................... 43
Page4Tuning:Detune......................... 44
Page5Tuning:Scale........................... 44
Page6Tuning:PitchBendSensitivity ............ 44
Page7FX:A/BSelect.......................... 44
Page8FX:C/DSelect .......................... 45
Page9FX:Aediting ........................... 45
Page10FX:Bediting.......................... 45
Page11FX:Cediting .......................... 45
Page12FX:Dediting .......................... 45
Page13Track:Easyedit ....................... 45
Page14Track:Mode .......................... 46
Page15Track:Internal/External................. 47
Page16R.T.controls:Damper.................. 47
Page17R.T.controls:Joystick .................. 47
Page18R.T.controls:Dynamicrange ............ 48
Page19R.T.controls:Ensemble ................. 48
Page20Stylecontrols:Drum/Fill ................ 49
Page21Stylecontrols:
WrapAround/KeyboardRange ............... 49
Page22Pads ................................. 50
Page23Preferences:Lock...................... 50
Page24Preferences:controls ................... 51
5
Style Record mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
TheStylesstructure............................52
StyleImport/Export ............................53
EnteringtheRecordmode ......................53
ListeningtotheStylewhileinRecord/Editmode...53
ExitandSave/AbortStyle .......................54
TheWritewindow .............................54
Listofrecordedevents .........................54
FastDeleteusingthecontrolpanelbuttons ........54
Mainpage ....................................55
StyleTrackspage..............................56
StepRecordpage ..............................57
StyleRecordprocedure .........................58
Menu ........................................61
Editpagestructure .............................61
Page1Edit:Quantize .........................62
Page2Edit:Transpose ........................62
Page3Edit:Velocity ..........................63
Page4EventEdit .............................63
Page5EventFilter ............................64
EventEditprocedure ...........................65
Page6Edit:Delete ............................66
Page7Edit:DeleteAll.........................67
Page8Edit:Copy .............................67
Page9StyleElementControls:Programs ........68
Page10StyleElementControls:Expression......68
Page11StyleElementControls:KeyboardRange.68
Page12StyleElementControls:
ChordVariationTable........................69
Page13StyleControls:Mode/Tension ...........69
Song Play operating mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
TheSongsandtheStandardMIDIFileformat .....70
Transportcontrols .............................70
MIDIClock ...................................70
Switchingbetweensequencersduringediting .....70
SelectingaSongcomposingitsprogressivenumber70
Realtimeandsequencertracks ...................70
MasterVolume,SequencerVolume,BALANCE ...71
EffectsinSongPlaymode.......................71
GrooveQuantizewindow.......................71
TheWritewindow .............................72
Mainpage ....................................73
Tracks18page................................73
Tracks916page...............................74
SongSelectpage ...............................74
TheLyricspage................................74
PlayingaJukeboxfile ..........................74
Menu ........................................75
Editpagestructure .............................75
Page1Mixer:Volume .........................76
Page2Mixer:Pan.............................76
Page3Mixer:FXsendA/B .....................76
Page3Mixer:FXsendC/D .....................77
Page4FX:A/BSelect ..........................77
Page4FX:C/DSelect..........................77
Page5FX:Aediting ..........................78
Page6FX:Bediting ...........................78
Page5FX:Cediting...........................78
Page6FX:Dediting ..........................78
Page7Track:Mode...........................78
Page8Track:Internal/External ................. 79
Page9Jukebox ............................... 79
Page10Preferences ........................... 80
SavingalistofSongs........................... 81
Backing Sequence operating mode . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Transportcontrols ............................. 82
TheBackingSequence,SongandSongPlaymodes. 82
HowtoplaybackaSong ........................ 82
RealtimeRecordingmode ...................... 82
Chord/AccSteprecording ...................... 83
MainPage(BackingSequencePlay) .............. 83
LoadSongpage............................... 84
SaveSongpage................................ 84
RealtimeRecordingpage....................... 85
Chord/AccStepRecordingpage ................. 85
HowtodeleteawholeSong .................... 87
Song operating mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Transportcontrols ............................. 88
MasterVolumeandSequencerVolume........... 88
TheSongsandtheStandardMIDIFileformat ..... 88
Fasttrackdeletion............................. 88
HowtodeleteawholeSong .................... 88
Mainpage .................................... 88
Tracks18page ............................... 89
Tracks916page .............................. 89
SongSelectpage............................... 89
SaveSongpage................................ 90
RealtimeRecordprocedure..................... 90
StepRecordprocedure......................... 91
SongRecordpage ............................. 92
StepRecordpage .............................. 93
Menu........................................ 94
Editpagestructure ............................ 94
Page1Mixer:Volume......................... 95
Page2Mixer:Pan ............................ 95
Page3Mixer:FXBlock ........................ 95
Page4Mixer:FXSendA/B(orC/D)............. 96
Page5Tuning:Detune ........................ 96
Page6Tuning:Scale .......................... 96
Page7Tuning:PitchBend/Scale ................ 97
Page8FX:A/BSelect ......................... 97
Page9FX:C/DSelect ......................... 97
Page10FX:Aediting......................... 98
Page11FX:Bediting ......................... 98
Page12FX:Cediting ......................... 98
Page13FX:Dediting......................... 98
Page14Track:Easyedit ....................... 98
Page15Track:Mode .......................... 99
Page16Track:Internal/External ................ 99
Page17Edit:Quantize....................... 100
Page18Edit:Transpose...................... 100
Page19Edit:Velocity ........................ 100
Page20Edit:Delete.......................... 101
Page21Edit:CutMeasures ................... 101
Page22Edit:InsertMeasures................. 101
Page23Edit:Copy .......................... 102
Page24EventEdit........................... 102
Page25EventFilter.......................... 103
EventEditprocedure ......................... 104
6
Program operating mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Mainpage ................................... 105
SoundProgramsandDrumPrograms........... 105
Menu....................................... 105
Editpagestructure ........................... 106
TheComparefunction ........................ 106
Howtoselectoscillators ....................... 106
EraseProgram/Oscillator...................... 106
TheWritewindow .......................... 106
Page1Basic ................................ 107
Page2Sample(SoundPrograms).............. 107
Page2DKSamples(DrumPrograms) .......... 108
Page3Pitch ................................ 109
Page4PitchLFO1 ........................... 110
Page5PitchLFO2 ........................... 111
Page6PitchEG............................. 111
Page7Filter................................ 112
Page8FilterModulation ..................... 113
Page9FilterLFO1 ........................... 114
Page10FilterLFO2 .......................... 115
Page11FilterEG ............................ 115
Page12Amp ............................... 117
Page13AmpModulation .................... 117
Page14AmpLFO1 .......................... 118
Page15AmpLFO2 .......................... 118
Page16AmpEG............................ 118
Page17LFO1 ............................... 120
Page18LFO2 ............................... 122
Page19Effects .............................. 122
Page20FX1editing.......................... 122
Page21FX2editing.......................... 122
AMS(AlternateModulationSource)list......... 123
Global edit environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
TheWritewindow............................ 125
Menu....................................... 125
Page1Generalcontrols ...................... 125
Page2MasterTranspose..................... 126
Page3Assignable
Pedal/Footswitch,AssignableSlider ........... 126
Page4MIDISetup........................... 126
Page5MIDIControls ........................ 127
Page6MIDIINChannels .................... 127
Page7MIDIINControls(1) .................. 128
Page8MIDIINControls(2) .................. 128
Page9MIDIINFilters ....................... 129
Page10MIDIOUTChannels ................. 129
Page11MIDIOUTFilters .................... 129
Card Edit environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
TheWRITE/CARDINUSELED ................ 130
Supportedcards.............................. 130
LoadingdatacreatedwiththePa80/Pa60/Pa50 ... 131
Cardstructure ............................... 131
Filetypes .................................... 131
Fileandfoldersizedisplay .................... 132
Appendix
Factory Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Styles ........................................ 144
StyleElements................................ 146
SingleTouchSettings(STS) ..................... 146
Programs(bankorder) ......................... 147
Programs(ProgramChangeorder).............. 154
DrumKits.................................... 160
DrumKitinstruments ......................... 161
Performances ................................. 173
MIDISetup................................... 174
Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Diagrams .................................... 175
DynamicModulationsources ................... 175
Filter/Dynamic................................ 175
Pitch/PhaseMod. ............................. 185
Mod./P.Shift .................................. 195
ER/Delay..................................... 202
Reverb ....................................... 208
MonoMonoChain........................... 209
Assignable parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
ListoffunctionsassignabletotheFootswitch ..... 225
Listoffunctionsassignable
tothePedalorAssignableSlider .............. 226
ListofsoundsassignabletothePads............. 226
ListoffunctionsassignabletothePads........... 227
Scales........................................ 227
MIDI Controllers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
MIDIImplementationChart .................... 229
Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
Recognized chords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Error messages & Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . 235
Errormessages ............................... 235
Troubleshooting .............................. 238
Technical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Alphabetical Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
INTRODUCTION
Welcome!
Useful links
1. WELCOME!
ThankyouforpurchasingtheKorgProfessional
ArrangermicroARRANGER.
Thisinstrumentisanidealkeyboardforsongproduc
tionitletsyouselectadesiredmusicalstyleandgen
erate a highquality band accompaniment simply by
playing chords, and then you can play the melody
yourselftoeasilycreateanoriginalsong.
Herearesomeofthefeaturesofyournewinstrument:
PowerfulHI(HyperIntegrated)KORGsoundgen
eration system, as seen in our best professional
synthesizers.
OPOS(ObjectivePortableOperatingSystem)mul
titasking operating system, to let you load data
whileplayingyourinstrument.
Operating System updates, to load new features
fromcard.Dontletyourinstrumentgetold!
Solid State Disk (SSD), for any system updatea
smartwaytoreplacetheusualROMmemory.
SDcardslot,capableofreadingandwritingonSD
andMMCmemorytypes.
DirectStyleaccessfromSDcard.
GeneralMIDILevel2Soundscompatible.
Morethan662SoundPrograms.
4multieffectprocessor,eachwith89effecttypes.
160Performancesand1,216SingleTouchSettings
(STS), for fast setting of keyboard sounds and
effects.
304Styles.
XDSDoubleSequencerwithCrossfader.
StyleRecordandEdit
Fullfeaturedsequencer(SongRecordandEdit)
Integrated speakers, for the most true sound
reproduction.
WideCustomDisplay.
USEFUL LINKS
YourpreferredKORGdealeralsocarriesawiderange
ofKorghardwareandsoftwareaccessories.Pleaseask
your dealer about additional Programs, Styles, and
otherusefulmusicmaterials.
Each KORG distributor can supply you with useful
information.Justgivehimacallforadditionalservices.
In the Englishspeaking world, here are the relevant
addresses:
USA
KORGUSA,316SouthServiceRoad,Mel
ville,NewYork,11747,USA
Tel:15163339100,Fax:15163339108
UK
KORGUKLtd,1HarrisonClose,Knowl
hill,MiltonKeynes,MK5,8PA,UK
Tel:01908304600,Fax:01908304699
UKTechnicalSupport
Tel:01908304637
Email:[email protected]
Many KORG distributors also have their own web
pageontheinternet,whereyoucanfindinfosandsoft
ware.UsefulwebpagesinEnglisharethefollowing:
http://www.korg.com/
http://www.korg.co.uk/
Aplacetofindoperatingsystemupdatesandvarious
system files (for example, a full backup of the factory
data)isatthefollowinglink:
http://www.korgpa.com/
Welcome!
About this manual
Thismanualisdividedinthreesections:
A Basic Guide, containing an overview of the
instrument, as well as a series of practical guides
(namedTutorials).
AReferenceGuide,witheachpageandparame
terdescribedindetail.
AnAppendix,withalistofdataandusefulinfor
mationfortheadvanceduser.
Withinthemanual,youwillfindthefollowingabbrevi
ations:
TheparametercanbesavedontoaPerfor
mancebypressingtheWRITEbutton.
Theparametercanbesavedontothecur
rent Style Performance by pressing the
WRITEbutton.
TheparametercanbesavedontoaSingle
TouchSettingbypressingtheWRITEbut
ton.
TheparametercanbesavedontoaGlobal
setting by going to the Global environ
ment (see Global edit environment on
page125)andpressingtheWRITEbutton.
10
Start up
Connecting the AC power adapter
2. START UP
CONNECTING THE AC POWER ADAPTER
UsetheMASTERVOLUME
slider to control the overall
volume of the instrument.
This slider controls the
volume of the sound going
totheinternalspeakers,the
L/MONO & RIGHT OUT
PUTS, and the HEADPHO
NESconnector.
Note: Start at a moderate level, then raise the MASTER
VOLUME up. Dont keep the volume at an uncomfortable
levelfortoolong.
UsetheACC/SEQVOLUMEslidertocontroltheStyle
tracks (drums, percussion, bass) volume. This slider
also controls both of the Sequencers tracks, excluding
theRealtime(Keyboard)tracks.
Bydefault,youcanusetheASSIGN.SLIDERtocontrol
thekeyboardtracksvolume.Thissliderisuserassigna
ble,butissettotheKeyboardExpressionparameterby
default.
HEADPHONES
Youcanconnectapairofheadphonestotherearpanel
headphone jack (PHONES: stereo minijack). You can
use headphones with an impedance of 16200 (50
recommended). Use a headphone distributor to con
nectmorethanonepairofheadphones.
Start up
11
Audio Outputs
AUDIO OUTPUTS
DAMPER PEDAL
AUDIO INPUTS
Youcanconnecttheoutputofanotherelectronicmusi
cal instrument, an unpowered mixer, or any audio
devicetotherearpanelinputjack(INPUT:stereomini
jack).Sincethisisalinelevelinput,youllneedtousea
separatelysoldmicpreampormixerifyoureconnect
ingamic.
Usetheconnecteddevicesvolumecontroltoadjustthe
inputlevel.Becarefulnottomakeitdistort(orclip).
Hereishowtosetthevolumeoftheconnecteddevice:
ifthesoundheardonmicroARRANGERsoutputsistoo
low,youshouldincreasetheoutputleveloftheconnec
teddevice.
ifitsoundsfine,itsok.
ifitdistorts,youshouldlowerthelevelalittle,untilthe
soundsisfineagain.
MIDI CONNECTIONS
You can play the internal sounds of your microAR
RANGERwithanexternalcontroller,i.e.amasterkey
board, a MIDI guitar, a wind controller, a MIDI
accordion,oradigitalpiano.
1. ConnectastandardMIDIcablefromtheMIDIOUTof
your controller to the MIDI IN connector on the mic
roARRANGER.
2. Select a transmission MIDI channel on your controller.
Some controllers, like the MIDI accordions, usually
transmitonmorethanonechannel(seemoreinforma
tionintheMIDIchapter).
3. On the microARRANGER, select the MIDI Setup that
bestfitsyourcontrollerstype(seePage4MIDISetup
onpage126).
DEMO
Listen to the builtin Demo Songs to appreciate the
power of the microARRANGER. There are 16 Demo
Songstochoosefrom.
1. Press the STYLE PLAY and SONG PLAY buttons
together.TheirLEDsstartblinking.
At this point, if you dont press any other button, all the
DemoSongswillbeplayedback.
2. ChooseapageusingthePAGEbuttons.Therearetwo
differentpagesintheDemomode.
3. Select a Demo Song by pressing the corresponding
VOLUME/VALUEbuttonaroundthedisplay.TheDemo
willautomaticallystart.
4. StoptheDemobypressingSTART/STOP.
5. ExittheDemomodebypressingoneoftheMODEbut
tons.
Front panel
12
3. FRONT PANEL
28
27
2
6 7
34
30
30
31
15 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
32
33
48
16
17
29
18
19
20
21
1 Power switch ( )
ThisturnsthemicroARRANGERspoweronoroff.
2 MASTER VOLUME
This slider controls the overall volume of the instru
ment,bothoftheinternalspeakers,theL/MONOand
RIGHToutputs,andtheHEADPHONESoutput.
Warning:Atthemaximumlevel,withrichsoundingSongs,
StylesorPrograms,theinternalspeakerscoulddistortdur
ingsignalpeaks.Shouldthishappen,lowertheMasterVol
umealittle.
3 ACC/SEQ VOLUME
Thisslidercontrolstheaccompanimenttracksvolume
(StylePlaymode)ortheSongtracksvolume,excluding
theRealtimetracks(SongandSongPlaymodes).This
is a relative control, where the effective maximum
value is determined by the MASTER VOLUME slider
position.
4 ASSIGN.SLIDER
Thisisafreelyprogrammableslider(seeSld(Slider)
on page126). By default, it acts as the Keyboard
Expressioncontrol,toletyoubalancetherelativevol
umeoftheRealtime(Keyboard)tracks.
5 MODE section
Eachofthesebuttonsrecallsoneoftheoperatingmodes
oftheinstrument.Eachmodeexcludestheothers.
STYLEPLAY
Style Play mode, where you can play
Styles (automatic accompaniments) and/
orplayuptofourRealtimetracksonthe
keyboard.
In the main page, Realtime (Keyboard)
tracks are shown on the right half of the
display. You can reach the main page by
pressing EXIT from any of the Style Play
editpages.Ifyouareinadifferentoperat
ingmode,pressSTYLEPLAYtorecallthe
Style Play mode. If the TRACK SELECT
LEDison,pressTRACKSELECTtoturn
itoffandseetheRealtimetracks.
This operating mode is automatically
selected when the instrument is turned
on.
22
23 24 25 26
39
40
35
36
49
38
37
44
45
41 42 43
46
47
SONGPLAY
SongPlaymode,whereyoucanplayback
16track Songs in Standard Midi File
(SMF) format directly from the memory
card. You can also play .MID and
.KAR files directly from the memory
card. Since the microARRANGER is
equipped with two sequencers, you can
evenplaytwoSongsatthesametime,and
mixthemwiththeBALANCEslider.
In addition to the Song tracks, you can
play one to four Realtime (Keyboard)
tracks,alongwiththeSong(s).Inthemain
page, Realtime (Keyboard) tracks are
shownontherighthalfofthedisplay.You
canreachthemainpagebypressingEXIT
from any of the Song Play edit pages. If
you are in a different operating mode,
pressSONGPLAYtorecalltheSongPlay
mode.IftheTRACKSELECTLEDisonor
flashing, press TRK SELECT one or two
times to turn it off and see the Realtime
tracks.
B.SEQ
Backing Sequence mode, where you can
recordanewSongbasedontheRealtime
andStyletracks,andsaveitasanewStan
dardMIDIFile.
SONG
Songmode,whereyoucanplay,record,or
editaSong.
PROGRAM Programmode,toplaysingleSoundPro
gramsonthekeyboard,oreditthem.
Press the STYLE PLAY and SONG PLAY
DEMO
buttonstogethertoselecttheDemomode.
This mode lets you listen to some Demo
Songs,to let youhear the sonic power of
themicroARRANGER.
6 GLOBAL
ThisbuttonrecallstheGlobaleditenvironmentwhere
you can select various global settings. This edit envi
ronmentoverlapsanyoperatingmode,whichwillstill
remainactiveinthebackground.PressEXITtogoback
totheunderlyingoperatingmode.
Front panel
7 SD CARD
This button recalls the Card edit environment, where
you can execute various operations on files and cards
(Load, Save, Format, etc). This edit environment
overlapsanyoperatingmode,thatstillremainsactive
inthebackground.PressEXITtogobacktotheunder
lyingoperatingmode.
8 MEMORY (TIE)
ThisbuttonturnstheLowerandChordMemoryfunc
tions on or off. Go to the Page 24 Preferences: con
trols edit page (Style Play mode, see page 51) to
decideifthisbuttonshouldbeaChordMemoryonly,
oraLower/ChordMemorybutton.Whenitworksasa
Lower/ChordMemory:
ON
Thesoundtotheleftofthesplitpoint,and
the chord for the automatic accompani
ment,arekeptinmemoryevenwhenyou
raiseyourhandfromthekeyboard.
OFF
The sound and chords are released as
soonasyouraiseyourhandfromthekey
board.
This button doubles as a TIE function for the Song
mode(seechapter13).
9 BASS INV. (REST)
ThisbuttonturnstheBassInversionfunctiononoroff.
ON
The lowest note of a chord played in
inverted form will always be detected as
theroot noteof thechord. Thus,you can
specify to the arranger composite chords
suchasAm7/GorF/C.
OFF
The lowest note is scanned together with
the other chord notes, and is not always
consideredastherootnote.
ThisbuttondoublesasaRESTfunctionfortheSong
mode(seechapter13).
10 MAN. BASS
ThisbuttonturnstheManualBassfunctiononoroff.
Note: When you press the MAN. BASS button, the Bass
trackvolumeisautomaticallysettothemaximumvalue.The
volumeisautomaticallysetbacktotheoriginalvaluewhen
theMAN.BASSbuttonisdeactivated.
ON
Theautomaticaccompanimentstopsplay
ing (apart for the Drum and Percussion
tracks), and you can manually play the
Bass track on the Lower part of the key
board.Youcanstarttheautomaticaccom
paniment again by pressing one of the
CHORDSCANNINGbuttons.
OFF
Thebasstrackisautomaticallyplayedby
theStyle.
11 SPLIT POINT (<)
Keep this button pressed to open the Split Point win
dow.Whilethiswindowisopen,youcansetthesplit
pointsimplybyplayingthesplitpointnoteonthekey
board.Then,releasetheSPLITPOINTbutton.
To memorize the selected split point note, press the
GLOBALbutton,thenpressWRITEtosavetheGlobal
intomemory(seeTheWritewindowonpage125).
13
14
Front panel
pressthelefmostbuttonoftheSTYLEsection.Ames
sage window will appear, showing the name of the
originalbank.ReleasetheSHIFTbuttontoexitthewin
dow.
There is a shortcut to see all pages of the selected
bank.Tocycleallpagesforaselectedbank,pressthe
banksbuttonuntilyouseethepagethatyourelooking
for.
Thesebuttonsdoubleasanumerickeypadoncertain
pages(seeSelectingaSongcomposingitsprogressive
numberonpage70).
16 FADE IN/OUT
WhentheStylestoped,pressthisbuttontostartitwith
a volume fadein (the volume goes from zero to the
maximum).
When the Style is playing, press this button to stop it
with a volume fadeout (the volume gradually
decreases).
You dont need to press START/STOP to start or stop
theStyle.
17 VARIATION 14 (NOTE LENGTH) buttons
Eachofthesebuttonswillselectoneofthefourvaria
tions of the current Style. Each variation can vary in
patternsandsounds.
ThesebuttonsdoubleasaNOTELENGTHfunction
fortheSongmode(seechapter13).
18 FILL 12 (NOTE LENGTH) buttons
Thesetwobuttonstriggerafillin.Pressthemtwice(LED
blinking) to let them play in loop, and select any other
Styleelement(Fill,Intro,Variation)toexittheloop.
TheyalsodoubleasaNOTELENGTHfunctionfor
theSongmode(seechapter13).
19 COUNT IN / BREAK
WhiletheStyleisnotrunning,pressthisbutton,then
press START/STOP. This combination triggers a one
barinitialcount,thentheStylestartsplaying.
WhiletheStyleisalreadyinplay,thisbuttontriggersa
break(anemptymeasurebeginningwithakick+crash
shot).Pressittwicetoletitplayinloop,andselectany
otherStyleelement(Fill,Intro,Variation)toexitthe
loop.
Front panel
START+STOPLEDsON
When both LEDs are litup, raising your
handfromthekeyboardmomentarilywill
stoptheStylefromplaying.Ifyouplaya
chordagain,theStylestartsagain.
OFF
AllSynchrofunctionsareturnedoff.
This button doubles as a DELETE function for the
Backing Sequence and Song modes (see chapters 12
and13).
It is also used to delete the selected character, during
textediting.
24 TAP TEMPO/RESET (INSERT)
This is a doublefunction button, acting in a different
waydependingontheStylestatus(stop/play).
Tap Tempo: When the Style is not playing, you can
beatthetempoonthisbutton.Attheend,theaccom
panimentstartsplaying,usingthetappedintempo.
Reset:WhenyoupressthisbuttonwhiletheStyleisin
play,theStylepatterngoesbacktothepreviousstrong
beat.
This button doubles as an INSERT function for the
Backing Sequence and Song modes (see chapters 12
and13).
It is also used to insert a character at the cursor posi
tion,duringtextediting.
25 WRITE/CARD IN USE
In Style Play mode, this button opens the Write win
dow, that lets you save all the tracks onto a Perfor
mance, the Realtime (Keyboard) tracks in a Single
TouchSetting(STS),ortheaccompanimenttracksonto
a Style Performance. (See The Write window on
page42).
IntheGlobaleditenvironment,pressittosaveGlobal
parameters in memory. (See The Write window on
page125).
ThisbuttonsLEDworksasaCARDINUSEindica
tor,andturnsonwhenthecardslotisinuse.
26 ENSEMBLE
This button turns the Ensemble function on or off.
When on, the righthand melody is harmonized with
thelefthandchords.
Note:TheEnsemblefunctionworksonlywhenthekeyboard
isinSPLITmode,andtheLOWERChordScanningmode
selected.
15
Acorrespondingtracknameisprintedovereachbut
ton pair. These names show the corresponding track
the button pair affects in the main page of the Style
Playmode.
The left half is for the main page, where you can
see the Realtime tracks, and the Style tracks
groupedtogether:
27 RECORD
This button sets the instrument in Record mode
(dependingonthecurrentoperatingmode).
28 MENU
ThisbuttonopenstheMenupageforthecurrentoper
ating mode or edit environment. After opening a
menu,youcanjumptooneoftheeditpagesbypress
ing the corresponding VOLUME/VALUE buttons; or
browse them using the PAGE buttons. Otherwise, go
backto themainpageofthecurrentoperating mode,
or close the edit environment, by pressing the EXIT
button.
SeeSymbolsandIconsonpage21.
Usethesebuttonstoperformvariousoperationsonthe
commandsandfunctionsappearinginthedisplay.
SELECTING
Use each button pair to select the corre
spondingiteminthedisplay(i.e.atrack,a
parameteroracommand).Useeitherthe
leftorrightbuttoninapair.
16
Front panel
VOLUME
MUTE
SOLO
VALUE
31 TRACK SELECT
Depending on the operating mode, this button
switchesbetweenthevarioustracksview.
STYLEPLAYMODE
SwitchesbetweentheRealtimetracksand
theStyletracks.
SONGPLAYMODE
Switchesbetweenthemainpage(showing
the Realtime/Keyboard tracks), Song
tracks18,andSongtracks916.
SONGMODE
Switches between the main page, Song
tracks18andSongtracks916.
The TRACK SELECT LED shows the current page
view:
Off
Main page(Realtimetracks,orSongcon
trols)
On
2ndpage(Styletracks,orSongtracks18)
Flashing
3rdpage(Songtracks916)
32 SINGLE TOUCH SETTING
(F-1F-4 FUNCTION KEYS) buttons
While in the main page of the Style Play or Backing
Sequence mode, these buttons select a Single Touch
Settingeach.EachoftheStylesincludesamaximumof
fourSingleTouchSettings(STS),toautomaticallycon
figuretheRealtimetracksandeffectsatthetouchofa
finger.WhentheSINGLETOUCHLEDislit,anSTSis
automaticallyselectedwhenselectingaStyle.
InEditmode,thesebuttonsdoubleasfunctionkeys,
toselectthecorrespondingitemsinthedisplay.
33 SHIFT
Withthisbuttonhelddown,pressingcertainotherbut
tonswillaccesstoasecondfunction.
34 TEMPO/VALUE section
The DIAL and the DOWN/ and UP/+ buttons can be
used to control the Tempo, assign a different value to
theselectedparameterinthedisplayorscrollalistof
files in the Song Select and Card pages. The VALUE
LEDshowsthestatusofthissection.
DIAL
Turn the dial clockwise to increase the
valueortempo.Turnitcounterclockwise
todecreasethevalueortempo.
When used while pressing the
SHIFTbutton,thiscontrolalwaysactsasa
Tempocontrol.
DOWN/andUP/+
DOWN/ decreases the value or tempo;
UP/+increasesthevalueortempo.
Keep the SHIFT button pressed
down,andpresseithertheDOWN/or
UP/+ button to reset the Tempo to the
valuethatssavedontotheselectedStyle.
35 VALUE LED
ThisLED shows the status of the DIAL and DOWN/
andUP/+buttons.
ON
TheDIALandDOWN/andUP/+buttons
actasValuecontrols,tochangethevalue
oftheselectedparameterinthedisplay.
OFF
TheDIALandDOWN/andUP/+buttons
controltheTempo.
36 EXIT/NO
Use this button to perform various actions, leaving
fromthecurrentstatus:
exitadialogbox
answer No to any question that appears in the
display
exittheMenuwindow
gobacktothemainpageofthecurrentoperating
mode
exittheGlobalorCardEditenvironment,andgo
back to the main page of the current operating
mode
exit from a Style, Performance or Program Select
window
37 ENTER/YES
Use this button to perform various actions, agreeing
thecurrentselectedstatus:
answer Yes to any question that appears in the
display
confirmacommand
38 DISPLAY HOLD
ThisbuttonturnstheDisplayHoldfunctiononoroff.
ON
Whenyouopenatemporarywindow(like
theProgramSelectwindow),itremainsin
the display until you press EXIT/NO, or
anoperatingmodebutton.
OFF
Anytemporarywindowclosesafteracer
taintime,orafterselectinganiteminthe
window.
Front panel
17
44 PROGRAM/PERFORMANCE section
UsethesebuttonstoopentheProgramSelectorPerfor
manceSelectwindow,andselectaProgramoraPerfor
mance. See Selecting a Program on page25, or
Selecting a Performance on page25. For a list of
available Programs, see Programs (Program Change
order)onpage154.
Theleftmostbuttonselectstheupperorlowerrowof
Program or Performance banks. Press it until youve
selected the row that youre looking for. (After both
LEDs have consecutively turned on, press the button
againtoturnthemoff).
UPPERLEDON
Upper row of Programs or Performances
selected.
LOWERLEDON
Lower row of Programs or Performances
selected.
On the front panel, Program banks are identified by
the instrument names, while Performance banks are
identifiedbynumbers(110;0=bank10).
A note about Program banks and names. Programs
from PIANO to SFX are standard Programs, the
usercantdirectlymodify.
Programs USER1 and USER2 are locations where
youcanloadnewProgramsfromthememorycard.
USERDKiswhereyoucanloadnewdrumkits.
EachProgrambankcontainsvariouspages,eachwith
up to 8 Programs. You can browse them using the
PAGEbuttons.
ShortcuttoseetheoriginalbankforaPerformanceor
Program.YoucanseetheoriginalbankwhereaPerfor
mance or Program is contained. Just keep the SHIFT
button pressed, and then press the lefmost button of
the PROGRAM/PERFORMANCE section. A message
windowwillappear,showingthenameoftheoriginal
bank.ReleasetheSHIFTbuttontoexitthewindow.
Shortcuttoseeallpagesoftheselectedbank.Tocycle
all of the pages for a selected bank, press the banks
button.
45 PADS (14, STOP)
These programmable pads can be used to trigger a
sound effect. Use the STOP button to stop a cyclic
sound.(SeeListofsoundsassignabletothePadson
page226).
EachPadcorrespondstoadedicatedPadtrack.
46 TRANSPOSE
Thesebuttonstransposethewholeinstrumentinsemi
tonesteps(MasterTranspose).Thetranspositionvalue
isshown(asanotename)onthetoprightofthedis
play.
Pressbothbuttonstogether,toresettheMasterTrans
posetozero.
18
Front panel
RaisestheMasterTransposeasemitone.
47 OCTAVE
Thesebuttonstransposetheselectedtrackinstepsofa
wholeoctave(12semitones;max2octaves).Thetrans
position value is shown (in octaves) on the top right
areaofthedisplay.
Pressbothbuttonstogether,toresettheOctaveTrans
posetozero.
Note: The Octave Transpose has no effect on tracks set to
Drum mode (and, even if set in a different status, on the
DrumandPercussiontracks).
Lowerstheselectedtrackanoctave.
Raisestheselectedtrackanoctave.
48 BALANCE slider
InSongPlaymode,thissliderbalancesthevolumeof
the two onboard sequencers. When fully on the left,
onlySequencer1canbeheard.Whenfullyontheright,
only Sequencer 2 can be heard. When in the middle,
bothsequencerswillplayatfullvolume.
19
Display controls
DISPLAY CONTROLS
VOLUME/VALUE (AH) buttons and display parameters. Thesebuttonsareusedtoselectthecorrespond
ing parameter or command in the display, to change
theparameters value, orto changethe volume of the
correspondingtrack.
While you are on the main page, these buttons can
select a track, change the tracks volume, or mute/
unmuteatrack.
See VOLUME/VALUE (MUTE) AH buttons on
page15formoreinformation.
F-1F-4 buttons. WheninanEditpage,thesebuttons
maybeusedwhentherearefourparametersinarow,
asinthefollowingexample:
IntheCardEditenvironment,theF1F4buttonscan
be used also to select one of the page commands
appearinginthelastlineofthedisplay.
SeeSINGLETOUCHSETTING(F1F4FUNCTION
KEYS)buttonsonpage16formoreinformation.
PAGE. The PAGE buttons select the previous or next
edit page. When selecting a Style or a Program, they
select a different page of Styles or Programs. See
PAGE/+onpage15formoreinformation.
MENU. TheMENUbuttonopensthecurrentoperating
mode or edit environments Menu. When in a Menu,
youcanusetheVOLUME/VALUEbuttonstoselectan
editsectiontojumpto.
20
SongPlay
4Realtimetracks,2x16SongTracks,
4Pads.
BackingSequence
4Realtimetracks,8Styletracks,4Pads.
Song
16Songtracks.
Youcanonlyseeupto8tracksinthedisplay.So,use
theTRACKSELECTbuttontoswitchtotheother(hid
den) tracks. Forexample,wheninStyle Play,youcan
usethisbuttontoswitchfromtheRealtimetracksand
theStyletracks.
Whenopeninganeditenvironmentoraselectingpage,
thecurrentoperatingmodeisstillworkingintheback
ground.
INTERFACE STRUCTURE
Thankstoitsmultitaskingoperatingsystem,themicro
ARRANGER user interface is structured in overlap
ping,activelayers.Fromthelowerlevel:
operating modes (Style Play, Backing Sequence,
SongPlay,Song,Program)
editenvironments(Global,Card)
selecting windows (Style Select, Song Select, Pro
gramSelect,PerformanceSelect).
Operating modes
Main page
Menu
Edit pages
21
Message windows
Percussiontrack(Styletrackview).
GroupedDrumandPercussiontracks.
Basstrack(Styletrackview).
Grouped accompaniment tracks. This
symbolindicatesthefivegroupedaccom
panimenttracks(Acc15).
MESSAGE WINDOWS
Accompanimenttracks(Styletrackview).
PressENTERorEXITtoexitoneofthesewindows.
Other messages ask for an answer, asin the Are you
surewindowbelow:
PressENTER/YESforYes,orEXIT/NOforNo.
Sequencertracks.
(noicon)
GRAYED-OUT NON-AVAILABLE
PARAMETERS
Currentlynonavailableparametersarenowshownin
grayinthedisplay,i.e.withaghosttexture.Here
isanexampleofagrayedoutparameter,comparedto
anormalparameter:
Text in gray
Edit environment
Menu
Edit pages
22
Rear panel
5. REAR PANEL
4 5
1 PHONES
Usethisjacktoconnectapairofheadphones.Youcan
use headphones with an impedance of 16200 (50
suggested). Use a headphone distributor to connect
morethanonepairofheadphones.
2 INPUT
Usetheseunbalancedconnectorstoinputanotherkey
board/synthesizer,a(nonpowered)mixersoutput,or
aCD/tapeplayer(lineimpedance).Thesignalisauto
matically routed to the speakers, the Audio Outputs
andthePhones.
3 OUTPUTS
Usetheseunbalancedconnectorstosendtheaudiosig
nal(sound)toamixer,aPAsystem,asetofpowered
monitors,oryourhifisystem.Settheoutputlevelwith
theMASTERVOLUMEslider.
4 DAMPER
Use this to connect a Damper pedal, like the KORG
PS1,PS3orDS1H.Tochangeitspolarity,seeDamper
Pol.(DamperPolarity)onpage126.
5 ASSIGN. PDL/SW
Use this to connect a continuous or footswitch pedal,
liketheKORGEXP2orXVP10.Toprogramit,seeP/S
(Pedal/Switch)onpage126.
6 MIDI interface
The MIDI interface allows your microARRANGER to
be connected to an external controller (master key
BASIC GUIDE
24
Basic operations
Playing on the keyboard
6. BASIC OPERATIONS
PLAYING ON THE KEYBOARD
Justplayonthekeyboard.YouwillheartheRealtime
tracks playing. There are four Realtime tracks: Upper
13andLower.Theymayplayallatthesametime,or
justoneorafewofthem,dependingontheirMutesta
tus.Ifyoucannothearatrack,checkthemutestatusof
thatpart.
Tracks can be set in different ways: use the KEY
BOARDMODEsectiontoselectthewaytheyarecon
figuredonthekeyboard.
Press FULL UPPER to play the Upper 13 tracks
on the full range of the keyboard, just as you
wouldonapiano.
Upper 1
Upper 2
Upper 3
Selected track
PressSPLITtolettheUpper13tracksplayonthe
rightoftheSplitPoint,andtheLowertrackonthe
left.
Ifyoucantseethetrackthatyourelookingfor,usethe
TRACK SELECT button to scroll up or down the
tracks,andfindthehiddenones.
Upper 1
Lower
Upper 2
Upper 3
Split Point
KeeptheSPLITPOINTbuttonpressed,andplaya
note to change the point where the keyboard is
dividedinanUpperandaLowerpart.
Themute/playstatusisshownbytherelevanticonin
thedisplay:
LOWER
UPPER
(noicon)
Tosavetheselectedsplitpointnote,presstheGLOBAL
button,thenpressWRITEtosavetheGlobalinmem
ory(seeTheWritewindowonpage125).
Basic operations
25
Selecting a Performance
SELECTING A PERFORMANCE
APerformanceisasetofProgramsandsettingsforthe
Keyboard and Style tracks, that makes selecting com
plexcombinationslivefastandeasy.WhentheSTYLE
CHANGE LED is on, a Performance can also select a
differentStyle.
ItisalwaysadvisabletousePerformances,ratherthan
single Programs, when playing even a solo sound,
since a Performance lets you select the right effects,
transposition, plus many other parameters, together
withthePrograms.
Data type
Realtime
Tracks
Style
Tracks
Parameters
Upper 1, Upper 2,
Upper 3, Lower
Drum, Percussion,
Bass, Acc1, Acc2,
Acc3, Acc4, Acc5
2.
3.
4.
5.
SelectaPerformanceusingtheVOLUME/VALUE
(AH)buttons.
If the DISPLAY HOLD LED is on, press EXIT to
exitthiswindow.
SELECTING A PROGRAM
You can select a different Program (i.e., sound) to be
playedbyatrack.BeforeselectingaProgram,youmust
selectthetrackthatyouwanttoassigntheProgramto.
Note:ToassigndifferentPrograms totheStyletracks,press
TRACK SELECTtoseetheStyletracks.IfyouselectaPro
gram while grouped tracks (Drum/Percussion or ACC) are
selected,theProgramwillbeassignedtothelastselectedtrack.
EachStyleElement(Variations,Fills)canhavedif
ferentPrograms,soyourselectionmightbeautomati
callyresetwhenselectingadifferentElement.Toavoid
thisreset,seeProg(Program)onpage49.
1. Use the VOLUME/VALUE (EH) buttons on the
right side of the display, to select the Realtime
(Keyboard) track you wish to assign a different
Programto.
2.
26
Basic operations
Selecting a Style
3.
4.
SelectthePROGRAM/PERFORMANCEbankcon
tainingtheProgramyouarelookingfor(Program
banksareidentifiedbyinstrumentnames).
TheStyleSelectwindowappears.
3.
4.
The Program Select window appears. See Pro
grams(ProgramChangeorder)onpage154fora
listofFactoryPrograms.
Last selected Program
Selected track
5.
Thereare2pagesforeachbank,eachcontaining8
Styles.SelectapageusingthePAGEbuttons.
AsyoufindtheStyleyouarelookingfor,selectit
usingtheVOLUME/VALUE(AH)buttons.
Note:ThenewStylewillenteratthenextstrongbeat.
If the DISPLAY HOLD LED is on, press EXIT to
exitthiswindow.
6.
7.
BrowsealltheProgramsintheselectedbankusing
thePAGEbuttons.Therecanbevariouspagesfor
eachbank,containingupto8Programseach.
AsyoufindtheProgramyouarelookingfor,select
itusingtheVOLUME/VALUE(AH)buttons.
If the DISPLAY HOLD LED is on, press EXIT to
exitthiswindow.
SELECTING A STYLE
AStyleisasetofrhythmandaccompanimentpatterns.
You can select a Style from the internal memory, or
from a memory card (see The DIRECT SD bank on
page40).
1. Use the leftmost STYLE button to select a row of
Stylebanks(upper,lower).
2.
Tutorial
27
7. TUTORIAL
This chapter is fully devoted to stepbystep instruc
tions,thatwehopemaybeusefultolearnthebasics
inthefield.
PLAYING A STYLE
(Automatic Accompaniment)
A Style will be your virtual band for your best solos.
Selectoneofthe304Styleswefittedinthismachine
1 OK, select your favorite musical Style.
There are plenty of Styles to choose from. We will go
withaJazzStyletheJazzBrush.
1. SelectthesecondrowofStyles.Presstheleftmost
STYLEbuttontoswitchthelowerLEDon.
2 Call an Intro.
YoucanengageanIntrotobeplayedbeforetheStyle.
Press INTRO1 or INTRO2. The former plays more
freely,withoutlettingyoudecidethechords.Thelatter
letsyouplayachordprogressionwhileitsplaying.
Now,youarefreetopressbuttonnumber4,called
JAZZ1.
TheStyleSelectwindowappears.
The selected Style
3.
YoucangotoaVariationafteraFill.JustpressaFILL
button, then, immediately after press a VARIATION
button.
28
Tutorial
Playing in Realtime (Without using Automatic Accompaniment)
7 Stop it!
OK,youcouldsay:Oh,thatseasy,Iknowhowtodo
it, I can just press that big red START/STOP button
again.
Yes,youareperfectlyright.Butthatstheeasyway.Let
ussuggestamorecolorfulway:
PRESS ENDING1 OR ENDING2
An ending is instantaneously called, and will begin
playing, to lead the Style to a colorful end. As usual,
ENDING1 is preprogrammed, while ENDING2 asks
foryourchordprogression.
PLAYING IN REALTIME
(Without using Automatic Accompaniment)
AssoonasyouturnyourmicroARRANGERon,itisin
StylePlaymode,andyoucanplayitinrealtime.Please
followme
1 Play on the keyboard.
WhenyouturnthemicroARRANGERon,Performance
11isautomaticallyselected.
Performance bank-number
In Sync
WhatifIwanttoavoidallthatSTART/STOPstuff?I
mean, I prefer to have my hands free for playing
music!
Good point. The SYNCHRO button is there right for
thispurpose.
While the Style is stopped, press the SYNCHRO button.
TheSYNCHROSTARTLEDbeginsblinking.TheSyn
chroStartfunctionisenabled.
1
ThissetstheRealtime(Keyboard)tracksforyou.Inthis
caseyougettheUpper1trackplayingonthefullkey
boardrange,withtheGrandPianoProgramselected.
As you may know, there are four available Realtime
tracks: Upper 13 and Lower. Upper Realtime tracks
may play on the full range of the keyboard (the
selected KEYBOARD MODE shall be FULL UPPER).
Otherwise,theLowertrackplaysontheleftoftheSplit
Point,andtheUppertracksontheright(KEYBOARD
MODEshallbeSPLIT).
Ifyouarenotsatisfiedwiththissettingatstartup,you
cansimplyselectanotherPerformance.Orchangethe
tracks settingsas you will see in this tutorialand
savethemintoPerformance11.Youllsoonseehowto
doit.
2 Select a different Performance.
IsthePERFORM.LEDon?
Tutorial
29
PressthemagaintounmutetheLowertrack.
Try also with the Upper tracks, using the E, F and G
VOLUME/VALUE buttons. You will notice the sound
becomes more or less fullersounding, depending on
thenumberoftracksmutedorunmuted.
30
Tutorial
Recording a Song (Simultaneously recording the Style and realtime performance)
RECORDING A SONG
(Simultaneously recording the Style and
realtime performance)
TheBackingSequencemodeisafastandeffectiveway
of recording a new Song, making full use of the fea
tures of the Style Play mode. So, arm your recorder,
andplaylivewiththeStylesasongwillbereadyin
seconds!
1 First, enter Backing Sequence mode
PressB.SEQtoaccesstheBackingSequencemode.The
Realtimetracks,onthekeyboard,willremainthesame
asyouselectedintheStylePlaymode.
Tutorial
31
3.
Pressthe[F1]buttontoselecttheSDcard(SD).
4.
MovethefolderwhereyouwishtosaveyourSong
tothefirstlineofthedisplay,usingtheEF(Scroll
Up) and GH (Scroll Down) VOLUME/VALUE
buttons,ortheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols.PressF3
(OPEN) to open it. Close the current folder by
pressingF4(CLOSE).
To create a new file, move the NEW_NAME.MID
itemtothefirstlineofthedisplay.
When the NEW_NAME.MID item is selected,
pressoneoftheAVOLUME/VALUEbuttons.You
arepromptedtoassignanametothenewfolder:
5.
6.
2.
3.
4.
5.
7.
MovethecursorusingtheDOWN/andUP/+but
tons. Select a character using the DIAL. Insert a
character at the cursor position by pressing the
INSERT button. Delete a character at the cursor
positionbypressingtheDELETEbutton.
When you have finished writing a name for the
new midifile, press F2 (SAVE) to confirm. The
Are you sure? message will appear. Press
ENTERtoconfirm,orEXITtoabort.
32
Tutorial
Editing a Song
EDITING A SONG
You can edit a Song, either a Standard MIDI File
boughtattheshop,oroneofyourSongsmadeinBack
ingSequencemode.
What about changing those boring General MIDI
sounds with those gorgeous original KORG sounds?
YoucandoitinSongmode.
1 Press SONG to go to the Song mode.
This is the Song garage, where you may find tools to
reshapeyourSong.
Page commands
Use the TEMPO/VALUE controls, or the VOLUME/VALUE (EH) buttons to scroll the list.
The EF buttons are the Scroll Up ( ), while the
GH buttons are the Scroll Down ( ).
Movethefileyouarelookingfortothefirstlineofthe
display.
6
Ifyoureplacedthecard,pressF1(SD)toreadtheSD
cardagain.
Movethemidifiletoloadtothefirstlineofthedisplay.
UsetheDIALortheUPandDOWNbuttonstoscroll
thelist;orusetheEF(ScrollUp)orGH(Scrolldown)
VOLUME/VALUEbuttons.
When the midifile is on the first line of the display,
pressF2(LOAD)toloadit.TheAreyousure?mes
sagewillappear.PressENTERtoconfirm.
Note:WhenloadingaStandardMIDIFile,thefirstMIDI
events are converted to the Song Performance events. You
willseethemasthePrograms,Volume,Pan,Effectsettings
assignedtothetracks.
Tutorial
33
Editing a Song
select.Forexample,oneoftheAbuttonstoselect
track1:
3.
Press PLAY/STOP (SEQ1) to listen to the Song. The
LEDonthebuttonturnson.
Doesitsoundgood?IfitisaGeneralMIDIcompatible
midifile,thereisagoodchanceitdoes.Butwecanfur
therimproveonit.
5 Stop the Song.
Thisoneiseasy:pressPLAY/STOP(SEQ1).TheLEDon
thePLAY/STOPbuttonturnsoff.
Please, always remember: make any changes to the
Songwhenthesequencerisnotplaying.Otherwise,a
Stopcommandwillresetallyourchanges.
(Notfunny,huh?)
6 Select different Programs.
You can replace General MIDI Programs with KORG
Programs.Itwillsoundmorerich,morelively.
1. PressTRACKSELECTtoseetracks18.TheLED
turnson.
Youarewatchingattracks18.Youcanswitchto
tracks 916 by pressing the TRACK SELECT but
tonagain.
2.
IfyoupressTRACKSELECTagain,youareback
to the main page. Press TRACK SELECT AGAIN
togototracks18
SelectthetrackyouwishtoassignadifferentPro
gram using the VOLUME/VALUE buttons. Press
one of the buttons corresponding to the track to
4.
SelectaProgram.Youshouldknowhowtodo.If
not,whataboutgoingbackforalittletotheBasic
operations chapter, Selecting a Program sec
tion, page25? It will be of a great help in the
future
Which Programs to choose? With >662 Programs,
you will for sure find your preferred sound. Just
browse any Program bank, and listen to them.
Turn on the DISPLAY HOLD LED, to stay in the
Selecting Window until you have found the right
Program.(Then,pressEXITorDISPLAYHOLDto
exitthewindow.)
Executeasmanychangesasyouliketotheother
tracks.
PressoneoftheAVOLUME/VALUEbuttons,toselect
the Mixer/Tuning item. Suddenly, a Volume edit page
appears
Selectatrack,andusetheDIALortheUPandDOWN
buttons, or the VOLUME/VALUE buttons, to change
thetracksvolume.
Modifyalltracksyouthinkneedtobemodified.
8 Save the Song.
YourchangeswillbelostwhenyouloadanewSong,
switch to the Song Playmode,or turnthe instrument
34
Tutorial
The Arabic Scale
off.So,pressEXITtogobacktothemainpageofthe
Songmode.
PressoneoftheCVOLUME/VALUEbuttons,toselect
the Save Song command. Save your Song with a new
name. How to accomplish this simple operation is
described in great details on page90 (Save Song
page).
Note: When saving a Song the Song Performance events
(initial Program, Volume, Pan, Effect Send settings) are
savedatthebeginningoftheStandardMIDIFile.Effectset
tingsaresavedasmicroARRANGERSysExevents,ignored
byothermusicalinstruments.
Other editings
TheVolumeisnottheonlyparameteryoucanedit.You
caneditalotmorethings,likethePan,theEffects,the
Tuningyoucanevenuseupto4effects(ADInter
nal FX Processors), but this will be useful only when
readingtheSongbackonthemicroARRANGERonly,
since other General MIDIcompliant instruments use
only2effects.
MIDI
35
What is MIDI?
8. MIDI
WHAT IS MIDI?
Here is a brief overview of MIDI, as related to the
microARRANGER. If interested, you may find more
informationonthegeneraluseofMIDIinthevarious
specializedmagazinesandbooks.
In general
MIDI stands for Musical Instruments Digital Interface.
Thisinterfaceletsyouconnecttwomusicalinstruments,
oracomputerandvariousmusicalinstruments.
Physically,MIDIiscomposedofthreedifferentconnec
tors.TheMIDIINreceivesdatafromanotherdevice;the
MIDIOUTsendsdatatoanotherdevice;theMIDITHRU
sendstoanotherdeviceexactlywhatwasreceivedonthe
MIDIIN(thisisusefultodaisychainmoreinstruments).
CC10,orPan.Thisonesetsthechannelsposition
onthestereofront.
CC64,orDamperPedal.Usethiscontrollertosim
ulatetheDamperpedal.
Tempo
Tempo is a global MIDI message, that is not tied to a
particularchannel.EachSongincludesTempodata.
Lyrics
LyricsarenonstandardMIDIevents,madetodisplay
text together with the music. microARRANGER can
readmanyoftheavailableLyricsformatonthemarket.
MIDIFILES
Midifiles,orStandardMIDIFiles(SMF),areapractical
way of exchanging songs between different instru
mentsandcomputers.microARRANGERhastheSMF
format as its default song format, so reading a song
fromacomputer,orsavingasongthatacomputersoft
warecanread,isnotaproblematall.
microARRANGERsequencersarecompatiblewiththe
SMF in format 0 (all data in one track; it is the most
common format) and 1 (multitrack). It can read the
SMFinSongPlaymodeandmodify/savetheminSong
mode.ItcansaveaSonginSMF0formatintheBack
ingSequenceorSongmode.
When in Song Play mode, the microARRANGER can
also display SMF lyrics in Solton, MLive (Midisoft),
Tune1000 and compatible (Edirol, GMX, HitBit, XF)
formats,andthechordabbreviationsofSMFinSolton,
Mlive(Midisoft),GMX,andXFformat.
36
MIDI
The Chord 1 and Chord 2 channels
transmissionshouldtakeplaceovertheGlobalchannel
ofthemicroARRANGER.
The MIDI messages received over a Global channel and
notoverastandardchannelareaffectedbythebuttonsof
the KEYBOARD MODE section, as well from the split
point. Therefore, if the SPLIT button LED is lit up, the
notesthatarrivetothemicroARRANGERoverthischan
nelwillbedividedbythesplitpointintotheUpper(above
thesplitpoint)andLower(belowthesplitpoint)parts.
ThenotesthatarrivetoaGlobalchannelareusedfor
thechordrecognitionoftheautomaticaccompaniment.
If the KEYBOARD MODE is SPLIT, only the notes
belowthesplitpointwillbeused.Thesenoteswillbe
combined with the ones of the special Chord 1 and
Chord2channels.
selectedthemostappropriateMIDISetupforthecon
nectiontobemade,youcanmodifytheparametersas
necessaryandsavetheGlobalinthememorywiththe
Writefunction(seeTheWritewindowonpage125).
CONNECTING microARRANGER TO A
MASTER KEYBOARD
You can control the microARRANGER with a master
keyboardoranyotherMIDIkeyboard.Youonlyneed
toconnecttheMIDIOUTconnectorofthemasterkey
boardtotheMIDIINconnectorofthemicroARRANG
ERmicroARRANGER. The master keyboard will
become the integrated keyboard of the microAR
RANGER if it transmits over the same channel pro
grammedasGlobalinthemicroARRANGER.
MIDI SETUP
YoucanplaymicroARRANGERwithanexternalcon
troller,anduseitsimplyasagorgeoussoundgenera
tor.TohelpyouconfiguretheMIDIchannels,wehave
provided a set of MIDI Setups. Go to Global mode to
selecttheonethatfitsyourMIDIneeds.(SeePage4
MIDISetuponpage126formoreinformation).
WerecommendyoutoconsidereachMIDISetupasa
starting point you can freely tweak. Once you have
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
IfthemasterkeyboardtransmitsovertheGlobalchannel
ofthemicroARRANGER,thesplitpointandthestatusof
theKEYBOARDMODEsectioninthecontrolpanelwill
affectthenotesreceivedfromthemasterkeyboard.
MIDI
37
3.
4.
MIDI OUT
5.
6.
GotoPage4MIDISetup(seepage126).Select
theExt.SeqSetup.
Note:Thesettingscanchangewhennewdataisloaded
fromacard.Toprotectthesettingsfromloading,usethe
Global Protect function (see Global Protect on
page142).
Press WRITE, select Global, and press ENTER to
savetheGlobal.TheAreyousure?messagewill
appear.PressENTERtoconfirm,orEXITtoabort.
Set the Upper 1 track in play, and press FULL
UPPER in the KEYBOARD MODE section. This
way,youcantransmittotheexternalsequenceron
thefullkeyboardrange.
At this point, the notes played on the Upper 1
track go from the MIDI OUT of the microAR
RANGER to the MIDI IN of the computer/MIDI
interface.
The notes generated by the computer (i.e. a Song
played by its sequencer) are sent thru the MIDI
OUToftheMIDIinterfacetotheMIDIINconnec
torofthemicroARRANGER.
MIDI IN
The programs
MIDI IN
2.
MIDI OUT
38
MIDI
Playing another instrument with the microARRANGER
Tohearonlytheexpanderssounds,youcanlowerthe
MASTERVOLUMEcontrolonthemicroARRANGER,
or set the Realtime Tracks to the External status (see
Page15Track:Internal/Externalonpage47).
The Sequencer
AnySequencerstrackcandriveachannelonanexter
nal instrument. To set each tracks MIDI output chan
nel,seePage10MIDIOUTChannelsonpage129.
Tohearonlytheexpanderssounds,youcanlowerthe
MASTERVOLUMEcontrolonthemicroARRANGER,
orsettheSongtrackstotheExternalstatus(seePage8
Track:Internal/Externalonpage79).
Select the Sequencer 1 or Sequencer 2 MIDI Setup
(depending on the Sequencer you are using on the
microARRANGER)tosetthechannelsasfollows.
Track
Out Channel
Song 116
116
The Arranger
The Keyboard
microARRANGERsphysicalkeyboardcandriveupto
4 tracks via the MIDI OUT (Upper 13 and Lower).
MIDI output channels are set in Global mode (see
Page10MIDIOUTChannelsonpage129).
As a default situation (Default Setup), each of micro
ARRANGER Realtime Tracks transmit on these chan
nels:
Track
Out Channel
Upper1
Upper2
Upper3
Lower
Whenatrackisinmute,itcanttransmitanyMIDIdata
toanexternalexpanderorsequencerconnectedmicro
ARRANGERsMIDIOUT.
OneofthemostinterestingaspectofMIDI,isthatyou
can use your microARRANGER to play an external
instrumentwithitsonboardarranger.Yes,itshardto
beat the audio quality of microARRANGER, but you
could wish to use that old faithful synth you are still
accustomedto
ToassignsomeofmicroARRANGERStyletrackstoan
externalinstrument,setthemtotheExternalstatus(see
Page15Track:Internal/Externalonpage47).
SelecttheDefaultMIDISetuptosetthechannelsasfol
lows(thisisthedefaultstatusofmicroARRANGER).
Track
Out Channel
Bass
Drums
10
Percussion
11
Acc15
1216
REFERENCE GUIDE
40
WHATS A STYLE?
AStyleisarhythm/accompanimentstructure,thatsim
ulatesabandbackingyoursolos.
In a vertical direction, it is composed of 8 different
tracks (Drums, Percussion, Bass, and 5 different har
monic or melodic instruments). You can play on the
keyboardwith4moreRealtimetracks(Upper13and
Lower).
Inahorizontaldirection,itisaseriesofStyleElements
(i.e., the various sets of patterns for each chord and
each of the Intros, Variations, Fills, Breaks and End
ings).
Folder
DIRECT SD pages
1, 2
3, 4
5, 6
3.
4.
5.
UsetheF1(SD)buttontorescantheSDcard.
LoadthreebanksofStyles,tobetransformedinto
theDIRECTSDbank.
GototheSavepage.
6.
WhiletheALLitemisselected,pressF3(OPEN)
toopenit.
7. Use the EF (Scroll Up) and GH (Scroll Down)
VOLUME/VALUEbuttons(ortheTEMPO/VALUE
sectioncontrols)tomovetheSTYLEitemtothe
firstlineofthedisplay,andpressF2(SAVE).
8. SelecttheSDcard(SD)asthetarget,usingtheF1
button.
9. The card directory appears. Use the EF (Scroll
Up) and GH (Scroll Down) VOLUME/VALUE
buttons (or the TEMPO/VALUE section controls),
toscrollthecardcontent.Movethefirstfolderof
thedirectorytothefirstlineofthedisplay.
10. PressENTERtwicetosavethebanks.
41
Main page
MAIN PAGE
Thisisthepageyouseeafteryouturntheinstrument
on.
Toaccessthispagefromanotheroperatingmode,press
theSTYLEPLAYbutton.
Note:WhenswitchingfromSongPlaytoStylePlay,aPer
formanceisautomaticallyselected,andvarioustrackparam
etersmaychange.
To return to this page from one of the Style Play edit
pages,presstheEXIT/NObutton.
ToswitchbetweentheRealtime(Keyboard)tracksand
theStyletracks,usetheTRACKSELECTbutton.
Style Play icon
Selected Style
Selected STS or
Performance
Usethesebuttonstoselect,mute/unmuteorchangethe
volume of the instrumental accompaniment tracks
(tracks15,otherthanBass,DrumandPercussion).To
mute these tracks, press both VOLUME/VALUE but
tons. To unmute them, press both buttons again. To
changethevolume,keeponeofthebuttonspressed.
E (Upper 1 Program), F (Upper 2 Program), G (Upper 3
Program), H (Lower Program)
NameoftheProgramsassignedtotheRealtime(Key
board)tracks.Usethesebuttonstoselect,mute/unmute
orchangethevolumeofthecorrespondingtracks.
PresstheTRACKSELECTbuttononceagaintogoback
tothemainpage.
Selected Style
CurrentlyselectedStyle.
NameoftheProgramsassignedtotheStyletracks.Use
thesebuttonstoselect,mute/unmuteorchangethevol
umeofthecorrespondingtracks.
Usethesebuttonstoselect,mute/unmuteorchangethe
volumeofbothDrumandPercussiontracks(grouped
together)atthesametime.Tomutethesetracks,press
bothVOLUME/VALUEbuttons.Tounmute,pressboth
buttons again. To change the volume, select the track,
thenkeeponeofthebuttonspressed.
B (Bass track Program name)
42
MENU
1.
If you select
you save
to this location
Performance
Selected Performance
STS
Current Style
2.
3.
Eachiteminthismenucorrespondstoaneditsection.
Eacheditsectiongroupsvariouseditpages.
Page header
Page number
Page name
Page number
Thisareashowsthecurrentpagenumber.
AH
EachpairofVOLUME/VALUE(AH)buttonsselectsa
different parameter of command, depending on the
43
editpage.Afterselectingaparameter,youcanchange
itsvaluebypressingoneofthetwobuttonsinapair,or
usingtheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols.
R+63
Off
HardRight.
Thedirect(uneffected)signaldoesnotgo
totheoutputs;onlytheFXsignalisheard
forthistrack.
Track
Output
FX Processor
There are four Internal FX processors in Style Play
mode. You can assign them any kind of available
effects,butwefounditconvenienttoarrangethemin
thefollowingway,foralltheStylesincludedwiththe
microARRANGER:
A ReverbprocessorfortheStyletracks.
B ModulatingFXprocessorfortheStyletracks.
C Reverb processor for the Realtime (Keyboard)
tracks.
D Modulating FX processor for the Realtime (Key
board)tracks.
UsetheTRACKSELECTbuttontoswitchfromtheReal
time(Keyboard)trackstotheStyletracks,andviceversa.
Volume
Tracksvolume.
0127
MIDIvalueofthetracksvolume.
Toselectaparameterandedititsvalue:
1. UsetheVOLUME/VALUE(AH)buttonstoselect
atrack.
2. UsetheF1F4buttonstoselectoneoftheeffect
processors.
3. UsetheTEMPO/VALUEcontrolstochangethevalue.
Send level
000
Pan
L64
C+00
127
HardLeft.
Center.
Noeffect.Onlythedirect(uneffected)sig
nalgoestotheoutputs.
100% effect. The direct (uneffected) and
effectedsignalsgototheoutputswiththe
samelevel.
44
Note
Notedetune,relativetothestandardEqualtuning.This
parametercanbeaccessedwhenaUserScaleisselected.
Parameters
Detune
Thisisthefinetuningvalue.
64
Lowestpitch.
00
Standardtuning.
+63
Highestpitch.
TheseparametersshowthePitchBendrangeforeach
track,insemitones.
0112
Maximum up/down pitchbend range (in
semitones).12=1octave.
Off
Nopitchbendallowed.
Thispageletsyouprogramthealternativescaleforthe
selected tracks (see Scale Mode on page51). The
remainingtracksusetheScalesetintheGlobalmode
(seeScaleonpage125).
A, B
Scale
Selectedscale.SeeScalesonpage227foralistofthe
availablescales.
Key
ParameterrequiredforsomeScales,whenyoushould
selectapreferredkey.
EffectsassignedtotheAandBeffectprocessors.Usu
ally, A is the reverb, while B is the modulating effect
(chorus, flanger, delay). For a list of the available
effects,seeEffectsonpage175.
ModTrk (Modulating Track)
AmountoftheBeffectgoingbacktotheinputoftheA
effect.
45
ThispageletsyouselecttheCandDeffects.Usually,
theCeffectisthereverb,andtheDeffectisthemodu
latingeffectfortheRealtime(Keyboard)tracks.
C, D
EffectsassignedtotheCandDeffectprocessors.Usu
ally, C is the reverb, while D is the modulating effect
(chorus, flanger, delay). For a list of the available
effects,seeEffectsonpage175.
AmountoftheDeffectgoingbacktotheinputoftheC
effect.
SeeEffectsonpage175foralistofavailableparame
tersforeacheffecttype.
Hereistheeditprocedure:
1. UsetheVOLUME/VALUE(AH)buttonstoselect
atrack.
2. Use the F1F4 buttons to select a Program
parameter,oritsvalue.(FortheDrumandPercus
siontracks,seebelowtheDrumtrackssection).
3. Use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the
Programparameteroritsvalue.
Parameters
Attack
Attacktime.Thisisthetimeduringwhich
thesoundgoesfromzero(atthemoment
when you strike a key) to its maximum
level.
Decay
Decay time. Time to go from the final
Attack level to the beginning of the
Release.
Release
Release time. This is the time during
whichthesoundgoesfromthesustaining
(or Decay) phase, to zero. The Release is
triggeredbyreleasingakey.
Cutoff
Filter cutoff. This sets the sound bright
ness.
Resonance Use the Filter Resonance to define the
width of the frequency range affected by
theFilter.
46
VibratoRate SpeedoftheVibrato.
VibratoDepth
IntensityoftheVibrato.
VibratoDelay
DelaytimebeforetheVibratobegins,after
thesoundstarts.
Drum tracks
WhenatrackissetinDrumMode(liketheDrumand
Percussiontracks),youcanadjustthevolumeforeach
oftheDrumandPercussioncategories.
KickV
Kickdrumsvolume.
SnareV
Snaredrumsvolume.
TomV
Tomsvolume.
HiHatV
HiHatvolume.
CymbalV Ride,Crashandothercymbalsvolume.
Percus1V
Classicpercussionsetvolume.
Percus2V
Ethnicpercussionsetvolume.
SFXV
Specialeffectsvolume.
Reset
You can reset the parameters value by keeping the
SHIFTbuttonpressed,whilepressingoneoftheselected
track VOLUME/VALUE buttons. After you press the
abovebuttoncombination,theResetwindowappears:
PressENTER/YEStoresetthecurrentlyselectedtrack.
KeepSHIFTpressed,andpressENTER/YES,toresetall
tracks.PressEXIT/NOtoabortandkeepallparameters
unchanged.
Parameters
Drum
ThisisaDrum/Percussiontrack.NoMas
ter or Octave Transpose applies to this
track. You can set a different volume for
each class of percussive instruments (see
Page13Track:Easyeditonpage45).
Poly
Tracks of this kind are polyphonic, i.e.
they can play more than one note at the
sametime.
Mono
Tracks of this kind are monophonic, i.e.
eachnewnotestopsthepreviousnote.
MonoRight AMonotrack,butwithpriorityassigned
totherightmost(highest)note.
47
ThispageletsyousettheInternalorExternalstatusfor
eachtrack.ItisveryusefultoletaStyletrackdrivean
externalexpander,or play adigitalpiano withoneof
microARRANGERsRealtimetracks.
Thispageletsyouenable/disabletheDamperpedalfor
eachoftheRealtime(Keyboard)tracks.
D (Damper)
On
Off
E (Expression)
Parameters
Internal
External
CC#0
Both
CC#32
PC
Hereistheeditprocedure:
1. UsetheVOLUME/VALUE(EH)buttonstoselect
atrack.
2. UsetheF3F4buttonstoselecttheXorYparam
eterforthattrack.
3. Use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the
status.
48
Up1Up3
Righthand(Upper)tracks.
Off
Thereisnoharmonizationonthistrack.
Normal
This track is included in the harmoniza
tion.
Mute
ThistrackonlyplaystheEnsemblenotes,
butnottheoriginalnote.
Hereistheeditprocedure:
1. UsetheVOLUME/VALUE(EH)buttonstoselect
atrack.
2. UsetheF3F4buttonstoselecttheLorHparam
eterforthattrack.
3. Use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the
parametersvalue.
L/H
E(nsemble)
Harmonizationtype.
Duet
Addsasinglenotetothemelody.
Close
Adds a closedposition chord to the mel
ody.
Open1
Adds an openposition chord to the mel
ody.
Open2
As the above, but with a different algo
rhythm.
Block
Blockharmonizationverytypicalofjazz
music.
PowerEnsemble
Addsafifthandanoctavetothemelody,
asheardinhardrock.
FourthsLO Typicalofjazz,thisoptionaddsaperfect
fourthandaminorseventhunderthemel
ody.
FourthsUP As the above, but with notes added over
themelody.
Fifths
ThisaddsaseriesofFifthsbelowtheorig
inalnote.
Octave
Addsoneormoreoctavestothemelody.
Dual
Thisoptionaddstothemelodylineasec
ond note, at a fixed interval set with the
Note parameter. When selecting this
option, a transposition value appears (
24+24semitonestotheoriginalnote).
Brass
TypicalBrasssectionharmonization.
Reed
TypicalReedsectionharmonization.
Trill
Thisoptiontrillsthemelodynote.Youcan
set the trill speed by using the Tempo
parameter(seebelow).
Note: You must play at least two notes with
thisoption!
The played note is repeated in sync with
Repeat
the Tempo parameter (see below). When
playing a chord, only the first note is
repeated.
Echo
As the Repeat option, but with the
repeatednotesfadingawayafterthetime
set with the Feedback parameter (see
below).
Dyn(amics)
Thisparametersetsthevelocitydifferencebetweenthe
righthand melody and the added harmonization
notes.
100
Subtractedvelocityvalue.
Tempo
Note:ThisparameteronlyappearswhentheTrill,Repeator
Echooptionsareselected.
49
Inc/Dec
Feedback
Note:ThisparameteronlyappearswhentheEchooptionis
selected.
Thisparametersetshowmanytimestheoriginalnote/
chordisrepeatedbytheEchooption.
>1>4
Hereistheeditprocedure:
1. UsetheVOLUME/VALUE(AH)buttonstoselect
aparameter.
2. Use the F1F4 buttons to move the cursor
betweentheparameteranditsstatusorvalue.
3. Use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the
parametersstatusorvalue.
Prog (Program)
50
W (Wrap Around)
Thewraparoundpointisthehighestregisterlimitfor
thebackingtrack.Theaccompanimentpatternswillbe
transposed according to the detected chord. If the
chordistoohigh,theStyletracksmightplayinaregis
ter that is too high, and therefore unnatural. If, how
ever, it reaches the wraparound point, it will be
automaticallytransposedanoctavelower.
The wraparound point can be set for each track in
semitonestepsuptoamaximumof12semitones,rela
tive to the chord root. This value will be the interval
betweenthekeyspecifiedbytheStyleElementandthe
wraparoundpoint.
112
Maximum transposition(in semitones) of
the track, referred to the original key of
thepattern.
KR (Keyboard Range)
SoundsorfunctionsassignedtothePads.
Scale
PAGE 22 - PADS
Thispageletsyouselectadifferentsoundorfunction
foreachofthefourPADbuttons.
14
VolumeforeachofthefourPadtracks.
Pan
PanforeachofthefourPadtracks.
64
FullyLeft.
00
Centered.
+63
FullyRight.
C Send
SendleveltotheDInternalFXprocessor(usuallymod
ulatingeffect)foreachofthefourPadtracks.
TheMasterTransposevalueismemorizedintothePer
formanceorStylePerformance.TopreventtheMaster
Transposetobeautomaticallychangedwhenselecting
aStyleorPerformance,thislockshouldbesettoOn.
On
(Default) The lock is engaged. When
selectingaStyleorPerformance,theMas
terTransposewillnotchange.
Off
The lock is turned off. When selecting a
Style or Performance, the Master Trans
pose value may change, according to the
data memorized into the Performance or
StylePerformance.
51
Scale Mode
Thisparametersetshowchordsarerecognizedbythe
autoaccompanimentengine.Pleasenotethatwhenin
Full or Upper Chord Scanning mode, the Fingered 3
modeisalwaysselected,andyoumustalwaysplayat
leastthreenotes,toletachordberecognized.
Fingered1 Play one or more notes, according to the
selected Chord Scanning Mode. A full
Major chord will be recognized even if
onlyasinglenoteisplayed.
Fingered2 Youmustalwaysplaythreeormorenotes
for a full chord to be recognized. If you
playjustonenote,aunisonwillbeplayed.
Ifyouplayasuspended5th,asuspended
chord will be played. The full chord will
be recognized when you play three or
morenotes.
Fingered3 Youmustalwaysplaythreeormorenotes
forachordtoberecognized.
OneFinger Youcanalsocomposeachordusingasim
plifiedchordplayingtechnique:
Ifyouplayonlyonenote,aMajorchord
isrecognized.
Playtherootnote,plusawhitekey on
theleft,fora7th.Ex.:C3+B2.
Play the root note, plus a black key on
theleft,foraMinorchord.Ex.:C3+Bb2.
Play the root note, plus a white and a
blackkeyontheleft,foraMinor7th.Ex.:
C3+B2+Bb2.
SetthisparametertotriggeraFilloraBreaksimplyby
playing louder with your left hand. When playing on
the Lower track with a velocity higher than 95, the
selected Style Element will start. For this function to
work, the SPLIT Keyboard Mode and LOWER Chord
ScanningModemustbeselected.
Off
Thefunctionisturnedoff.
Break,Fill1,Fill2
Whenplayingwithavelocityhigherthan
95 on the Lower track, the selected ele
mentisautomaticallytriggered.
Start/Stop YoucanstartorstoptheStylebyplaying
harderonthekeyboard.
52
Chord
Variation 1
CV1
CV1 CV6
CV1 CV2
Maj
Drum
Perc
Bass
Acc1
Acc2
Acc3
Acc4
Acc5
CV2
EachStyleElementismadeupofsmallerunits,called
Chord Variations (CV), but not all of them have the
samenumberofCVs.Variations14haveupto6CVs
each,whiletheotherStyleElementshaveonlyupto2
CVs.
Whenyouplayonthechordrecognitionarea(Lower,
UpperorFull,dependingontheChordScanningsec
tiononthecontrolpanel),thearrangerscansthekey
board and determines which chord you are playing.
Then, depending on the selected Style Element, it
determines which Chord Variation (CV) should be
playedforthescannedchord.WhichChordVariation
corresponds to each scanned chord is a setting of the
Style: the Chord Variation Table. Each Style Element
contains a Chord Variation Table, whose prototype is
thefollowing:
6
M7
M7b5
Sus4
Sus2
M7sus4
min
m6
CV3
m7
CV4
m7b5
mM7
CV5
CV6
7b5
7sus4
Variation 2
dim
Variation 3
dimM7
Variation 4
Intro1
aug
aug7
augM7
no 3rd
CV1
CV2
Intro 2
Fill 1
Fill 2
Ending 1
Ending 2
no 3rd, no 5th
53
Style Import/Export
GoingdeeperintotheStylestructure,wecanseethat
eachChordVariationismadeupofTrackSequences,
andthemicroARRANGERsupports8differenttracks.
DRUM and PERC are used for drum and percussion
sequences, BASS for bass and ACC15 are for accom
paniment sequences (string, guitar, piano or other
accompanimentinstruments).
Justtosummarize,whenyouplayachordonthechord
recognition area, the arranger determines which Style
Element is used, then determines which Chord Varia
tion should be used for the played chord, then Style
sequences for every track of that Chord Variation are
transposed from the original chord to the recognized
chordusingtheNTT,andsooneverytimeyouplaya
chord.
Note:TheBreak andtheCountInarenotStyleElements,
andcannotbeprogrammedbytheuser.Whileinrecord/edit,
theBREAK/COUNTINbuttondoesnotwork.
What to record
RecordingaStyleisamatterofrecordingtracks,inside
aseriesofChordVariations,insideaseriesofStyleEle
ments,insidetheStyleitself.
You dont need to record all Chord Variations for all
StyleElements.Itisoftenonlynecessarytorecordjust
a Chord Variation for each Style Element. Exceptions
are the Intro 1 and Ending 1, where we suggest to
recordbothaMajorandminorChordVariations.
STYLE IMPORT/EXPORT
You can use Korgs Style To Midi application to
exchangeStylesbetweenyourcomputerandthemicro
ARRANGER, through the Standard MIDI File (SMF)
format. The application is freely downloadable from
http://www.korgpa.com/. Please read the included
instructions.
SelectCurrentStyletoeditthecurrentStyle.Ifitis
aFactory Style, you will not be ableto saveit on
the original location; you will select a User Style
instead.
54
Note On
Note Off*
Pitch Bend
Modulation 1
TosavetheStyletotheinternalmemory,pressthe
A or B VOLUME/VALUE buttons, then press
ENTER.TheAreyousure?messagewillappear.
PressENTERtoconfirm,orEXITtoabort.
ToreturntothepreviousStyleRecordpage,leav
ing all untouched and the Style unsaved, press
EXIT.
TodeleteallchangestotheStyle,pressoneofthe
D VOLUME/VALUE buttons to select the Abort
command. The Are you sure message? will
appear.PressENTERtoconfirmdeletion,orEXIT
toreturntotheWritepage.
Style name
Modulation 2
Pan
10
Expression
11
CC#12
12
CC#13
13
Damper
64
Filter Resonance
71
74
CC#80
80
CC#81
81
CC#82
82
Not allowed
After Touch
Volume
Abort
Whenatrackisselected,youcanusethiskeysequence
to delete a single note or a single percussive instru
ment.
IftheStyleisplaying,thisshortcutdeletestheinstru
ment only while the key is kept pressed, leaving all
othernotesuntouchedwithinthetrack.
SelectthiscommandtodeleteanychangetotheStyle.
DELETE + Track
To (Style number)
WhileintheStyleTrackspage,youcandeleteawhole
trackwithasingleshortcut.KeeptheDELETEbutton
pressed, then press one of the VOLUME/VALUE but
tonscorrespondingtothetracktobedeleted.TheAre
you sure? message appear. Press ENTER to confirm,
EXITtoabort.
55
Main page
MAIN PAGE
After pressing the RECORD button, and selected the
Styletorecord/edit,theMainpageoftheStyleRecord
modeappears.
Style Play icon
Chord
Measure counter
Whenthisiconappearsinthedisplay,youareinStyle
PlayorStyleRecordmode.
Chord
RL (Recording Length)
Thisparametersetstherecordinglength(inmeasures)of
theselectedtrack.Itsvalueisalwaysequalto,oradivider
of,theChordVariationLength(seenextparameter).
ThisisnotthetotallengthoftheChordVariation,but
justofthecurrenttrack.Forexample,youmayhavea
ChordVariationeightmeasureslong,withadrumpat
ternrepeatingeachtwomeasures.Ifso,settheCVLen
parameter to 8, and the RecLen parameter to 2
beforestartingrecordingtheDrumtrack.Whensaving
theStyle,orexecutinganyeditoperationontheStyle,
the 2measures pattern will be extended to the full 8
measureslengthoftheChordVariation.
Warning: If you assign CVLen a value lower than
RecLen, the value of RecLen is not immediately
updatedinthedisplay.Therefore,youarestillfreeof
changing the value of CVLen, before the measures
exceedingitsvaluearedeleted(seewarninginCVLen
(ChordVariationLength)below).
However,ifyoupressSTART/STOPtobeginrecording,
therealRecLenvalueischangedtothenewone,evenif
thedisplaystillshowstheoldvalue.
Forexample,youmayhaveCVLen=4andRecLen=4.
IfyousetCVLento2,andpressSTART/STOPtobegin
recording,RecLenisstillshownas4,butitisinreality
set to 2, and recording will cycle for just 2 measures.
After you press START/STOP to stop recording,
RecLenisupdatedto2,andallmeasuresafterthesec
ondmeasurearedeleted.
Style name
Track in record/edit
Style name
ThisisthenameoftheStyleinrecord/edit.
Measure counter
Mosteditinginthiseditmodeareexecutedonasingle
track. While in the main page, the currently selected
track is shown on the upper right area of the display.
The abbreviations are: DR (Drums), PC (Percussion),
BS(Bass),A1A5(Accompaniment15).
To select the track to edit, press TRACK SELECT to
jump tothe Style Tackspage(see Style Tracks page
on page56) and use the VOLUME/VALUE buttons to
selectit.
E (Style Element)
UsetheAVOLUME/VALUEbuttonstoselecttheline,
andtheF1buttontoselectthisparameter.
ThisparameterletsyouselecttheStyleElementtoput
in edit. Each Style Element corresponds to one of the
buttonsonthecontrolpanelcarryingthesamename.
Note: When this parameter and the assigned value is in
smallletters(e:v1),theStyleElementisempty;whenitisin
capitals(E:V1),itisalreadyrecorded
V1V4
Variation1toVariation4
I1I2
Intro1toIntro2
F1F2
Fill1toFill2
E1E2
Ending1toEnding2
CV (Chord Variation)
UsetheAVOLUME/VALUEbuttonstoselecttheline,
andtheF2buttontoselectthisparameter.Thisparam
eter lets you select the Chord Variation to edit, after
selecting the Style Element this Chord Variation per
tainsto.
56
Metro (Metronome)
Thisisthemetronomeheardduringrecording.
Off
Nometronomeclickwillbeheardduring
recording. A onebar precount will be
playedbeforestartingrecording.
On1
Metronome on, with a onebar precount
beforestartingrecording.
On2
Metronome on, with a twobar precount
beforestartingrecording.
Resol (Resolution)
Thisparametersetsthequantizationduringrecording.
(1/32)(1/8)
Grid resolution, in musical values. For
example, when you select 1/16, all notes
are moved to the nearest 1/16 division.
When you select 1/8, all notes are moved
tothenearest1/8division.
No quantization
1/16
1/8
Meter
Thisisthemeter(timesignature)oftheStyle.Youcan
edit this parameter only when the Style is empty, i.e.
beforeyoubeginrecordinganything.
VOLUME/VALUEbuttons,tocopytheKeyofthecur
rently selected track to all other tracks of the same
ChordVariation.Thisfunctionisusefultospeeduppat
ternprogramming,andtoavoidhavingdifferenttracks
indifferentkeyswithinthesameChordVariation.
NTT
As recorded with
NTT= i-Series
(Key/Chord = CM7
)
Original Key/Chord
Style tracks
57
Program name
Meter
Meterofthecurrentmeasure.Thisparametercantbe
edited. Youcan setthe Meterinthe Main page of the
Style Record mode, before actually starting recording
(seestep6onpage58formoreinformation).
Track status
WhenintheStyleTrackspage,eachtrackcanbeinone
ofthreestatus.
Play
(Visiblestatusicon).Thisstatusisavailable
onlyfornonselectedtracks.Wheninplay,
atrackcanplaybacktherecordedpattern.
Mute
(Hidden status icon). When in this status,
you can play the track on the keyboard,
butyoucantrecordonit.Thisisusefulto
do some preliminary test, before actually
startrecording.
To set a track in mute, first select it, then
press both corresponding VOLUME/
VALUEbuttonstohidethestatusicon.To
set the track in record again, press again
thecorrespondingVOLUME/VALUEbut
tons.
Record
(Flashing status icon). When in this status,
the track is ready to record. Just select a
tracktosetitinrecordstatus.
Event to be inserted
key?
Dot(.)
Triplet(3)
Notevalue.
Augmentstheselectednotebyonehalfof
itsvalue.
Makestheselectednoteatripletnote.
V (Velocity)
Setthisparameterbeforeenteringanoteorchord.This
willbetheplayingstrength(i.e.,velocityvalue)ofthe
eventtobeinserted.
KBD
Keyboard. You can select this parameter,
by turning all counterclockwise the dial.
When this option is selected, the playing
strength of the played note is recognized
andrecorded.
1127
Velocityvalue.Theeventwillbeinserted
with this velocity value, and the actual
playingstrengthofthenoteplayedonthe
keyboardwillbeignored.
D (Duration)
Relativedurationoftheinsertednote.Thepercentage
isalwaysreferredtothestepvalue.
50%
Staccato.
85%
Ordinaryarticulation.
100%
Legato.
(a)
TIE button
(b)
Tiesthenotetobeinsertedtothepreviousnote.
REST button
Current position
Step value
Insertsarest.
NOTE VALUE buttons
Selectthestepvalue.
(a) section
START/STOP button
ExitstheStepRecordmode.
(b) section
Goestothepreviousstep,deletingtheinsertedstep.
Eventtobeinserted.Seethefollowingparametersfor
informationoneachelementofthissection.
M (Measure)
Thisisthepositionoftheevent(note,restorchord)to
beinserted.
Goestothenextmeasure,andfilltheremainingspace
withrests.
58
8.
Atthispoint,ifyouwanttodoaRealtimeRecord
ing go on reading Realtime Record procedure
below.Otherwise,ifyouprefertodoaStepRecord,
jumptoStepRecordprocedureonpage59.
Preparing to record
1. IfyouliketoeditanexistingStyle,selectthatStyle.
2. Press RECORD to enter the Style Record mode.
You are prompted to select either the Current
Style,oraNewStyle.
2.
SelectCurrentStyleifyouwanttoeditthecur
rent Style, or make a new Style starting from an
existing one. Select New Style if you want to
startfromscratchwithanemptyStyle.
After you select your preferred option, the Main
pageoftheStyleRecordmodewillappear.
3.
Ifyoulike,youcansetthetempoagainfromthis
page:justusetheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols.
AssignaProgramtoeachtrack,byusingthePRO
GRAM/PERFORMANCEsection.
Ifneeded,settheOctaveTransposeforeachtrack.
Note: The Octave Transpose will affect only the notes
comingfromthekeyboard,andnotfromthearranger.
Selectthetracktoputinrecord.Itsstatusiconwill
beginflashing.
Note: When entering the Record mode, the last
selectedtrackisalreadyinrecord.Whenyoupress
START/STOPafterenteringtheRecordmode,you
canimmediatelystartrecording.
Ifyoulike,youcantryyourpartbeforerecording:
Set the track in mute, by pressing both corre
sponding VOLUME/VALUE buttons; the status
icondisappears.
PressSTART/STOPtoplaybacktheothertracks,
ifalreadyrecorded,andpracticeonthekeyboard.
When you have finished practicing, press
START/STOPtostopthearranger,andunmutethe
trackbypressingbothVOLUME/VALUEbuttons;
thetrackwillbeinrecordagain.
While the status icon is flashing, press START/
STOP to begin recording. Depending on the
Metro(metronome)optionyouselected,a1or
2bars precount may play before the recording
actually begins. When it begins, play freely. The
pattern will last for some measures, according to
theRecLenvalue,thenrestart.
Since the recording will happen in overdub, you
can add notes on any following passage. This is
3.
4.
5.
6.
4.
5.
6.
7.
UsetheAVOLUME/VALUEbuttons,andtheF1
and F2 function keys to select the E (Style Ele
ment)andCV(ChordVariation)parameter.
Note:FormoreinformationontheStyleElementsand
ChordVariations,andtheStylestructureingeneral,see
TheStylesstructureonpage52.
Use the RL (Recording Length) parameter to set
the length (in measures) of the pattern to step
record. Select this parameter using the E VOL
UME/VALUEbuttonsandtheF4functionbutton.
UsetheTEMPO/VALUEcontrolstosetthevalue.
Use the Meter parameter to set the Styles meter.
Youcaneditthisparameteronlyifyouselectedthe
NewStyleoptionwhenenteringtheRecordmode.
Set the tempo. Keep the SHIFT button pressed,
andusetheTEMPO/VALUEcontrolstochangethe
tempo.
7.
59
2.
3.
AssignaProgramtoeachtrack,byusingthePRO
GRAM/PERFORMANCEsection.
Press START/STOP to turn on its LED and enter
theStepRecordpage.(SeeStepRecordpageon
page57formoreinformationoneachparameterof
thispage).
4.
Previous event
Event to be inserted
(a)
(b)
Current position
5.
6.
7.
Step value
Waiting for a keystroke
Thefirsttwolines(a)arethelatestinsertedevent.
The last two lines (b) are the event currently in
edit,readytobeinserted.
TheEmptyeventmarksthebeginningofthepat
tern,whentherearenoeventsinserted.Itisauto
maticallyinsertedwhenenteringtheRecordmode.
Itwillberemovedwhenaneventisinserted.
TheMaaa.bb.cccparameterin(b)isthecurrent
position. This is the place where the note in edit
willbeinserted.
If you dont want to insert a note at this posi
tion,insertarestinstead,asshowninstep7.
Tojumptothenextmeasure,fillingtheremain
ingbeatswithrests,pressthe>>button.
To change the step value, use the NOTE VALUE
buttons,onthelowerleftareaofthecontrolpanel.
Insertanote,restorchordatthecurrentposition.
To insert a single note, just play it on the key
board.Theinsertednotelengthwillmatchthestep
length. You may change the velocity and relative
duration of the note, by editing the V (Velocity)
and D (Duration) parameters. See V (Velocity)
andD(Duration)onpage57.
60
Step Time =
On
Off
Release E (continue holding C)
Press E and C
Step Time =
On
Off
Press G
Release G and C
Ex.2:
Step Time =
Step Time =
Tie
When exiting,theRTrecordingmodeisauto
maticallyselected.YoumaypressSTART/STOPto
listentotheStyle.PressSTART/STOPagaintostop
theplayback.
To enter the Step Record mode again, select the
Stprecordingmode,andpressSTART/STOP.
11. From the Main page of the Style Record mode,
pressRECORDtoexittheRecordmode.Youwill
be prompted to assign a new name to the Style,
andselectamemorylocationwheretosaveit.See
The Write window on page54 for information
onhowtosaveaStyle.
On
On
Off
Press C
Release G and C
Ex.3:
Step Time =
Step Time =
On
Press F and C
Step Time =
Step Time =
Off
Release F
On
Press G
(continue holding C)
(continue holding C)
Step Time =
Step Time =
Off
Release G
On
(continue holding C)
Step Time =
On
Press E
(continue holding C)
Off
Release D
Press D
(continue holding C)
Step Time =
Off
Release E and C
(continue holding C)
61
Menu
MENU
SelectaneditsectionfromtheMenu,and/orusethe
PAGEbuttonstoreachthedesiredpage.
PressEXITtogobacktothemainpageoftheStyle
Recordmode.
Alleditpagessharethesamestructure.
Note:WhiletheStyleisinplay,youcannotaccesstheEdit
sectionpagesfromtheMainpageandtheStyleTrackspage
(seepage55andpage56).Stoptheplaybackbeforepressing
MENU.
Page header
Page number
Note:WhenswitchingfromtheEditsectionpages(Quan
tize,Transpose,Velocity,Delete)totheotherpages,orvice
versa,theStyle(ifinplay)isautomaticallystopped.
Section name
Page name
Page number
Thisareashowsthecurrentpagenumber.
AH
EachpairofVOLUME/VALUE(AH)buttonsselectsa
different parameter of command, depending on the
editpage.Afterselectingaparameter,youcanchange
itsvaluebypressingoneofthetwobuttonsinapair,or
usingtheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols.
62
Inthispageyoucantransposetheselectedtrack(s).
Note:Aftertransposing,pleasedontforgettoreadjustthe
Original Key/Chord parameter in the Style Record page
(seepage56).
(Noneditable)Thesereadonlyparametersshowwhich
Style Element and Chord Variation are currently
selected for editing. See the Main page E (Style Ele
ment) and CV (Chord Variation) parameters on
page55 for information on selecting a different Style
ElementandChordVariation.
Trk (Track)
Usethisparametertoselectatrack.
All
Alltracksselected.
DrumAcc5Selectedtrack.
Resol (Resolution)
1/8
1/4
(Noneditable)Thesereadonlyparametersshowwhich
Style Element and Chord Variation are currently
selected for editing. See the Main page E (Style Ele
ment) and CV (Chord Variation) parameters on
page55 for information on selecting a different Style
ElementandChordVariation.
Trk (Track)
Usethisparametertoselectatrack.
All
All tracks selected, apart for tracks set in
Drum mode (like the Drum and Percus
sion tracks). The whole selected Chord
Variationwillbetransposed.
DrumAcc5Singleselectedtrack.
Value
Usetheseparameterstosetthestarting(S)andending
(E)pointsoftherangetobetransposed.
If a Chord Variation is four measures long, and you
want to select it all, the Start will be positioned at
1.01.000,andtheEndat5.01.000.
Bottom / Top
(1/32)(1/4)
Gridresolution,inmusicalvalues.Ana
afterthevaluemeansnoswing.Abf
afterthevaluemeansswingquantization.
S / E (Start/End)
Usetheseparameterstosetthestarting(S)andending
(E)pointsoftherangetoquantize.
If a Chord Variation is four measures long, and you
want to select it all, the Start will be positioned at
1.01.000,andtheEndat5.01.000.
Bottom / Top
Usetheseparameterstosetthebottomandtopofthe
keyboardrangetobetransposed.Ifyouselectthesame
noteastheBottomandTopparameters,youcanselect
asinglepercussiveinstrumentinaDrumorPercussion
track.SinceinaDrumKiteachinstrumentisassigned
toadifferentnoteofthescale,transposingapercussive
instrument means assigning the part to a different
instrument.
Note:TheseparametersareavailableonlywhenaDrumor
Percussiontrackisselected.
63
TheEventEditpageallowsyoutoediteacheventina
singletrack.SeeEventEditprocedureonpage65for
moreinformationontheeventeditingprocedure.
(Noneditable)Thesereadonlyparametersshowwhich
Style Element and Chord Variation are currently
selected for editing. See the Main page E (Style Ele
ment) and CV (Chord Variation) parameters on
page55 for information on selecting a different Style
ElementandChordVariation.
Trk (Track)
Usethisparametertoselectatrack.
All
All tracks selected. The velocity for all
notes of the whole selected Chord Varia
tionwillbechanged.
DrumAcc5Selectedtrack.
Value
Usetheseparameterstosetthestarting(S)andending
(E)pointsoftherangetobemodified.
If a Chord Variation is four measures long, and you
want to select it all, the Start will be positioned at
1.01.000,andtheEndat5.01.000.
Bottom / Top
Usetheseparameterstosetthebottomandtopofthe
keyboardrangetobemodified.Ifyouselectthesame
noteastheBottomandTopparameters,youcanselect
asinglepercussiveinstrumentinaDrumorPercussion
track.
Note:TheseparametersareavailableonlywhenaDrumor
Percussiontrackisselected.
Event Type
First value
Second value
Trk (Track)
Trackinedit.Toselectadifferenttrack,pressoneofthe
AVOLUME/VALUEbuttonstoopentheGo ToTrack
window.
UsetheTEMPO/VALUEcontrolstoselectatrack,and
pressENTERtoconfirm,orEXITtoabort.
E/CV (Style Element/Chord Variation)
Positionoftheeventshowninthedisplay,expressedin
theformaaa.bb.ccc:
aaaisthemeasure
bbisthebeat
cccisthetick(eachquarterbeat=384ticks)
Youcaneditthisparametertomovetheeventtoadif
ferentposition.
Ev (Event)
First value
Second value
Note
Note name
Velocity
Ctrl
Bend
Bending value
Tochangetheeventtype,usetheCVOLUME/VALUE
buttonstoselecttheEventline,thenusethesamebut
tonsortheTEMPO/VALUEcontrolstoselectadiffer
enteventtype.
Toselectandedittheeventsvalue,usetheF3andF4
function keys, and use the G/VOLUME/VALUE but
tonsortheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols.
64
Length
LengthoftheselectedNoteevent.Thevalueformatis
thesameasthePositionvalue.
Note:Ifyouchangealengthof000.00.000toadifferent
value, you cant go back to the original value. This rather
uncommonzerolengthvaluemaybefoundinsomedrumor
percussiontracks.
Usethesebuttonstoselectthecorrespondingparame
tervaluearea.
F-3 and F-4 buttons
TurnOffthefilterforalleventtypesyouwishtoseein
theEventEditpage.
Note: Some of the events are ghosted, and non editable,
sincethecorrespondingeventsarenoteditableinaStyle.
Note
Notes.
Ctrl
Control Change events. Only the follow
ingControlChangenumbersareallowed.
START/STOP button
PressSTART/STOPandplaysomechordsonthekey
board to test the pattern in edit. Press START/STOP
againtostopthepatternrunning.
Control function
Modulation 1
Modulation 2
KeeptheSHIFTbuttonpressedandpressthe<<or>>
buttontoopentheGotoMeasurewindow.
Pan
10
Expression(a)
11
CC#12
12
CC#13
13
Damper
64
Filter Resonance
71
74
INSERT
CC#80
80
CC#81
81
CC#82
82
DELETE
PresstheDELETEbuttontodeletetheeventshownin
thedisplay.
Bend
PitchBendevents.
65
Chord Variation
6.
7.
8.
9.
2.
3.
UsetheAVOLUME/VALUEbuttons,andtheF1
and F2 function keys to select the E (Style Ele
ment)andCV(ChordVariation)parameters.
Note:FormoreinformationontheStyleElementsand
ChordVariations,andtheStylestructureingeneral,see
TheStylesstructureonpage52.
Press MENU, and use the VOLUME/VALUE (A
H) buttons to select the Event Edit section. The
EventEditpageappears(seePage4EventEdit
onpage63formoreinformation).
PressPAGEtogobacktotheEventEditpage.
Press the A VOLUME/VALUE button (Trk), to
select the track to edit. The Go To Track window
appears.
UsetheTEMPO/VALUEcontrolstoselectatrack,
andpressENTERtoconfirm(orEXITtoabort).
Thelistofeventscontainedintheselectedtrack(in
theStyleElementandChordVariationselectedon
step2)willappearinthedisplay.Thefirststep,or
MeasureStart,iscurrentlyshown.Sinceitcontains
an initialization event, it is not editable and
appears in grey (i.e., written with a ghost
character).
Formoreinformationontheeventtypesandtheir
values,seePage4EventEditonpage63.
10. Use the B VOLUME/VALUE buttons to select the
Position line. Use these buttons or the TEMPO/
VALUEcontrolstochangetheeventsposition.
Measure
4.
5.
PressSTART/STOPtolistentotheselectedChord
Variation.Ifyoulike,playsomechordsonthekey
board, to test the pattern. Press START/STOP to
stopit.
Press PAGE+ to go to the Event Filter page, and
turnOffthefiltersfortheeventtypesyouwish
toseeinthedisplay(seePage5EventFilteron
page64formoreinformation).
Beat
Tick
11. UsetheCVOLUME/VALUEbuttonstoselectthe
Event line. You may use the C VOLUME/VALUE
buttonsortheTEMPO/VALUEcontrolstochange
the event type. Use the G VOLUME/VALUE but
tons,andtheF3andF4functionkeystorespec
tively select the first and second value of the
parameter. Use the G VOLUME/VALUE buttons
or the TEMPO/VALUE controls to modify the
selectedvalue.
Event Type
First value
Second value
66
thesamebuttons,ortheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols,
tochangetheeventslength.
Measure
Beat
Tick
(Noneditable)Thesereadonlyparametersshowwhich
Style Element and Chord Variation are currently
selected for editing. See the Main page E (Style Ele
ment) and CV (Chord Variation) parameters on
page55 for information on selecting a different Style
ElementandChordVariation.
Trk (Track)
Usethisparametertoselectatrack.
All
All tracks selected. After deletion, the
selected Chord Variation will remain
empty.
DrumAcc5Selectedtrack.
Ev (Event)
TypeofMIDIeventtodelete.
All
Allevents.Themeasuresarenotremoved
fromtheChordVariation.
Note
Allnotesintheselectedrange.
Dup.Note Allduplicatenotes.Whentwonoteswith
the same pitch are encountered on the
sametick,theonewiththelowestvelocity
isdeleted.
A.Touch
AfterTouchevents.
Note: This kind of data is automatically
removedduringrecording.
P.Bend
PitchBendevents.
PrChange Program Change events, excluding the
bundledControlChange#00(BankSelect
MSB)and#32(BankSelectLSB).
Note: This kind of data is automatically
removedduringrecording.
C.Change All Control Change events, for example
Bank Select, Modulation, Damper, Soft
Pedal
CC00/32CC127
Single Control Change events. Double
Control Change numbers (like 00/32) are
MSB/LSBbundles.
Note: Some CC data are automatically
removed during recording. See the table on
page54 for more information on the allowed
data.
67
S / E (Start/End)
Usetheseparameterstosetthestarting(S)andending
(E)pointsoftherangetodelete.
If a Chord Variation is four measures long, and you
want to select it all, the Start will be positioned at
1.01.000,andtheEndat5.01.000.
Bottom / Top
Usetheseparameterstosetthebottomandtopofthe
keyboardrangetodelete.Ifyouselectthesamenoteas
theBottomandTopparameters,youcanselectasingle
percussiveinstrumentinaDrumorPercussiontrack.
Note: These parameters are available only when the All or
Noteoptionisselected.
From Style
Del (Delete)
All
68
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2
Wheninthispage,pressthecorrespondingbuttonon
the control panel to select a Style Element
(VARIATION1ENDING2).
To copy the settings of this page to another Style Ele
ment, keep the SHIFT button pressed, and press the
buttonofthetargetStyleElement.
Value
Note:AvoidcopyingonaChordVariationwithadifferent
meter,forexamplea4/4ChordVariationontoa3/4one.
UsethisparametertosettheExpressionvalueforthe
correspondingtrack.
InthispageyoucanassignadifferentProgramtoeach
trackoftheselectedStyleElement.EachStyleElement
can have different Programs; after saving the new
Style,pleasedontforgettosettheProgparameterto
Original(seeProg(Program)onpage49),toletthe
Style select the Program bypassing the Style Perfor
mancesettings.
TheKeyboardRangeautomaticallytransposesanypat
ternnotethatwouldotherwiseplaytoohighortoolow
inpitch,comparedtotheoriginalacousticinstrument,
whentransposedbythearranger.Thiswillresultina
more natural sound for each accompaniment instru
ment.
For example, the lower limit for a guitar is E2. If you
play a chord under the E2, the transposed pattern
couldexceedthislimit,andsoundunnatural.ABottom
limitsettoE2fortheguitartrackwillsolvetheprob
lem.
Wheninthispage,pressthecorrespondingbuttonon
the control panel to select a Style Element
(VARIATION1ENDING2).
To copy the settings of this page to another Style Ele
ment, keep the SHIFT button pressed, and press the
buttonofthetargetStyleElement.
Program
UsethePROGRAM/PERFORMANCEsectiontoassign
aProgramtotheselectedtrack.
Bottom
Top
Note:TheKeyboardRangeisignoredwhilerecording.The
selectedtrackcanplayonthefullrangeofthekeyboard.
Wheninthispage,pressthecorrespondingbuttonon
the control panel to select a Style Element
(VARIATION1ENDING2).
69
Bottom/Top
In this page you can set the Retrigger mode for the
Styletracks,andactivate/deactivatetheTensionforthe
Accompanimenttracks.
Usetheseparameterstosetthebottomandtopofthe
keyboardrangeforthecorrespondingtrack.
Wheninthispage,pressthecorrespondingbuttonon
the control panel to select a Style Element
(VARIATION1ENDING2).
EF (Scroll Up), GH (Scroll Down)
Usethesebuttonstoscrolltheavailableparametersin
thedisplay.
Chords / Chord Variation
Tensionaddsnotes(a9th,11thand/or13th)thathave
actually been played to the accompaniment, even if
they havent been written in the Style pattern. This
parameter specifies whether or not the Tension
includedintherecognizedchordwillbeaddedtothe
Acc15tracks.
On
TheTensionwillbeadded.
Off
NoTensionwillbeadded.
70
TRANSPORT CONTROLS
Youcanusetheseparatetransportcontrolsforeachof
thetwoonboardsequencers.UsetheSEQ1controlsfor
Sequencer 1, and SEQ2 controls for Sequencer 2. See
SEQUENCERTRANSPORTCONTROLSSEQ1and
SEQ2onpage18formoreinformation).
Afterthefourthdigithasbeeninserted,thewindow
automaticallydisappears,andtheSongisselected.
IftheSongnumberisjust1,2or3digitlong,dialthe
number,thenpressENTERtoconfirm(forexample:
iftheSongisnumber52,dial5,2,ENTER).
Note:IfnoSongcorrespondstothedialednumber,the
Songnotavailablemessageappears.Pressanybutton
tomakeitdisappear.
MIDI CLOCK
InSongPlaymodetheMIDIClockisalwaysgenerated
bytheinternalsequencer,eveniftheClockparameter
issettoExternal(seeClockonpage127).microAR
RANGERtransmitsonlytheMIDIClockmessagegen
eratedbySequencer1.
When you enter Edit mode, you can edit the selected
sequencers parameters. Go to the main page of Song
Playmode,andselecttheS1(Abuttons)orS2(Bbut
tons) to select the sequencer you wish to edit (see
Mainpageonpage73).
71
When you enter Song Play mode from the Style Play
mode,theRealtimetracksarethesameastheStylePlay
mode. A quick way to select Programs and Effects for
theRealtimetracksischoosingadifferentPerformance.
WhileinSongPlay,pressG.QUANTIZE.Thefollowing
windowwillappear.
PressEXITtoexitthiswindow.
Enable
Enables/disablesthequantizationoftheNoteOnevent
(i.e.beginningofthenote).
NDurat (Note Duration)
Enables/disablesthequantizationoftheNoteOffevent
(i.e.thelengthofthenote).
Res (Resolution)
Coarsequantizegrillresolution.Thisparameteristhe
main quantization value, to be varied with the Acc,
SwingandWindowvalues.
(1/32)(1/4)
Grid resolution, in musical values (a 3
afterthevaluemeanstriplet).Forexam
ple, when you select 1/8, all notes are
moved to the nearest 1/8 division. When
you select 1/4, all notes are moved to the
nearest1/4division.
No quantization
1/8
1/4
Acc (Accuracy)
Asymmetryofquantization.Gridaxisaremovedtothe
nearestgridaxis.
0
Evennumbered axis are totally moved
overthepreviousoddnumberedaxis.
50
Axisareperfectlyequidistant.
72
100
Swng=25
Swng=75
Window
Areaofquantizeintervention,borderingthegridaxis.
0
The quantize window corresponds to the
axis.Noquantizationhappens.
100
Thequantizewindowextendstothenear
estwindow;alleventsarequantized.
Win=0
Win=50
Win=100
2.
PressENTERtoconfirm,orEXITtoabort.
Ifyouconfirm,theSetupissavedintotheGlobal.
YoumaythensavethisSetuponthecardtogether
withtheGlobaldata.
73
Main page
MAIN PAGE
Bar number
Page header
Measure number
Thiscountershowsthecurrentbarnumberpositionof
theselectedSong.
A (S1:SongName)
Pressedafirsttime(withaSongalreadyselected)this
buttonpairselectsSequencer1.Pressedasecondtime
(orwithnoSongselected),itopenstheSongSelection
page(seeSongSelectpageonpage74),allowingfor
selection of a single Song or a Jukebox file for
Sequencer1.
If you select another Song, while a Song is in play
within the same Sequencer, the new Song will start
playing.
Whilethisparameterisselected,youcanselectaSong
bycomposingitsprogressivenumber(seeSelectinga
Songcomposingitsprogressivenumberonpage70).
B (S2:SongName)
Pressedafirsttime(withaSongalreadyselected)this
buttonpairselectsSequencer2.Pressedasecondtime
(orwithnoSongselected),itopenstheSongSelection
page(seeSongSelectpageonpage74),allowingfor
selectionofasingleSongforSequencer2.
If you select another Song, while a Song is in play
within the same Sequencer, the new Song will start
playing.
Whilethisparameterisselected,youcanselectaSong
bycomposingitsprogressivenumber(seeSelectinga
Songcomposingitsprogressivenumberonpage70).
C (Lyrics)
Whenon,thisiconshowsthattheinstrumentisinSong
Playmode.
Page header
WhenaJukeboxfileisinplay,itsnameappearsonthe
pageheader.
Selected Sequencer
NameoftheProgramsassignedtotheRealtime(Key
board)tracks.Usethesebuttonstoselect,mute/unmute
orchangethevolumeofthecorrespondingtracks.
TRACKS 18 PAGE
Toseeandedittracks18,pressTRACKSELECTfrom
themainpage.TheTRACKSELECTLEDturnson.
PresstheTRACKSELECTbuttontwice,togobackto
themainpage.
AH (Tracks 18 Programs)
74
F-1 (SD)
Pressthisbuttonafterreplacingacardinthecardslot.
The new card will be read, and the file list shown on
thedisplaywillbeupdated.
F-2 (SELECT)
Selectstheitemonthefirstlineinthedisplay(Songor
Jukeboxfile).IfaSongisalreadyplaying,itstops,and
the new Song starts playing. You are returned to the
Mainpage.
F-3 (OPEN)
Exitfromthisdisplay,andgobacktothemainpageof
theSongPlaymode,bypressingtheEXITbutton.
WhiletheSongisplaying,thetextflowsinthedisplay,
andthechordabbreviations(ifany)willappearonthe
chords area of the display. The lyrics at the current
positionareunderlined:
AC (File, folder)
Movethe.MID,.KARor.JBXfile,orfolder,tobe
selectedtothefirstlineofthedisplay.Toselecta file,
presstheF2(SELECT)button.Toopenafolder,press
theF3(OPEN)button.
The
symbolidentifiesafolder.
EF (Scroll Up)
Scroll the list up. Keep SHIFT pressed and press one of
thesebuttonstojumptothepreviousalphabeticalsection.
A (1)
GH (Scroll Down)
Scrollthelistdown.KeepSHIFTpressedandpressone
ofthesebuttonstojumptothenextalphabeticalsection.
75
Menu
ThisletsyouplayalistofSongswithoutmultipleselec
tions.
Eachitemofthismenucorrespondstoaneditsection.
Eacheditsectiongroupsmanyeditpages.
Note:TheJukeboxfilecanbeassignedtotheSequencer
1only.
Note: To create a Jukebox file, go to the Jukebox page (see
page79).
Warning:ShouldyoudeleteaSongincludedintotheJuke
box list currently in play, the sequencer will stop, and the
No Song message will appear. At this point, press
SHIFT+>>(Seq1)togotothenextSong,andpressPLAY/
STOPagain.
Page header
Page number
Transport controls
WhenyouselectaJukeboxfile,Sequencer1transport
controlsareslightlydifferentthanwithsingleSongs.
<<and>> Pressed alone, these buttons are the
RewindandFastForwardcommands.
Keep the SHIFT button pressed,
and press these buttons to scroll to the
previousornextSongintheJukeboxlist.
PAUSE
Pauses the Song at the current position.
Press PAUSE or PLAY/STOP to start the
Songplayingagain.
PLAY/STOP Starts or stops the current Song. When
you stop the Song, the sequencer goes
backtomeasure1ofthecurrentSong.
IftheJukeboxpageisopen,youcanstart
from the Song at the first line of the dis
play.SeePage9Jukeboxonpage79.
MENU
From any page, press MENU to open the Song Play
editmenu.ThismenugivesaccesstothevariousSong
Playeditsections.
Wheninthemenu,selectasectionusingtheVOLUME/
VALUEbuttons,pressPAGE+toselectapage,orpress
EXITtoexitthemenu.
When in an edit page, press EXIT to go back to the
SongPlaymodemainpage.
Page name
Selected Sequencer
Thisareashowsthecurrentpagenumber.
AH
EachpairofVOLUME/VALUEbuttonsselectadiffer
ent parameter of command, depending on the edit
page.
76
HereyoucanadjustthepanforeachSongtrack.
Use the TRACK SELECT button to switch between
Songtracks18,Songtracks916,andbackagain.
Pan
64
+00
+63
Off
HardLeft.
Center.
HardRight.
Thedirect(uneffected)signaldoesnotgo
totheoutputs;onlytheFXsignalisheard
forthistrack.
Note:WhenplayingbackaSongthatmakesuseofallfour
effects (AD), you cant edit any effect parameter. These
parametersappeargreyedoutinthedisplay.
77
Note:WhenyoustoptheSong,orselectadifferentSong,the
defaulteffectsareselectedagain.Youcan,however,stopthe
Song,changetheeffects,thenstarttheSongagain.Editthe
SonginSongmodetopermanentlychangetheeffects.
Hereistheeditprocedure:
1. UsetheVOLUME/VALUE(AH)buttonstoselect
atrack.
2. Use the F1F4 buttons to select a parameter for
thattrack.
3. Use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the
parametersvalue.
Parameters
000
127
Noeffect.Onlythedirect(uneffected)sig
nalgoestotheoutputs.
100% effect. The direct (uneffected) and
effectedsignalsgototheoutputswiththe
samelevel.
Note:WhenplayingbackaSongthatmakesuseofallfour
effects (AD), you cant edit any effect parameter. These
parametersappeargreyedoutinthedisplay.
Note:WhenyoustoptheSong,orselectadifferentSong,the
defaulteffectsareselectedagain.Youcan,however,stopthe
Song,changetheeffects,thenstarttheSongagain.Editthe
SonginSongmodetopermanentlychangetheeffects.
A, B
EffectsassignedtotheAandBeffectprocessors.Usu
ally, A is the reverb, while B is the modulating effect
(chorus, flanger, delay). For a list of the available
effects,seeEffectsonpage175.
ModTrk (Modulating Track)
AmountoftheBeffectgoingbacktotheinputoftheA
effect.
Hereistheeditprocedure:
1. UsetheVOLUME/VALUE(AH)buttonstoselect
atrack.
2. Use the F1F4 buttons to select a parameter for
thattrack.
3. Use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the
parametersvalue.
Parameters
000
127
Noeffect.Onlythedirect(uneffected)sig
nalgoestotheoutputs.
100% effect. The direct (uneffected) and
effectedsignalsgototheoutputswiththe
samelevel.
ThispageletsyouselecttheCandDeffects.Usually,
theCeffectisareverb,whiletheDeffectisamodulat
ingeffect.
Effects C and D are usually reserved to Sequencer 2
and the Realtime tracks. You can, however, create
SongsusingallfoureffectsinSongmode.Depending
on the status of the S2 FX Mode parameter,
Sequencer 2 might also use the A/B effect pair (see
page80).
78
Note:WhenplayingbackaSongthatmakesuseofallfour
effects (AD), you cant edit any effect parameter. These
parametersappeargreyedoutinthedisplay.
Note:WhenyoustoptheSong,orselectadifferentSong,the
defaulteffectsareselectedagain.Youcan,however,stopthe
Song,changetheeffects,thenstarttheSongagain.Editthe
SonginSongmodetopermanentlychangetheeffects.
C, D
EffectsassignedtotheCandDeffectprocessors.Usu
ally, C is the reverb, while D is the modulating effect
(chorus, flanger, delay). For a list of the available
effects,seeEffectsonpage175.
ModTrk (Modulating Track)
AmountoftheDeffectgoingbacktotheinputoftheC
effect.
SeeEffectsonpage175foralistofavailableparame
tersforeacheffecttype.
Parameters
Drum
ThisisaDrum/Percussiontrack.NoMas
ter or Octave Transpose applies to this
track.
Tracks of this kind are polyphonic, i.e.
Poly
they can play more than one note at the
sametime.
Mono
Tracks of this kind are monophonic, i.e.
eachnewnotestopsthepreviousnote.
MonoRight AMonotrack,butwithpriorityassigned
totherightmost(highest)note.
79
PAGE 9 - JUKEBOX
ThispageletsyousettheInternalorExternalstatusfor
eachtrack.ItisveryusefultoletaSongtrackdrivean
externalexpander.
UsetheTRACKSELECTbuttontoswitchfromtracks
18totracks916.
TheJukeboxfunctionletsyouplayalistofSongs(127
max), at the simple touch of a button. You can play a
JukeboxfilebyselectingitintheSongSelectpage(see
PlayingaJukeboxfileonpage74),justasifitwasa
normalSong.
Parameters
Internal
External
CC#0
Both
CC#32
PC
Note:Youcansaveyour.JBXfileonlyinthesamefolder
astheSongsinthelist.
Youcancreateanewfile,oroverwriteanexistingone.
1. Movetothefirstlineofthedisplaythe.JBXfile
you wanttosave your list into. Select an existing
file if you want to overwrite it. Select the
NEW_NAME.JBXitemtocreateanewfile.
Use the EF (Scroll Up) and GH (Scroll Down)
VOLUME/VALUEbuttons,ortheTEMPO/VALUE
controlstoscrollthelist.
2. If you are making a new file, when the
NEW_NAME.JBXitemisonthefirstlineofthe
display,pressoneoftheAVOLUME/VALUEbut
tons. You are prompted to assign a name to the
selecteditem:
3.
MovethecursorusingtheDOWN/andUP/+but
tons. Select a character using the DIAL. Insert a
80
4.
F-2 (Add)
AddsaSongattheendofthecurrentlist.Youcanadd
upto127Songsinalist.
Note:AJukeboxlistcanincludeonlySongscontainedinthe
samefolder.
F-3 (Ins)
InsertsaSongatthecursorposition(i.e.,thefirstlineof
the display). All subsequent Songs are moved to the
next highernumbered slot. You can add up to 127
Songsinalist.
Note:AJukeboxlistcanincludeonlySongscontainedinthe
samefolder.
F-4 (Del)
ThiscommandletsyoudeletetheSongonthefirstline
ofthedisplay.
Pressed while keeping SHIFT pressed, the
wholeJukeboxlistisdeleted.(Theinstrumentasksfor
aconfirmationwiththeAreyousure?message;press
ENTERtoconfirm,EXITtoabort).
TheJukeboxfilenamechangestoNEW_NAME.JBX.
PAGE 10 - PREFERENCES
Inthispage,youcansetvariousgeneralparameters.
LinkMeasure
The two sequencers Tempo are linked
together.TheTempodatawrittenintothe
Songs are ignored. Adjust the Tempo
usingtheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols.
Startoneofthesequencers,bypressingits
own PLAY/STOP control. Then, start the
other sequencer, by pressing the other
PLAY/STOPcontrol;thesecondsequencer
startsatthenextmeasure.
LinkBeat The two sequencers Tempo are linked
together.TheTempodatawrittenintothe
Songs are ignored. Adjust the Tempo
usingtheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols.
Startoneofthesequencers,bypressingits
own PLAY/STOP control. Then, start the
other sequencer, by pressing the other
PLAY/STOPcontrol;thesecondsequencer
starts at the next beat (quarter or octave,
dependingontheSongsTimeSignature).
S2 FX Mode
UsetheADVOLUME/VALUEbuttonpairstoselecta
parameter.
Note: These settings are stored in the Global file. After
changingthesesettings,pressWRITEtosavethemintothe
Global. The Write Global window will appear (see The
Writewindowonpage72).
Note:Youcanalwaysstartbothsequencerssimultaneously.
StartbothsequencerssimultaneouslybykeepingSHIFTheld
downwhilepressingoneofthePLAY/STOPcontrols.
Link Mode
ThetwoonboardSequencerscanworkeachwithadif
ferent Tempo (Off), or use the same Tempo (Link
modes).
Off
The sequencers Tempo are not linked.
EachsequencerusesitsownTempo.
ThisparameterselectstheeffectsmodeforthePerfor
mance.
Off
WhenselectingaPerformance,noeffectis
selected.
CD
ThePerformanceselectstheCandDeffect
pair.
Note:WhenboththisparameterandtheS2
FXModeparameteraresettoCD,Sequencer
2 shares its effects with the Realtime (Key
board) tracks, so these effects can be changed
either selecting a Song for Sequencer 2, or
selectingaPerformance.
81
82
TRANSPORT CONTROLS
WheninBackingSequencemode,useSEQ1transport
controls (PLAY/STOP, PAUSE). See SEQUENCER
TRANSPORT CONTROLS SEQ1 and SEQ2 on
page18formoreinformation).
3.
4.
ThelastselectedStyleiscurrentlyselected.Should
itnotbetherightone,selectadifferentStyletostart
recordingwith.(SeeSelectingaStyleonpage26).
The last selected Performance or STS is currently
selected. If you prefer, select a different Perfor
mance or STS. (See Selecting a Performance on
page25, and Selecting a Single Touch Setting
(STS)onpage26).
Select the status of the Backing Sequence tracks,
usingtheG(RT)andH(Ch/Acc)buttonpairs.(RT
stays for Realtime/Keyboard; Ch/Acc stays for
Chord/Accompaniment, i.e. the Style tracks). To
recordallyouplayonthekeyboard,plustheauto
matic accompaniment, leave their status to REC
(seeRealtimeRecordingpageonpage85).
Warning:TrackssettoRECareautomaticallydeleted
when starting recording. Set a track to the PLAY sta
tus, when you dont want to delete it. For example, if
you are recording a Realtime (Keyboard) part on and
existingStyletrack,settheCh/AccparametertoPLAY,
andtheRTtracktoREC.
Start recording by pressing the left PLAY/STOP
button(ortheSTART/STOPbutton).Afteracount
in(seeMetro(Metronome)onpage85),youcan
startrecording.
5.
6.
2.
3.
4.
PressoneoftheB(LoadSong)VOLUME/VALUE
buttonstoloadaSong(seeLoadSongpageon
page84). You can load any Standard Midi File
(fileswiththe.MIDor.KARextension).
PressPLAY/STOPtostarttheplayback.
PressPLAY/STOPagaintostoptheplayback.The
playbackisautomaticallystoppedattheendofthe
Song.
7.
83
Playasolointro,orstarttheautoaccompaniment
with the START/STOP button. To start with the
Style playing right from bar 1, keep the chord
pressed during the precount, and press START/
STOP before the end of the precount. Otherwise,
the Style will start playingfrom thenext bar,fol
lowingtheonewhereyoupressedSTART/STOP.
SinceyoucanuseanyStylecontrol,youcouldstartwith
the usual combinations (INTRO, ENDING, FILL see
PlayingaStyle(AutomaticAccompaniment)on
page27formoreinformation).
Note: While in Backing Sequence mode, you cant
recordtheSYNCHRO,FADEIN/OUT,TAPTEMPO/
RESET,ACCOMPANIMENTVOLUMEcontrols.
8. Playyourmusic.YoucanevenstoptheStylebypress
ingSTART/STOP.Ifyou stoptheStylewhile record
ing,startitagainwiththeSTART/STOPbutton.
9. Whenfinishedrecordingyourperformance,press
the left PLAY/STOP button. The RECORD LED
willturnoff,andyouwillgobacktothePlayback
page(seeHowtoplaybackaSongbefore).
TherecordedSongwillbeautomaticallyconverted
totheStandardMIDIFileformat.
10. Atthispoint,youcanedittheSonginSongmode
(seeSongoperatingmodeonpage88),orsaveit
toacard(seeSaveSongpageonpage84).
Warning: The recorded Song is in RAM (Random
AccessMemory),andwillbedeletedwhenturningthe
instrument off, or entering Record again (either in
BackingSequenceorSongmode).SavetheSongtothe
card,ifyouwishtopreserveit.
3.
4.
SelecttheM(easure)parameter,andgotoadiffer
ent position into the Song, using the TEMPO/
VALUEcontrols,ortheAVOLUME/VALUE but
tons.Alternatively,youcanmovethelocatorusing
the<>and<<>>buttons.SeeTransportcontrols
onpage87.
Selecttheparametertypetoinsert,editordeleteat
thecurrentposition.Ifanarrow( )appearsnextto
aparameter,theshowneventhasbeeninsertedat
thecurrentposition.
Use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to modify the
selectedevent.DeleteitusingtheDELETEbutton.
When editing a parameter without the arrow ( )
nexttoit,aneweventisinserted.
Exit the Chord/Acc Step Mode by pressing the
RECORDbutton.
PressSTART/STOPtolistentotheresultsofyour
editing.Iftheyarefine,savetheBackingSequence
onacard.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Page header
ThisheadershowsthenameoftheselectedSong.
B (Load Song)
84
C (Save Song)
ThiscommandsavestherecordedSongasaStandard
MIDIFile.Thefileisautomaticallyaddedthe.MID
extension.Afterpressingthiscommand,theSaveSong
pageappears(seeSaveSongpageonpage84).
D (Select Tempo)
Usethesebuttonstoturnthemetronomeon/offduring
playback.
G (Meter)
ThissetstheTempochangemode.
Man(ual)
When the cursor is on the D (Select
Tempo) parameter, you can change the
Tempo using the TEMPO/VALUE section
controls. The Song will be played back
usingthemanuallyselectedtempo.
Auto
TheTemporecordedintotheSongwillbe
usedinstead.
The new card will be read, and the file list shown on the
display will be updated.
F-2 (LOAD)
LoadtheSongatthefirstlineofthedisplay.
F-3 (OPEN)
Openstheselectedfolder(filewhosenamebeginswith
the symbol).
F-4 (CLOSE)
4.
AC (File, folder)
Movethefileorfoldertobeselectedtothefirstlineof
thedisplay.Toselectafile,presstheF2(SELECT)but
ton.Toopenafolder,presstheF3(OPEN)button.
The
symbolidentifiesafolder.
5.
EF (Scroll Up)
Scrollthelistup.KeepSHIFTpressedandpressoneof
thesebuttonstojumptothepreviousalphabeticalsec
tion.
GH (Scroll Down)
Scrollthelistdown.KeepSHIFTpressedandpressone
of these buttons to jump to the next alphabetical sec
tion.
TEMPO/VALUE section
Thesecontrolsscrollthelistupordown.
F-1 (SD)
6.
MovethefolderwhereyouwishtosaveyourSong
tothefirstlineofthedisplay,usingtheEF(Scroll
Up) and GH (Scroll Down) VOLUME/VALUE
buttons,ortheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols.PressF3
(OPEN) to open it. Close the current folder by
pressingF4(CLOSE).
Whenintheselectedfolder,youcansavetheSong
overanexistingfile,orcreateanewfile.
Tooverwriteanexistingfile,moveittothefirst
lineofthedisplay.
Tocreateanewfile,movetheNEW_NAME.MID
itemtothefirstlineofthedisplay.
When the NEW_NAME.MID item is selected,
pressoneoftheAVOLUME/VALUEbuttons.You
arepromptedtoassignanametothenewfolder:
MovethecursorusingtheDOWN/andUP/+but
tons. Select a character using the DIAL. Insert a
character at the cursor position by pressing the
INSERT button. Delete a character at the cursor
positionbypressingtheDELETEbutton.
When you have finished writing a name for the
new midifile, press F2 (SAVE) to confirm. The
Are you sure? message will appear. Press
ENTERtoconfirm,orEXITtoabort.
85
Metro (Metronome)
Style
Theseparametersletyoudecidethetrackstatusduring
recording.
RT/Pads: This Backing Sequence track includes the
four Realtime (Keyboard) tracks, and the four Pads.
TheywillbeSongtracks18,asinthefollowingtable:
RT/Pad track
Song track/Channel
Upper 1
Upper 2
Upper 3
Lower
Pad 1
Pad 2
Pad 3
Pad 4
099%
ThisnoneditableparametershowstheselectedPerfor
manceorSTS(dependingonthelastitemselected).If
no Performance or STS is selected, the name will be
empty. You can select a different Performance, using
the PROGRAM/PERFORMANCE section (see Select
ing a Performance on page25). To select one of the
fourSTSforthecurrentStyle,usetheF1F4buttons.
Resol (Resolution)
1/16
1/8
Ch/Acc:ThisBackingSequencetrackincludesallStyle
tracks,includingrecognizedchords.TheywillbeSong
tracks916.
MUTE
The track is muted. If this tracks has
alreadybeenrecorded,itwillnotbeheard
during recording of the other Backing
Sequencetrack.
PLAY
The track is in play. If there are recorded
data,theywillbeheardduringrecording
oftheotherBackingSequencetrack.
REC
The track is in record. All previously
recordeddatawillbedeleted.
86
Side arrow ( )
Thisisthelocator.Itshowsthecurrentpositionofthe
Step Editor. To go to a different position within the
Song, select this parameter, then use the TEMPO/
VALUE controls, the A VOLUME/VALUE buttons, or
the<>buttons(whilethe<<>>buttonsletyoumoveto
thepreviousorfollowingmeasure).Whenusingoneof
these controls, the locator moves in steps of 1/8 (192
ticks),orjumpstothenextevent.
Thelocatorsformatisasfollows:
Measure:Measureorbarnumber.
Beat:DividerintheTimeSignatureratio(e.g.,aquar
terina3/4time).
Tick: Minimal sequencers resolution. The microAR
RANGER internal sequencers feature a resolution of
384ticksperquarter.
INSERT
When the Measure parameter is selected,
pressINSERTtoinsertameasurestarting
from the current position. All Chord/Acc
eventscontainedintothecurrentmeasure
will be moved to the following measure.
TheeventattheMxxx.xx.000position(i.e.,
exactly at the beginning of the measure,
likeaTimeSignatureorStylechange)will
notbemoved.
DELETE
When the Measure parameter is selected,
press DELETE to delete the current mea
sure. All Chord/Acc event contained into
the following measures are moved to the
currentmeasure.
SHIFT+DELETE
When the Measure parameter is selected,
pressSHIFT+DELETEtodeleteallevents
in the Style tracks, starting from the cur
rent position to the end of the Song. To
delete all events in the Style tracks, go
back to the M001.01.000 position, and
pressSHIFT+DELETE.
Note: All events on the very first tick
(M001.01.000), like Style, Tempo, Chord,
StyleElementselection,cannotbedeleted.
ThisisthelastselectedStyle.ToinsertaStylechangeat
thecurrentposition,followthestandardselectingpro
cedureusingthebuttonsoftheSTYLEsection.
Note:AnyStyleChangeinsertedafterthebeginningofthe
measure(i.e.,toapositionotherthanMxxx.01.000)willbe
effective at the following measure. For example, if a Style
ChangeeventhasbeeninsertedatM004.03.000,theselected
StylewillbeeffectivelyselectedatM005.01.000.(Thisworks
exactlyasinStylePlaymode).
Note:WheninsertingaStyleChange,youmayalsoinserta
TempoChangeatthesameposition.AStyleChangewillnot
automaticallyinserttheStylesTempo.
DELETE
WhentheStyleparameterisselected,and
the side arrow ( ) showing that a Style
Changeeventhasbeenselectedatthecur
rent position appears next to it, press
DELETEtodeletetheStyleChangeatthe
currentposition.
Note: If the side arrow doesnt appear, the
eventwasnotselectedatthecurrentposition,
andwillnotbedeleted.
SHIFT+DELETE
When the Style parameter is selected,
pressSHIFT+DELETEtodeleteallStyle
Change events, starting from the current
positiontotheendoftheSong.Todelete
all Style Change events in the Song, go
back to the M001.01.000 position, and
pressSHIFT+DELETE.
Note: All events on the very first tick
(M001.01.000), like Perf, Style, Tempo,
Chord, Style Element selection, cannot be
deleted.
Tempo
Perf
ThisistheTempoChangeparameter.ToinsertaTempo
Changeeventatthecurrentposition,selectthisparam
eterandusetheTEMPO/VALUEcontrolstochangeits
value.
DELETE
When the Tempo parameter is selected,
and the side arrow ( ) showing that a
TempoChangeeventhasbeenselectedat
Measure
Beat
Tick
87
selectingaPerformanceautomaticallyselectstheStylemem
orizedintothePerformance.
The SINGLE TOUCH and STS buttons are automatically
disabled,meaningthatyoucantchangetheRealtime(Key
board)trackswhileinChord/AccStepMode.
When the Perf parameter is selected, and
DELETE
thesidearrow( )showingthataPerfor
manceChangeeventhasbeenselectedat
the current position appears next to it,
press DELETE to delete the Performance
Changeatthecurrentposition.
Note: If the side arrow doesnt appear, the
eventwasnotselectedatthecurrentposition,
andwillnotbedeleted.
SHIFT+DELETE
WhenthePerfparameterisselected,press
SHIFT + DELETE to delete all Perfor
mance Change events, starting from the
currentpositiontotheendoftheSong.To
deleteallPerformanceChangeeventsin
theSong,gobacktotheM001.01.000posi
tion,andpressSHIFT+DELETE.
Note: All events on the very first tick
(M001.01.000), like Perf, Style, Tempo,
Chord, Style Element selection, cannot be
deleted.
SE (Style Element)
ThisistheStyleElement(i.e.,aVariation,Fill,Intro,or
Ending). The length of the selected Style Element is
alwaysshownonthemeasurecounter,atthetopofthe
display:
Transport controls
WhileinStepMode,youcanusevariouscontrolpanel
buttonstoaccomplishtheeditingprocedure.
<< or >> (Rewind or Fast Forward)
Usethesebuttonstomovetothepreviousorfollowing
measure. These commands are effective even if the
M(easure)parameterisnotselected.
< or > (Previous or Next Step)
Usethesebuttontogotothepreviousornextstep(1/8,
or192ticks).Ifaneventislocatedbeforetheprevious
ornextstep,thelocatorstopsonthatevent.Forexam
ple,ifyouarepositionedonM001.01.000,andnoevent
exists before M001.01.192, the > button moves to the
M001.01.192location.IfaneventexistsonM001.01.010,
the>buttonstopstotheM001.01.010location.
These commands are effective even if the M(easure)
parameterisnotselected.
+ < or > (Previous or Next Event)
Name
Type
Tension
Extension
KeeptheSHIFTbuttonpressedwhilepressingthe<or
> button, to move to the previous or next recorded
event.
88
TRANSPORT CONTROLS
While in Song mode, use the SEQ1 transport controls
for the Song playback. See SEQUENCER TRANS
PORT CONTROLS SEQ1 and SEQ2 on page18 for
moreinformation).
MAIN PAGE
PressSONGtoaccessthispagefromanotheroperating
mode.
Note: When switching from Style Play to Song, the Song
Setupisautomaticallyselected,andvarioustrackparameters
maychange.
Press EXIT/NO to access this page from the Menu or
anyoftheSongPlayeditpages.
ToseetheSongstracks,usetheTRKSELECTbuttonto
switchfromtheMainpagetotheTrackspages.Pressed
a first time, you will see tracks 18 (enlightened TRK
SELECT LED); a second press will show tracks 916
(flashingTRKSELECTLED);pressedagain,youwillgo
backtotheMainpage(TRKSELECTLEDswitchedoff).
Song icon
Page header
Bar number
Whenon,thisiconshowsthattheinstrumentisinSong
mode.
ThislineshowstheselectedSongname.
Page header
Bar number
Thiscountershowsthecurrentbarnumberpositionof
theselectedSong.
B (Load Song)
Usethesebuttonstoturnthemetronomeon/offduring
playback.
G (Meter)
ThissetstheTempochangemode.
89
Tracks 18 page
Man(ual)
Auto
TRACKS 18 PAGE
Toseeandedittracks18,pressTRACKSELECTfrom
themainpage.TheTRACKSELECTLEDturnson.
PresstheTRACKSELECTbuttontwice,togobackto
themainpage.
AC (File, folder)
Movethefileorfoldertobeselectedtothefirstlineof
thedisplay.Toselectafile,presstheF2(LOAD)but
ton.Toopenafolder,presstheF3(OPEN)button.
The
symbolidentifiesafolder.
EF (Scroll Up)
Scrollthelistup.
AH (Tracks 18 Programs)
GH (Scroll Down)
Scrollthelistdown.
TEMPO/VALUE section
Thesecontrolsscrollthelistupordown.
F-1 (SD)
LoadtheSongatthefirstlineofthedisplay.
F-3 (OPEN)
Openstheselectedfolder(filewhosenamebeginswith
the symbol).
F-4 (CLOSE)
90
3.
4.
5.
6.
MovethefolderwhereyouwishtosaveyourSong
tothefirstlineofthedisplay,usingtheEF(Scroll
Up) and GH (Scroll Down) VOLUME/VALUE
buttons,ortheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols.PressF3
(OPEN) to open it. Close the current folder by
pressingF4(CLOSE).
Whenintheselectedfolder,youcansavetheSong
over an existing midifile (a file with a .MID
extension),orcreateanewmidifile.
Tooverwriteanexistingmidifile,moveittothe
firstlineofthedisplay.
Tocreateanewmidifile,movethe
NEW_NAME.MIDitemtothefirstlineofthe
display.
When the NEW_NAME.MID item is selected,
pressoneoftheAVOLUME/VALUEbuttons.You
arepromptedtoassignanametothenewfile:
MovethecursorusingtheDOWN/andUP/+but
tons. Select a character using the DIAL. Insert a
character at the cursor position by pressing the
INSERT button. Delete a character at the cursor
positionbypressingtheDELETEbutton.
When you have finished writing a name for the
new midifile, press F2 (SAVE) to confirm. The
Are you sure? message will appear. Press
ENTERtoconfirm,orEXITtoabort.
3.
4.
91
5.
PressTRKSELECTtoswitchtotheSongTracks1
8page.
PressthebuttonagaintoswitchtotheSongTracks
916page.
2.
6.
Ifyoulike,youcansetthetempoagainfromthese
pages:justusetheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols.
7. AssigntherightProgramtoeachtrack.
8. Selectthetracktoputinrecord.Itsstatusiconwill
automaticallybeginflashing.
9. Whilethestatusiconisflashing,pressPLAY/STOP
to begin recording. Depending on the Metro
option you selected, a 1 or 2bars precount may
playbeforetherecordingactuallybegins.Whenit
begins,playfreely.
IfyouselectedtheAutoPunchrecordingmode,
the recording will begin only when reaching the
Startpoint.
IfyouselectedthePedalPunchrecordingmode,
pressthepedalwhenyouwanttobeginrecording.
Pressitagaintofinishrecording.
Note:ThePunchfunctionswillnotworkonanempty
Song.Atleastonetrackmustalreadyberecorded.
10. When finished recording, press PLAY/STOP to
stopthesequencer.Selectadifferenttrack,andgo
onrecordingthewholeSong.
11. When finished recording the new Song, press
RECORDtoexittheRecordmode.The Songwill
besavedinmemory.
Warning: Save the Song to a card, to avoid it is lost
whenturningtheinstrumentoff.
Note: When exiting the Record mode, the Octave
Transposeisautomaticallyresetto0.
12. Edit the new Song; press the MENU page, and
selectthevariouseditpages.
3.
UsetheAVOLUME/VALUEbuttonstoselectthe
Rec(RecordingMode)parameter.Usethesebut
tons,ortheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols,toselectthe
Step Dub (Step Overdub) or the StepOwr
(StepOverwrite)recordingmode.
The Step Overdubmode letsyou addevents to
theexistingevents.
The Step Overwrite mode will overwrite all
existingevents.
Press SEQ1 PLAY/STOP to turn its LED on, and
enter the Step Record page. (See Step Record
page on page93 for more information on each
parameterofthispage).
Previous event
Event to be inserted
(a)
(b)
Current position
Step value
4.
Thefirsttwolines(a)arethelatestinsertedevent.
Thesecondtwolines(b)aretheeventcurrentlyin
edit,readytobeinserted.
The Empty event marks the beginning of the
Song,whentherearenoeventsinserted.Itisauto
matically inserted when entering the Record
mode. It will be removed when an event is
inserted.
TheMaaa.bb.cccparameterin(b)isthecurrent
position. This is the place where the note in edit
willbeinserted.
If you dont want to insert a note at this posi
tion,insertarestinstead,asshowninstep6.
92
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Tojumptothenextmeasure,fillingtheremain
ingbeatswithrests,pressthe>>button.
To change the step value, use the NOTE VALUE
buttons,onthelowerleftareaofthecontrolpanel.
Insertanote,restorchordatthecurrentposition.
To insert a single note, just play it on the key
board.Theinsertednotelengthwillmatchthestep
length. You may change the velocity and relative
duration of the note, by editing the V (Velocity)
and D (Duration) parameters. See V (Velocity)
andD(Duration)onpage94.
To insert a rest, just press the REST button. Its
lengthwillmatchthestepvalue.
Totiethenotetobeinsertedtothepreviousone,
presstheTIEbutton.Anotewillbeinserted,tied
to the previous one, with exactly the same name.
Youdontneedtoplayitonthekeyboardagain.
Toinsertachordorasecondvoice,seeChords
andsecondvoicesbelow.
After inserting a new event, you may go back by
pressing the < button. This will delete the previ
ouslyinsertedevent,andsetthestepineditagain.
Whenfinishedrecording,pressSEQ1PLAY/STOP
to turn off its LED. The Main page of the Song
Recordmodeappearsagain.
Setthisparametertoselectarecordingmode.
Overdub
Thenewlyrecordedeventswillbemixed
toanyexistingevents.
Overwrite The newly recorded events will replace
anyexistingevents.
AutoPunch Recordingwillautomaticallybeginatthe
Sposition,andstopattheEposition
(seethefollowingline).
Note:TheAutoPunchfunctionwillnotwork
on an empty Song. At least one track must
alreadyberecorded.
PedalPunch Recording will begin when pressing a
pedalsettothePunchIn/Outfunction,
and will finish when pressing the same
pedalagain.
Note:ThePedalPunchfunctionwillnotwork
on an empty Song. At least one track must
alreadyberecorded.
StepDub
Step Overdub. This recording mode lets
you enter events one at a time, adding
eventstotheexistingevents.
StepOwr
StepOverwrite. Thisrecordingmodelets
you enter events one at a time, overwrit
ingallexistingevents.
Trk (Track)
Trackinrecord.
116
One of the 16 tracks selected. To select a
track,gototheTrackpages(seeTracks1
8 page on page89 and Tracks 916
pageonpage89).
S/E (Start/End)
WithmicroARRANGER,youarenotobligedtoinsert
singlenotesinatrack.Thereareseveralwaystoinsert
chords and double voices. For more information, see
theChordsandsecondvoicesinStepRecordmode
sectiononpage60oftheStyleRecordmodechapter.
TheseparametersappearonlywhentheAutoPunch
recording mode is selected. They set the starting and
endingpointsofthePunchrecording.
Metro (Metronome)
Thisisthemetronomeheardduringrecording.
Off
Nometronomeclickwillbeheardduring
recording. A onebar precount will be
playedbeforestartingrecording.
On1
Metronome on, with a onebar precount
beforestartingrecording.
Metronome on, with a twobar precount
On2
beforestartingrecording.
93
Resol (Resolution)
Event to be inserted
(a)
(b)
No quantization
Current position
1/16
Step value
(a) section
1/8
Meter
Thisparametersetsthewaytempoeventsareread.
Record
All Tempo changes made during record
ingwillberecordedtotheMasterTrack.
Auto
The Sequencer plays back all recorded
Tempoevents.NonewTempoeventsare
recorded.
Manual
The latest manual Tempo setting (made
using the TEMPO/VALUE controls) is
considered the current Tempo value. No
Tempo change will be recorded. This is
very useful to record the Song much
slowerthanitsactualTempo.
Eventtobeinserted.Seethefollowingparametersfor
informationoneachelementofthissection.
M (Measure)
Thisisthepositionoftheevent(note,restorchord)to
beinserted.
Meter
Meterofthecurrentmeasure.Thisparametercantbe
edited.YoucansetaMeterchangebyusingtheInsert
functionoftheEditmenu,andinsertinganewseriesof
measures with a different Meter (see Page 22 Edit:
InsertMeasuresonpage101).
key?
Dot(.)
Triplet(3)
Notevalue.
Augmentstheselectednotebyonehalfof
itsvalue.
Makestheselectednoteatripletnote.
V (Velocity)
Setthisparameterbeforeenteringanoteorchord.This
willbetheplayingstrength(i.e.,velocityvalue)ofthe
eventtobeinserted.
KBD
Keyboard. You can select this parameter,
by turning all counterclockwise the dial.
When this option is selected, the playing
strength of the played note is recognized
andrecorded.
94
1127
Velocityvalue.Theeventwillbeinserted
with this velocity value, and the actual
playingstrengthofthenoteplayedonthe
keyboardwillbeignored.
D (Duration)
Relativedurationoftheinsertednote.Thepercentage
isalwaysreferredtothestepvalue.
50%
Staccato.
85%
Ordinaryarticulation.
100%
Legato.
MENU
Whileinanypage,pressMENUtoopentheSongedit
menu.ThismenugivesaccesstothevariousSongedit
sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section using the
VOLUME/VALUE (AH) buttons, select an edit page
usingPAGE+,orpressEXITtoexitthemenu.
When in an edit page, press EXIT to go back to the
mainpageoftheSongoperatingmode.
Tiesthenotetobeinsertedtothepreviousnote.
REST button
Insertsarest.
NOTE VALUE buttons
Selectthestepvalue.
SEQ1 PLAY/STOP button
ExitstheStepRecordmode.
< (Previous step)
Goestothepreviousstep,erasingtheinsertedevent.
>> (Fast Forward)
Goestothenextmeasure,andfilltheremainingspace
withrests.
Eachiteminthismenucorrespondstoaneditsection.
Eacheditsectiongroupsvariouseditpages.
Page header
Page number
Song icon
Page name
Page
Thisareashowsthecurrentpagenumber.
95
AH
EachpairofVOLUME/VALUEbuttonsselectadiffer
ent track, parameter of command, depending on the
editpage.
Track status icons
Aseriesoficonsneareachtrackshowthetracksstatus.
Selected track or parameter. When this
symbol appears, you can execute any
availableoperationontheselecteditem.
(noicon)
Trackinplayoralreadyrecorded.
The track is in mute, or does not contain
data.
64
+00
+63
Off
HardLeft.
Center.
HardRight.
Thedirect(uneffected)signaldoesnotgo
totheoutputs;onlytheFXsignalisheard
forthistrack.
96
This page lets you set the level of the tracks direct
(uneffected) signal going to the A and B, or C and D
Internal FX pair. Go to the previous page (Page 3
Mixer:FXBlock)toselectanFXpair.
UsetheTRACKSELECTbuttontoswitchfromtracks
18totracks916.
Thispageiswhereyoucansetthefinetuningforeach
track.
Use the TRACK SELECT button to switch between
Songtracks18,Songtracks916,andbackagain.
Detune
Hereistheeditprocedure:
1. UsetheVOLUME/VALUE(AH)buttonstoselect
atrack.
2. Use the F1F4 buttons to select a parameter for
thattrack.
3. Use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the
parametersvalue.
Parameters
000
127
Thisisthefinetuning.
64
Lowestpitch.
0
Standardtuning.
+63
Highestpitch.
Noeffect.Onlythedirect(uneffected)sig
nalgoestotheoutputs.
100% effect. The direct (uneffected) and
effectedsignalsgototheoutputswiththe
samelevel.
Scale
ParameterrequiredforsomeScales,whenyoushould
setapreferredkey.
Note
Notedetune,comparedtothestandardEqualtuning.This
parametercanbeaccessedwhenaUserScaleisselected.
97
Note:WhenyoustoptheSong,orselectadifferentSong,the
defaulteffectsareselectedagain.Youcan,however,stopthe
Song,changetheeffects,thenstarttheSongagain.Savethe
Songtopermanentlychangetheeffects.
A, B
EffectsassignedtotheAandBeffectprocessors.Usu
ally, A is the reverb, while B is the modulating effect
(chorus, flanger, delay). For a list of the available
effects,seeEffectsonpage175.
ModTrk (Modulating Track)
AmountoftheBeffectgoingbacktotheinputoftheA
effect.
Note:WhenyoustoptheSong,orselectadifferentSong,the
defaulteffectsareselectedagain.Youcan,however,stopthe
Song,changetheeffects,thenstarttheSongagain.Editthe
SonginSongmodetopermanentlychangetheeffects.
EffectsassignedtotheCandDeffectprocessors.Usu
ally, C is the reverb, while D is the modulating effect
(chorus, flanger, delay). For a list of the available
effects,seeEffectsonpage175.
C, D
AmountoftheDeffectgoingbacktotheinputoftheC
effect.
98
SeeEffectsonpage175foralistofavailableparame
tersforeacheffecttype.
Hereistheeditprocedure:
1. UsetheVOLUME/VALUE(AH)buttonstoselect
atrack.
2. UsetheF1F4buttonstoselectasoundparame
ter, or its value. (For the Drum and Percussion
tracks,seebelowtheDrumtrackssection).
3. Use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change the
soundparameteroritsvalue.
Parameters
Attack
Attacktime.Thisisthetimeduringwhich
thesoundgoesfromzero(atthemoment
when you strike a key) to its maximum
level.
Decay time. Time to go from the final
Decay
AttackleveltothebeginningoftheRelease.
Release
Release time. This is the time during
whichthesoundgoesfromthesustaining
(or Decay) phase, to zero. The Release is
triggeredbyreleasingakey.
Cutoff
Filter cutoff. This sets the sound bright
ness.
Resonance Use the Filter Resonance to define the
width of the frequency range affected by
theFilter.
VibratoRate SpeedoftheVibrato.
VibratoDepth
IntensityoftheVibrato.
VibratoDelay
DelaytimebeforetheVibratobegins,after
thesoundstarts.
99
Drum tracks
WhenatrackissetinDrumMode(liketheDrumand
Percussiontracks),youcanadjustthevolumeforeach
oftheDrumandPercussioncategories.
KickV
Kickdrumsvolume.
SnareV
Snaredrumsvolume.
TomV
Tomsvolume.
HiHatV
HiHatvolume.
CymbalV Ride,Crashandothercymbalsvolume.
Percus1V
Classicpercussionsetvolume.
Percus2V
Ethnicpercussionsetvolume.
SFXV
Specialeffectsvolume.
Reset
Poly
PressENTER/YEStoresetthecurrentlyselectedtrack.
KeepSHIFTpressed,andpressENTER/YES,toresetall
tracks. Press EXIT/NO to abort and leave all parame
tersunchanged.
Parameters
Internal
External
Parameters
Drum
ThisisaDrum/Percussiontrack.NoMas
ter or Octave Transpose applies to this
track. You can set a different volume for
each class of percussive instruments
(Page14Track:Easyeditonpage98).
CC#0
Both
CC#32
PC
100
HereyoucantransposetheSong,atrackorapartofa
track.
Trk (Track)
Trk (Track)
Usethisparametertoselectatrack.
All
Alltracksselected.
116
Selectedtrack.
Usethisparametertoselectatrack.
All
Alltracksselected(apartforDrumtracks).
116
Selectedtrack.
Resol (Resolution)
Value
Valueofthetranspose(insemitones).
No quantization
S / E (Start/End)
Usetheseparameterstosetthestarting(S)andending
(E)pointsoftherangetotranspose.
Ifyouwishtoselectafourmeasuresequencestarting
at the beginning of the Song, the Start will be posi
tionedat1.01.000,andtheEndat5.01.000.
Bottom / Top
1/8
1/4
(1/32)(1/4)
Gridresolution,inmusicalvalues.Ana
afterthevaluemeansnoswing.Abf
afterthevaluemeansswingquantization.
Usetheseparameterstosetthebottomandtopofthe
keyboard range to transpose. If you select the same
noteastheBottomandTopparameters,youcanselect
asinglepercussiveinstrumentinaDrumtrack.
S / E (Start/End)
Usetheseparameterstosetthestarting(S)andending
(E)pointsoftherangetoquantize.
Ifyouwishtoselectafourmeasuresequencestarting
at the beginning of the Song, the Start will be posi
tionedat1.01.000,andtheEndat5.01.000.
Bottom / Top
Usetheseparameterstosetthebottomandtopofthe
keyboardrangetoquantize.Ifyouselectthesamenote
astheBottomandTopparameters,youcanselectasin
glepercussiveinstrumentinaDrumtrack.
Note: These parameters are available only when a Drum
trackisselected.
Usethisparametertoselectatrack.
All
Alltracksselected.
116
Selectedtrack.
Value
Velocitychangevalue.
101
S / E (Start/End)
Usetheseparameterstosetthestarting(S)andending
(E)pointsoftherangetoedit.
Ifyouwishtoselectafourmeasuresequencestarting
at the beginning of the Song, the Start will be posi
tionedat1.01.000,andtheEndat5.01.000.
Bottom / Top
Usetheseparameterstosetthebottomandtopofthe
keyboardrangetoedit. Ifyouselect the samenote as
theBottomandTopparameters,youcanselectasingle
percussiveinstrumentinaDrumtrack.
Ifyouwishtoselectafourmeasuresequencestarting
at the beginning of the Song, the Start will be posi
tionedat1.01.000,andtheEndat5.01.000.
Bottom / Top
Usetheseparameterstosetthebottomandtopofthe
keyboardrangetodelete.Ifyouselectthesamenoteas
theBottomandTopparameters,youcanselectasingle
percussiveinstrumentinaDrumtrack.
Note: These parameters are available only when the All or
Noteoptionsareselected.
AfterselectingtheStartandLengthparameters,press
ENTER to execute. The Are you sure? message will
appear.PressENTERtoconfirm,EXITtoabort.
Afterthecut,thefollowingmeasurearemovedback,to
fillthecutmeasures.
Trk (Track)
Start
Usethisparametertoselectatrack.
All
Alltracksselected.
116
Selectedtrack.
Master
Master track. This is where the Tempo,
ScaleandEffecteventsarerecorded.
Firstmeasurewheretobegincutting.
Ev (Event)
Length
Numberofmeasurestobecut.
TypeofMIDIeventtodelete.
All
All events. The measures will not be
removedfromtheSong.
Note
Allnotesintheselectedrange.
Dup.Note Allduplicatenotes.Whentwonoteswith
the same pitch are encountered on the
sametick,theonewiththelowestvelocity
isdeleted.
A.Touch
AfterTouchevents.
PitchBendevents.
P.Bend
PrChange Program Change events, excluding the
bundledControlChange#00(BankSelect
MSB)and#32(BankSelectLSB).
C.Change All Control Change events, for example
Bank Select, Modulation, Damper, Soft
Pedal
CC00/32CC127
Single Control Change events. Double
Control Change numbers (like 00/32) are
MSB/LSBbundles.
InthispageyoucaninsertmeasuresintheSong.You
canalsousethisfunctiontoinsertmeasureswithadif
ferentmeter(timesignature).
S / E (Start/End)
Start
Usetheseparameterstosetthestarting(S)andending
(E)pointsoftherangetodelete.
Firstoftheinsertedmeasures.
AfterselectingtheMeter,StartandLengthparameters,
pressENTERtoexecute.TheAreyousure?message
willappear.PressENTERtoconfirm,EXITtoabort.
Note:YoucannotappendmeasuresaftertheendoftheSong.
ToappendmeasuresusetheRecordorCopyfunction.
Note:YoucannotusethisfunctiononanemptySong.
Meter
Meterofthemeasurestobeinserted.
Length
Numberofmeasurestobeinserted.
102
Hereyoucancopytracksorphrases.
EnterthispagefromtheMenuoftheSongmode.The
EventEditpageallowsyoutoediteacheventinasin
gle track. See Event Edit procedure on page104 for
moreinformationontheeventeditingprocedure.
UsethisparametertoselecttheCopymode.
Merge
Copied data are merged with the data at
thetargetposition.
Overwrite Copied data replace all data at the target
position.
Warning:Deleteddatacannotberecovered!
Event Type
First value
Second value
Trk (Track)
Trackinedit.Toselectadifferenttrack,pressoneofthe
AVOLUME/VALUEbuttonstoopentheGo ToTrack
window.
UsetheTEMPO/VALUEcontrolstoselectatrack,and
pressENTERtoconfirm,orEXITtoabort.
116
One of the ordinary tracks of the Song.
These tracks contains musical data, like
notesandcontrollers.
Master
This is a special track, containing Tempo
changes,Meterchanges,Scale andTrans
posedata,andtheeffectparameters.
S/E
Position
Positionoftheeventshowninthedisplay,expressedin
theformaaa.bb.ccc:
aaaisthemeasure
bbisthebeat
cccisthetick(eachquarterbeat=384ticks)
Youcaneditthisparametertomovetheeventtoadif
ferentposition.
Numberoftimesthecopymustbeexecuted.
Ev (Event)
First value
Second value
Note
Note name
Velocity
Prog
Ctrl
Bend
Bending value
Aftt
PAft
103
AndherearetheeventscontainedintheMastertrack.
Event
First value
Second value
Tempo
Tempo change
Volume
change(a)
KeeptheSHIFTbuttonpressedandpressthe<<or>>
buttontoopentheGotoMeasurewindow.
Meter
Meter
Scale
UScale (User
Scale)
SHIFT + PAUSE
QT (Quarter Tone)
Altered note
Note alteration(b)
FXType
Effect number(c)
FXSend
Feedback send
level
Tochangetheeventtype,usetheCVOLUME/VALUE
buttonstoselecttheEventline,thenusethesamebut
tonsortheTEMPO/VALUEcontrolstoselectadiffer
enteventtype.
Toselectandedittheeventsvalue,usetheF3andF4
function keys, and use the G/VOLUME/VALUE but
tonsortheTEMPO/VALUEcontrols.
Whilethesequencerisrunning,keeptheSHIFTbutton
pressed, and press the PAUSE button to display the
eventthatiscurrentlyplaying.ThisiscalledtheCatch
Locatorfunction.
INSERT
PresstheDELETEbuttontodeletetheeventshownin
thedisplay.
Length
LengthoftheselectedNoteevent.Thevalueformatis
thesameasthePositionvalue.
Note:Ifyouchangealengthof000.00.000toadifferent
value, you cant go back to the original value. This rather
uncommonzerolengthvaluemaybefoundinthedrumand
percussiontracksofSongsmadeinBackingSequencemode.
Usethesebuttonstoselectthecorrespondingparame
tervaluearea.
F-3 and F-4 buttons
TurnOnthefilterforalleventtypesyoudonotwishto
seeintheEventEditpage.
Note
Notes.
Prog
ProgramChangevalues.
Ctrl
ControlChangeevents.
T/Meter
Tempo and Meter changes (Master Track
only).
Aftt
Mono(Channel)Aftertouchevents.
PAft
PolyAftertouchevents.
Bend
PitchBendevents.
PaCtl
Controls exclusive of the microAR
RANGER, like the FX and Scale settings.
ThesecontrolsarerecordedtotheMaster
Track, and saved as System Exclusive
data.
104
8.
Formoreinformationontheeventtypesandtheir
values,seePage24EventEditbelow.
Use the B VOLUME/VALUE buttons to select the
Position line. Use these buttons or the TEMPO/
VALUEcontrolstochangetheeventsposition.
Measure
9.
4.
5.
6.
7.
PressSEQ1PLAY/STOPtolistentotheSong.Press
SEQ1PLAY/STOPagaintostopit.
Press PAGE+ to go to the Event Filter page, and
turnOffthefilterfortheeventtypesyouwishto
seeinthedisplay(seePage25EventFilteron
page103formoreinformation).
PressPAGEtogobacktotheEventEditpage.
Press the A VOLUME/VALUE button (Trk), to
select the track to edit. The Go To Track window
appears.
UsetheTEMPO/VALUEcontrolstoselectatrack,
andpressENTERtoconfirm(orEXITtoabort).
The list of events contained in the selected track
willappearinthedisplay.
Tick
UsetheCVOLUME/VALUEbuttonstoselectthe
Event line. You may use the C VOLUME/VALUE
buttonsortheTEMPO/VALUEcontrolstochange
the event type. Use the G VOLUME/VALUE but
tons,andtheF3andF4functionkeystorespec
tively select the first and second value of the
parameter. Use the G VOLUME/VALUE buttons
or the TEMPO/VALUE controls to modify the
selectedvalue.
Event Type
3.
Beat
First value
Second value
Measure
Beat
Tick
105
Main page
MAIN PAGE
HereisthemainpageoftheProgramoperatingmode.
Tempo
Program icon
Page header
gram.Valuesareinthestandard0127MIDInumber
ingformat.
Note:Somemanufacturerscouldusethe1128numbering
system; when connecting your microARRANGER to an
instrumentofthiskind,incrementthePCvalueby1unit.
Effects
In Program mode, the Program uses its own effects
insteadofrelyingonADeffects.Twoeffectprocessors
(FX1andFX2)areavailable.
Program icon
Whenturnedon,thisiconshowsthattheinstrumentis
inProgrammode.
Page header
ThisisthetempoofSequencer1.TheTempoisoneof
the AMSs (see AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)
listonpage123).UsetheSHIFT+DIALcombination
tochangeit.
A (Group)
microARRANGERfeaturestwodifferentkindsofPro
grams:
Sound Programs. These are normal instrument
Programs,likepianos,strings,basses.
Drum Programs. These are drum and percussion
kits,whereeachnoteofthekeyboardisadifferent
percussive instrument. You can find Drum Pro
gramsintheDRUMKITandUSERDKbanks.
Before pressingMENUto enterthe editenvironment,
you should select a Program of the type you wish to
editorcreate.
Notes pointing to special Drum Program features are
markedbythe icon.
MENU
WhileinanyotherpageoftheProgramoperativemode,
pressMENUtoopentheProgrameditmenu.Thismenu
givesaccesstothevariousProgrameditsections.
When in the menu, select an edit section using the
VOLUME/VALUE (AG) buttons, select an edit page
usingPAGE+,orpressEXITtoexitthemenu.
When in an edit page, press EXIT to go back to the
mainpageoftheProgramoperatingmode.
B (CC00)
Eachiteminthismenucorrespondstoaneditsection.
Eacheditsectiongroupsvariouseditpages.
106
ERASE PROGRAM/OSCILLATOR
Youcaninitializeanyparametervalue,byusingone
ofthefollowingshortcuts:
Oscillator in edit
Page number
Parameters value
Program icon
ThispageappearswhenyoupresstheWRITEbutton.
Here you can save the Program into a User Program
locationinmemory.
Whenswitchedon,thisiconshowsthattheinstrument
isinProgrammode.
Page header
Theheadershowsthenameofthecurrenteditpage.
Oscillator in edit
Thisareashowsthecurrentpagenumber.
Parameters
1. Selectanameandalocation,thenpressENTERto
savetheProgram.
2. The Are you sure? message appears. Press
ENTERtoconfirm,orEXITtoabort.
Warning:IfyouwriteoveranexistingUserProgram,
theProgramwillbedeletedandreplacedbytheoneyou
aresaving(overwrite).Pleasesavetocard anyPro
gramyoudontwanttolose.
Name
UsetheBVOLUME/VALUEbuttonstoselectadiffer
ent User Program location in memory. Otherwise,
select this parameter and use the VOLUME/VALUE
controlstoselectthelocation.
Note:YoucantsaveoveraFactoryProgramlocation.
107
Page 1 - Basic
PAGE 1 - BASIC
HereyoucanmakebasicsettingsfortheProgram,such
asbasicoscillatorsettings,theoscillatorcount,andthe
polyphonicmode.
ThisparameterisavailablewhentheModeparame
terissettoMono.Itspecifieswhichnotewillbegiven
priority to play when two or more notes are played
simultaneously.
Low
Lowestnotewilltakepriority.
High
Highestnotewilltakepriority.
Last
Lastnotewilltakepriority.
Oscillators
Mode
ThisisthepolyphonicmodeoftheProgram.
Poly
The Program will play polyphonically,
allowingyouplaychords.
Mono
The Program will play monophonically,
producingonlyonenoteatatime.
Single Trigger
ThisparameterisavailablewhentheModeparame
terissettoPoly.
Yes
Whenthesamenoteisplayedrepeatedly,
the previous note will be silenced before
thenextnoteissounded,sothatthenotes
donotoverlap.
No
Whenthesamenoteisplayedrepeatedly,
the previous note will not be silenced
beforethenextnoteissounded.
Legato
ThisparameterisavailablewhentheModeparame
terissettoMono.
Yes
Legato is on. When multiple noteons
occur, the first noteon will retrigger the
sound, and the second and subsequent
noteonswillnotretrigger.
Whenlegatoison,multiplenoteonswill
not retrigger the voice. If one note is
alreadyonandanothernoteisturnedon,
thefirstvoicewillcontinuesounding.The
oscillator sound, envelope, and LFO will
not be reset, and only the pitch of the
oscillator will be updated. This setting is
effectiveforwindinstrumentsoundsand
analogsynthtypesounds.
No
Legatoisoff.Noteswillalwaysberetrig
geredwhennoteonoccurs.
Whenlegatoisoff,multiplenoteonswill
retrigger the voice at each noteon. The
Usethisparametertoselectanoscillatortoputinedit.
Alternatively,youcanselectoscillatorsusingtheF1F
4buttons.
MS Hi/Lo Bank/Num
Usetheseparameterstoselectadifferentmultisample
foreachoftheHighandLowlayers.Youcanuseveloc
ity to switch between the two multisamples. Reverse,
OffsetandLevelcanbeadjustedindependentlyforthe
HighandLowmultisamples.
Thefirstlineshowsthebank(ROM),whilethesecond
line is for selecting the multisample. The Program
numberappearsattheendofthesecondline.
Themultisampleyouselectfor theHighlayerwillbe
triggered by velocities higher than the value of the
Velocity Switch parameter (see page108). If you do
notwishtousevelocityswitching,settheswitchtoa
valueof001,andselectonlytheHighmultisample.
Note: Each multisample has an upper limit, and may not
producesoundwhenplayedabovethatlimit.
[H/L] Reverse
Themultisamplewillbeplayedinreverse.Inthecase
ofFlashROMmultisamplesthatwereoriginallyspeci
fied to loop, the multisample will be played back in
oneshotreversemode.Ifthemultisamplewasorigi
nallysettoreverse,itwillplaybackwithoutchange.
Yes
Themultisamplewillplaybackinreverse.
No
Themultisamplewillplaybacknormally.
108
[H/L] Level
Hereyoucanspecifythevelocityrangefortheselected
oscillator.
Note:YoucannotsettheBottomVelocityhigherthantheTop
Velocity,northeTopVelocitylowerthantheBottomVelocity.
0127
Assignedvelocity.
Octave
Usethisparametertoadjustthepitchofthesamplein
onecentsteps(asemitoneis100cents)overarangeof
1octave.
1200+1200
Finetunevalueincents.
Delay (ms)
Thisparametersetsadelaytimefromthenoteontothe
real beginning of the sound. With a setting of KeyOff,
thesoundwillbeginwhennoteoffoccurs.Thisisuse
ful to create sounds such as the click that is heard
whenaharpsichordnoteisreleased.Inthiscase,setthe
SustainLevelparameterto0(seepage115).
KeyOff
The sound will begin when the note is
released.
05000
Delaytimeinmilliseconds.
Key
Usethisparametertoturnthesampleon/off.
Yes
Thesampleisassignedtotheselectedkey.
No
The sample is not assigned. The sample
assignedtothenexthighestassignedkey
isusedinstead.
MS Hi/Lo Bank/Num
Usetheseparameterstofinetunetheassignedsample.
0
Nofinetuning.
99+99
Finetuning value in cents (1/100 of a
semitone).
[H/L] Reverse
Theseparameterssetthecutofffrequencyforthefilter
appliedtotheselectedsample.
[H/L] Resonance
Theseparametersareanoffsettotheselectedsamples
EGAttack.
109
Page 3 - Pitch
[H/L] Decay
Theseparametersareanoffsettotheselectedsamples
EGDecay.
Velocity Switch
PAGE 3 - PITCH
Here you can make pitch settings for each oscillator.
Thesesettingsspecifyhowkeyboardlocationwillaffect
thepitchofeachoscillator,andselectthecontrollersthat
will affect the oscillator pitch and specify the depth of
control.Youcanalsospecifytheamountofpitchchange
produced by the Pitch EG and by LFO1 and LFO2,
switchportamentoon/offandspecifyhowitwillapply.
Selected
Usethisparametertoselectanoscillatortoputinedit.
Alternatively,youcanselectoscillatorsusingtheF1F
4buttons.
Slope
Normallyyouwillleavethisparameterat+1.0.Positive
(+)valueswillcausethepitchtoriseasyouplayhigher
notes,andnegative()valueswillcausethepitchtofall
asyouplayhighernotes.
Withavalueof0,therewillbenochangeinpitch,and
theC4pitchwillsoundregardlessofthekeyboard
locationyouplay.
ThediagramshowshowthePitchSlopeandpitchare
related:
Pitch
+2
+1
2oct
Exclusive Group
Thisparametersetsthepositioninthestereopanorama
oftheselectedkey.
Send FX1
1oct
1oct
1
C4 C5
1.0+2.0
Key
Pitchslopevalue.
JS (+X)
110
Pitch modulation
Portamento Time
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effectproducedbyAMS.Withasettingof0,nomod
ulation will be applied. With a setting of 12.00, the
pitchwillchangeuptooneoctave.
Forexample,ifyousetAMStoJoystick+Yandpush
thejoystick,thepitchwillriseifthisparameterissettoa
positive(+)value,orfallifthisparameterissettoaneg
ative()value.Therangeisamaximumofoneoctave.
12.00+12.00
Parametervalue.
Pitch EG modulation
Selected
EG Intensity
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
modulation that the pitch EG specified on Page 6
Pitch EG will apply to the pitch. With a setting of
12.00,thepitchwillchangeamaximumof1octave.
12.00+12.00
Parametervalue.
Usethisparametertoselectanoscillatortoputinedit.
Alternatively,youcanselectoscillatorsusingtheF1F
4buttons.
Intensity
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effectthatjoystickmovementinthe+Ydirection(away
from yourself) will have on the pitch modulation
appliedbytheLFO1.
Asthisvalueisincreased,movingthejoystickinthe+Y
directionwillcausetheLFO1toproducedeeperpitch
modulation. With a setting of 12.00 a maximum of 1
octaveofpitchmodulationwillbeapplied.Negative(
)valueswillinverttheLFOwaveform.
12.00+12.00
Joystickactiondepth.
Note-on
Note-off
Softly played
(Intensity (Pitch EG) setting)
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
Portamento
Portamento
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effectthatAMSwillhave.Withasettingof0,modula
tionwillnotbeapplied.Withasettingof12.00,theLFO1
willapplyamaximumof1octaveofpitchmodulation.
Negative()settingswillinverttheLFOwaveform.
ForexampleifAMSissettoJoystick+Yandpushthe
joystick,apositive(+)settingofthisparameterwillcause
thepitchmodulationcreatedbyLFO1tobeappliedwith
the normal phase, and a negative () setting will cause
theLFOtobeappliedwithinvertedphase.
111
TheLFO1Intensity,JS+YandAMSsettingswill
be added to determine the depth and direction of the
pitchmodulationappliedbyLFO1.
12.00+12.00
Parametervalue.
Attack Level
Specifiestheamountofpitchchangewhentherelease
timehaselapsed.
Attack/Decay/Release Time
InthispageyoucansettheLFO2modulationparame
ters for the selected oscillator. See Page 4 Pitch
LFO1forinformationonthevariousparameters.
Theseparametersspecifythetimeoverwhichthepitch
changewilloccur.
099
Parametervalue.
Attack Time
PAGE 6 - PITCH EG
HereyoucanmakesettingsforthepitchEG,whichcre
atestimevariantchangesinthepitchoftheoscillators.
The depth of pitch change produced by these EG set
tings on the oscillators is adjusted by the Intensity
(AMS1/2Intensity)parameter(seepage111).
Note-on
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
Note-off
Theseparametersselectthesourcethatwillcontrolthe
pitchEGLevelparameters(AMS(AlternateModu
lationSource)listonpage123).
Pitch envelope
Note-on
0 = pitch when
key is held
(sustained)
Start Level
Time
Release Level
Attack
Time
Decay
Time
99 = approximately 1 octave
Release Time
Start/Attack/Decay/Release Level
Theseparametersspecifytheamountofpitchchange.
Theactualamountofpitchchangewilldependonthe
Intensity (AMS1/2 Intensity) parameter (see below).
For example, with an Intensity setting of +12.00, a
Levelsettingof+99wouldraisethepitchoneoctave,
andaLevelsettingof99wouldlowerthepitchone
octave.
Parametervalue.
99+99
Start Level
Specifiestheamountofpitchchangeatnoteon.
112
PAGE 7 - FILTER
Here youcanmakesettingsfor thefiltersthatwill be
used by the oscillators. You can select either a 24 dB/
octave low pass filter with resonance, or a series con
nection of a 12 dB/octave low pass filter and a 12 dB/
octavehighpassfilter.
Note-on
Note-off
Note-on
Note-off
Selected
Note-off
Usethisparametertoselectanoscillatortoputinedit.
Alternatively,youcanselectoscillatorsusingtheF1F
4buttons.
A note played softly with Attack A note played strongly with
Ti
S i
tt + d
Att k Ti S i
tt +
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effectthatAMSwillhaveontheTimeparameters.
With a setting of 0, the pitch EG times will be just as
specifiedbytheAttack/Decay/ReleaseTimesettings.
Thealternatemodulationvalueatthemomentthatthe
EGreacheseachpointwilldeterminetheactualvalue
oftheEGtimethatcomesnext.
Forexample,thedecaytimewillbedeterminedbythe
alternate modulation value at the moment that the
attacklevelisreached.
Whenthisparameterissettovaluesof16,33,49,66,82,
or99,thespecifiedEGtimeswillspeedupasmuchas
2,4,8,16,32,or64timesrespectively(orsloweddown
to1/2,1/4,1/8,1/16,1/32,or1/64oftheoriginaltime).
ForexampleifAMSissettoVelocity,increasingthe
absolute value of Intensity will allow strongly
played notes to increase the changes in pitch EG
Timevalues.Thedirectionofthechangeisspecified
byAttackTimeSwingandDecayTimeSwing.As
you play more softly, the pitch EG times will more
closelyapproachtheactualsettingsofthepitchEG.
99+99
Parametervalue.
Attack Time Swing
Filter Type
Thisparameterselectsthetypeoffilter(LowPassRes
onant,LowPass&HighPass)fortheselectedoscilla
tor. When the Low Pass & High Pass filter type is
selected,thefilterBwillbeactivated.
Low Pass Resonance: 24 dB/octave low
pass filter with resonance
Low Pass & High Pass: 12 dB/octave
low pass filter and 12 dB/octave high pass
filter in series
Trim
0099
Cutofffrequencyvalue.
Resonance A
113
Resonance modulation
Selected
Usethisparametertoselectanoscillatortoputinedit.
Alternatively,youcanselectoscillatorsusingtheF1F
4buttons.
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effect that AMS (Alternate Modulation Source) will
have on the resonance level specified by Resonance
A.
For example if Velocity has been selected, changes in
keyboardvelocitywillaffecttheresonance.
Withpositive(+)values,theresonancewillincreaseas
you play more strongly, and as you play more softly
theresonancewillapproachthelevelspecifiedbythe
Resonancesetting.
Withnegative()values,theresonancewilldecreaseas
you play more strongly, and as you play more softly
theresonancewillapproachthelevelspecifiedbythe
Resonancesetting.
TheresonancelevelisdeterminedbyaddingtheRes
onanceandIntensity(AMSIntensity)values.
99+99
Parametervalue.
Thesesettingsspecifykeyboardtrackingforthecutoff
frequency of the filter for the selected oscillator. The
way in which the cutoff frequency is affected by the
keyboard location you play can be specified by the
Tracking Low, Tracking High, Ramp Low and
RampHighparameters.
C1G9
Lowest/Highestnoteintherange.
Tracking Low
Thisparameterspecifiestheangleofkeyboardtracking.
99+99
Anglevalue.
Here is how cutoff frequency is affected by keyboard
location and the Ramp setting (Intensity to A and
IntensitytoB=+50):
Cutoff frequency
High Ramp=+99
High Ramp=+62
High Ramp=0
High Ramp=43
Low Ramp=+99
Filter B
Low Ramp=+43
Low Ramp=0
ThisparameterspecifiesthecutofffrequencyoffilterB.
ThisparameterwillbedisplayedwhenFilterTypeis
settoLowPass&HighPass.
Low Ramp=62
Low Key
High Key
Key
Low Ramp=99
Ramp Low
Ramp High
High Pass
Level
This filter cuts the low-frequency range that
lies below the cutoff frequency. By cutting
the lower overtones, it lightens the tone.
12dB/oct
Frequency
0099
High Ramp=99
Cutofffrequencyvalue.
WhenFilterTypeisLowPassResonance,parameters
forfilterBwillnotbeeditable(greyedout).
114
Filter EG modulation
Intensity to B
Note-on
Note-on
Note-off
Softly played
Note-off
Strongly played
Setting to +
Note-off
Strongly played
Setting to
Velocity to A
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effect that velocity will have on the timevarying
changes created by the filter EG (as set on Page 11
FilterEG)tocontrolthefilterAcutofffrequency.
With positive (+) values, playing more strongly will
causethefilterEGtoproducegreaterchangesincutoff
frequency. With negative () values, playing more
stronglywillalsocausethefilterEGtoproducegreater
changesincutofffrequency,butwiththepolarityofthe
EGinverted.
99+99
ValueoftheVelocitytoAparameter.
Velocity to B
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effect that velocity will have on the timevarying
changes createdbythefilterEGtocontrolthefilter B
cutofffrequency(seeVelocitytoA).
99+99
ValueoftheVelocitytoBparameter.
EG Intensity to A
Specifiesthedepthanddirectionoftheeffectthatthe
timevarying changes created by the filter 1 EG will
haveonthefilterAcutofffrequency.
With positive (+) settings, the sound will become
brighter when the EG levels set by Filter EG Level
andTimeparametersareinthe+area,anddarker
whentheyareinthearea.
With negative () settings, the sound will become
darkerwhentheEGlevelssetbyFilterEGLeveland
Time parameters are in the + area, and brighter
whentheyareinthearea.
99+99
Parametervalue.
Specifiesthedepthanddirectionoftheeffectthatthe
selectedsourcewillhave(seeIntensityonpage114).
EG Intensity to B
Specifiesthedepthanddirectionoftheeffectthatthe
timevaryingchangescreatedbythefilterEGwillhave
on the filter B cutoff frequency (see EG Intensity to
A).
99+99
Parametervalue.
EG AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)
Selectsthesourcethatwillcontrolthedepthanddirec
tion of the effect that the timevarying changes pro
ducedbythefilterEGwillhaveonthecutofffrequency
of filters A and B. See AMS (Alternate Modulation
Source)listonpage123.
Intensity to A
Selected
Usethisparametertoselectanoscillatortoputinedit.
Alternatively,youcanselectoscillatorsusingtheF1F
4buttons.
Intensity to A
115
Intensity to B
Specifythedepthanddirectionofthemodulationthat
LFO1willhaveonthecutofffrequencyoffilterB(see
IntensitytoA).
Change in cutoff
Low setting
99+99
PAGE 11 - FILTER EG
Here you can make settings for the EG that will pro
duce timevarying changes in the cutoff frequency of
filtersAandBfortheselectedoscillator.Thedepthof
theeffectthatthesesettingswillhaveonthefiltercut
off frequency is determined by the Velocity and
Intensityparameters.
High setting
Parametervalue.
Joystick Y to A
BymovingthejoystickintheYdirection(towardyour
self),youcancontrolthedepthatwhichLFO1modu
lates the cutoff frequency of filter A. This parameter
specifiesthedepthanddirectionofthecontrol.
Highersettingsofthisparameterwillproducegreater
increases in the effect of LFO1 on the filter when the
joystickismovedtowardyourself.
99+99
Parametervalue.
Joystick Y to B
BymovingthejoystickintheYdirection(towardyour
self),youcancontrolthedepthatwhichLFO1modu
lates the cutoff frequency of filter B. This parameter
specifies the depth and direction of the control (see
JoystickYtoA).
Selected
Usethisparametertoselectanoscillatortoputinedit.
Alternatively,youcanselectoscillatorsusingtheF1F
4buttons.
Filter envelope
Attack Level
Note-on
The specified
cutoff
frequency
Selectasourcethatwillcontrolthedepthanddirection
ofcutofffrequencychangeforbothfiltersAandB.See
AMS(AlternateModulationSource)list.
Intensity to A
Note-off
Sustain Level
Release
Level
Break
Point
Level
Start
Level
Attack
Time
Decay
Time
Time
Slope
Time
Release
Time
Start/Attack/Break/Sustain/Release Level
Thisparameterspecifiesthechangeincutofffrequency
atthetimeofnoteon.
Attack Level
Adjuststhedepthofthecyclicmodulationappliedby
LFO2(setonPage18LFO2)tothecutofffrequency
offiltersAandB.Formoreinformationontheparame
tersseePage9FilterLFO1onpage114.
Sustain Level
Thisparameterspecifiesthechangeincutofffrequency
aftertheattacktimehaselapsed.
Thisparameterspecifiesthechangeincutofffrequency
afterthedecaytimehaselapsed.
Thisparameterspecifiesthechangeincutofffrequency
that will be maintained from after the slope time has
elapseduntilnoteoffoccurs.
Release Level
Thisparameterspecifiesthechangeincutofffrequency
thatwilloccurwhenthereleasetimehaselapsed.
Attack/Decay/Slope/Release Time
Theseparametersspecifythetimeoverwhichthefilter
changewilloccur.
099
Timevalue.
116
Attack Time
Note-on
Note-off
Decay Time
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
Thisparameterspecifiesthetimeoverwhichthelevel
willchange afterthe decay time has elapsed until the
sustainlevelisreached.
Release Time
Thisparameterspecifiesthetimeoverwhichthelevel
willchangeafternoteonoccursuntilthereleaselevel
isreached.
Note-on
Note-off
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
ThisparameterspecifiesthedirectioninwhichAMS
willaffectStartLevel.WhenIntensityhasaposi
tive (+) value, a setting of + for this parameter will
allow AMS to raise the EG level, and a setting of
willallowAMStolowertheEGlevel.Withasetting
of0therewillbenochange.
Attack Level Swing
ThisparameterspecifiesthedirectioninwhichAMS
willaffectAttackLevel.WhenIntensityhasaposi
tive (+) value, a setting of + for this parameter will
allow AMS to raise the EG level, and a setting of
willallowAMStolowertheEGlevel.Withasetting
of0therewillbenochange.
Break Level Swing
ThisparameterspecifiesthedirectioninwhichAMS
willaffectBreakPointLevel.WhenIntensityhasa
positive(+)value,asettingof+forthisparameterwill
allow AMS to raise the EG level, and a setting of
willallowAMStolowertheEGlevel.Withasetting
of0therewillbenochange.
AMS1/2(T)
Usethisparametertoselectthesourcethatwillcontrol
the Time parameters of the filter EG. See AMS
(AlternateModulationSource)listonpage123.
Intensity
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effectthatAMS1/2(T)willhave.
Forexample,ifAMS1/2(T)issettoFltKTr+/+,theEG
TimeparameterswillbecontrolledbytheKeyboard
Tracking settings. With positive (+) values of this
parameter,positive(+)valuesofRampwilllengthen
the EG times, and negative () values of Ramp will
shortentheEGtimes.Thedirectionofchangeisspeci
fied by Attack Time Swing, Decay Time Swing,
SlopeTimeSwing,andReleaseTimeSwing.
Withasettingof0,thetimesspecifiedbyFrequencyA
(CutoffFrequencyA)willbeused.
IfAMS1/2(T)issettoVelocity,positive(+)valuesof
thisparameterwillcauseEGtimestolengthenasyou
playmorestrongly,andnegative()valueswillcause
EGtimestoshortenasyouplaymorestrongly.
99+99
Intensityvalue.
Attack Time Swing
ThisparameterspecifiesthedirectioninwhichAMS1/
2(T)willaffecttheattacktime.Withpositive(+)values
of Intensity, setting this parameter to + will allow
AMStolengthenthetime,andsettingthisparameterto
willallowAMStoshortenthetime.Withasettingof
0therewillbenochange.
Decay Time Swing
ThisparameterspecifiesthedirectioninwhichAMS1/
2(T)willaffectthedecaytime.Withpositive(+)values
of Intensity, setting this parameter to + will allow
AMStolengthenthetime,andsettingthisparameterto
willallowAMStoshortenthetime.Withasettingof
0therewillbenochange.
Slope Time Swing
ThisparameterspecifiesthedirectioninwhichAMS1/
2(T)willaffecttheslopetime.Withpositive(+)values
of Intensity, setting this parameter to + will allow
AMStolengthenthetime,andsettingthisparameterto
willallowAMStoshortenthetime.Withasettingof
0therewillbenochange.
Release Time Swing
ThisparameterspecifiesthedirectioninwhichAMS1/
2(T)willaffectthereleasetime.Withpositive(+)val
uesofIntensity,settingthisparameterto+willallow
AMStolengthenthetime,andsettingthisparameterto
willallowAMStoshortenthetime.Withasettingof
0therewillbenochange.
117
Page 12 - Amp
PAGE 12 - AMP
Thesesettingsallowyoutoapplymodulationtoamp
(foreachoscillator)tomodulatethevolume.
Selected
Selected
Usethisparametertoselectanoscillatortoputinedit.
Alternatively,youcanselectoscillatorsusingtheF1F
4buttons.
Usethisparametertoselectanoscillatortoputinedit.
Alternatively,youcanselectoscillatorsusingtheF1F
4buttons.
Level
Volumeoftheselectedoscillator.
Note:ThevolumeofaProgramcanbecontrolledbyCC#7
(volume)and#11(expression).Theresultinglevelisdeter
mined by multiplying the values of CC#7 and #11. The
GlobalMIDIchannelisusedforcontrol.
0127
Volumelevel.
Pan
Pan(stereoposition)oftheselectedoscillator.
This parameter is not available when editing a Drum
Program. Use the individual Pan control for each key
(seePanonpage109).
Random
The sound will be heard from a different
locationateachnoteon.
L001
Placesthesoundatfarleft.
C064
Placesthesoundinthecenter.
R127
Placesthesoundtofarright.
Note:ThiscanbecontrolledbyCC#10(panpot).ACC#10
valueof0or1willplacethesoundatthefarleft,avalueof
64willplacethesoundatthelocationspecifiedbythePan
settingforeachoscillator,andavalueof127willplacethe
soundatthefarright.ThisiscontrolledontheglobalMIDI
channel.
Theseparametersspecifytheangleofkeyboardtrack
ing.
99+99
Anglevalue.
Here is an example of volume changes produced by
keyboardlocationandRampsettings:
Volume
Pan modulation
AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)
Ramp Low=+99
Ramp High=+99
Ramp Low=0
Ramp High=0
Ramp Low=99
Ramp High=99
Intensity
Key Low
Key High
Key
Ramp Low
Withpositive(+)valuesofthisparameter,thevolume
will increase as you play notes below the Tracking
Low note number. With negative () values, the vol
umewilldecrease.
Ramp High
Withpositive(+)valuesofthisparameter,thevolume
willincreaseasyouplaynotesabovetheKeyHigh
notenumber.Withnegative()values,thevolumewill
decrease.
118
Amplifier Modulation
Intensity
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effect that LFO1 will have on the volume of the
selected oscillator. Negative () values will invert the
LFOwaveform.
99+99
Intensityvalue.
Note-off
Softly played
99+99
Note-on
Note-off
Strongly played
Intensityvalue.
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effectthatAMSwillhave.Theactualvolumewillbe
determined by multiplying the value of the changes
producedbytheampEGwiththevaluesofAlternate
Modulation etc., and if the levels of the amp EG are
low, the modulation applied by Alternate Modulation
willalsobeless.
Forexample,ifAMSissettoJoystick+Y,positive(+)
values of this parameter will cause the volume to
increasewhenyoupushthejoystick.HoweveriftheEG
settingsetc.havealreadyraisedthevolumetoitsmaxi
mumlevel,thevolumecannotbeincreasedfurther.
Withnegative()valuesofthisparameter,thevolume
willdecreasewhenthejoystickispushed.
99+99
Intensityvalue.
PAGE 16 - AMP EG
Selected
Selected
Usethisparametertoselectanoscillatortoputinedit.
Alternatively,youcanselectoscillatorsusingtheF1F
4buttons.
Usethisparametertoselectanoscillatortoputinedit.
Alternatively,youcanselectoscillatorsusingtheF1F
4buttons.
119
Page 16 - Amp EG
Amp envelope
Amplifier EG
Note-on
Note-off
Attack Level
Note-on
Break Point
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
Sustain
Level
Start
Level
Attack
Time
Note-on
Note-off
Volume
Time
Decay Slope
Time Time
Release Time
Theseparametersaretheleveloftheenvelopesegment.
099
Levelvalue.
Thisparameterspecifiesthesourcethatwillcontrolthe
Level parameters of the amp EG. See AMS (Alter
nateModulationSource)listonpage123.
Start Level
Intensity
Thisparameterspecifiesthevolumelevelatnoteon.If
youwantthenotetobeginataloudlevel,setthistoa
highvalue.
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effectthatAMS willhave. For example,if AMS is
Velocity, setting Start Level Swing, Attack Level
SwingandBreakPointLevelSwingto+andsetting
Intensity to a positive (+) value will cause the amp
EG volume levels to increase as you play more
strongly. Setting Intensity to a negative () values
willcausetheampEGvolumelevelstodecreaseasyou
playmorestrongly.Withasettingof0,thelevelswill
beasspecifiedonPage16AmpEG.
99+99
Intensityvalue.
Start/Attack/Break/Sustain/Release Level
Attack Level
Theseparametersspecifythetimeoverwhichthevol
umechangewilloccur.
099
Timevalue.
ThisparameterspecifiesthedirectioninwhichAMS
willchangeStartLevel.IfIntensityissettoaposi
tive (+) value, setting this parameter to + will allow
AMStoincreasetheEGlevel,andsettingthisparame
tertowillallowAMStodecreasetheEGlevel.Witha
settingof0,nochangewilloccur.
Attack Time
Thisparameterspecifiesthetimeoverwhichthevolume
willchangeafternoteonuntilitreachestheattacklevel.
Ifthestartlevelis0,thiswillbetherisetimeofthesound.
ThisparameterspecifiesthedirectioninwhichAMS
willchangeAttackLevel.IfIntensityissettoapos
itive (+) value, setting this parameter to + will allow
AMStoincreasetheEGlevel,andsettingthisparame
tertowillallowAMStodecreasetheEGlevel.Witha
settingof0,nochangewilloccur.
Attack/Decay/Slope/Release Time
Decay Time
ThisparameterspecifiesthedirectioninwhichAMS
willchangeBreakLevel.IfIntensityissettoapos
itive (+) value, setting this parameter to + will allow
AMStoincreasetheEGlevel,andsettingthisparame
tertowillallowAMStodecreasetheEGlevel.Witha
settingof0,nochangewilloccur.
120
Theseparametersletyouuseanalternatemodulation
sourcetomodifytheampEGtimesthatwerespecified
inAttack/Decay/Slope/ReleaseTimeonpage119.
Amp 1 EG changes (Time)
(AMS=Amp KTrk +/+, Intensity = a positive (+) value)
(When Amp Keyboard Track Low Ramp= a positive (+) value, and
High Ramp = a positive (+) value)
Note-on
Note-on
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
Note-off
Note-on
Note-off
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
Thisparameterspecifiesthedirectionoftheeffectthat
AMS1 will have on Slope Time. With positive (+)
values of Intensity, setting this parameter to + will
allow AMS1 to lengthen the time, and setting it to
willallowAMS1toshortenthetime.Withasettingof0
therewillbenoeffect.
Release Time
Thisparameterspecifiesthedirectionoftheeffectthat
AMS1willhaveonReleaseTime.Withpositive(+)
values of Intensity, setting this parameter to + will
allow AMS1 to lengthen the time, and setting it to
willallowAMS1toshortenthetime.Withasettingof0
therewillbenoeffect.
AMS2 (Alternate Modulation Source 2)
Thisparameterspecifiesthesourcethatwillcontrolthe
Time parameters of the amp EG (see AMS (Alter
nateModulationSource)listonpage123).Withaset
tingofOff,therewillbenomodulation.
Intensity
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effect that AMS1 will have. For example, if
AMS1(T) is Amp KTrk +/+, the (Amp) Keyboard
Track settings (see Amplifier keyboard tracking on
page117)willcontroltheEGTimeparameters.With
positive(+)valuesofthisparameter,positive(+)values
of Ramp (Ramp Setting) will cause EG times to be
lengthened, and negative () values of Ramp (Ramp
Setting) will cause EG times to be shortened. The
direction of the change is specified by Attack Time
Swing, Decay Time Swing, Slope Time Swing,
andReleaseTime.
When AMS1(T) is Velocity, positive (+) values will
causeEGtimestolengthenasyouplaymorestrongly,
andnegative()valueswillcauseEGtimestoshorten
asyouplaymorestrongly.Withasettingof0,theEG
times will be as specified by the Amp envelope
parameters(seepage119).
Attack Time Swing
Thisparameterspecifiesthedirectionoftheeffectthat
AMS1willhaveonAttackTime.Withpositive(+)
values of Intensity, setting this parameter to + will
allow AMS1 to lengthen the time, and setting it to
willallowAMS1toshortenthetime.Withasettingof0
therewillbenoeffect.
PAGE 17 - LFO1
Inthisandthenextpageyoucanmakesettingsforthe
LFOthatcanbeusedtocyclicallymodulatethePitch,
Filter, and Amp of each oscillator. There are two LFO
units for each oscillator. By setting the LFO1 or LFO2
Intensity to a negative () value for Pitch, Filter, or
Amp,youcaninverttheLFOwaveform.
Wave
Triangle
90
Triangle
Random
Saw
Step Triangle 4
Triangle wave
Step Triangle 6
Step Saw 4
Step Saw 6
Sawtooth down
Saw
180
Square
Square wave
Sine
Sine wave
Guitar
Guitar vibrato
Exponential
Triangle
Thisparameterspecifiesthedirectionoftheeffectthat
AMS1willhaveonDecayTime.Withpositive(+)
values of Intensity, setting this parameter to + will
allow AMS1 to lengthen the time, and setting it to
willallowAMS1toshortenthetime.Withasettingof0
therewillbenoeffect.
Exponential
Saw Down
Exponential
Saw Up
Random1 (S/H):
Conventional sample & hold (S/H) in which the
level changes randomly at fixed intervals of
time
Random2 (S/H):
Both the levels and the time intervals will
change randomly.
Random3 (S/H):
The maximum level and minimum level will
alternate at random intervals of time (i.e., a
square wave with random period).
Random4 (Vector)
Random5 (Vector)
Random6 (Vector)
These types cause Random 13 to change
smoothly. They can be used to simulate the
instability of acoustic instruments etc.
Frequency
SettheLFOfrequency.Asettingof99isthefastest.
0099
Frequencyrate.
121
Page 17 - LFO1
Key Sync
Base Note/Times
ThisparameterspecifiesiftheLFOissynchronizedto
keystrokes.
On
The LFO will start each time you play a
note, and an independent LFO will oper
ateforeachnote.
Off
The LFO effect that was started by the
firstplayed note will continue to be
applied to each newlyplayed note. (In
thiscase, DelayandFadewill beapplied
onlytotheLFOwhenitisfirststarted).
WhenMIDI/TempoSyncisOn,theseparametersset
anotelengthrelativeto(Tempo)andthemultiple
(Times) that will be applied to it. These parameters
willdeterminethefrequencyoftheLFO1.Forexample
ifBaseNoteis(quarternote)andTimesis04,the
LFOwillperformonecycleeveryfourbeats.
Even if you change the (Tempo) setting of
Sequencer 1, the LFO will always perform one cycle
everyfourbeats.
Offset
offset = 99
offset = 0
offset = +99
Offsetvalue.
Delay
Note-off
Fade
Delay
0099
Times
Frequency modulation
Youcanusetwoalternatemodulationsourcestoadjust
thespeedoftheLFO1fortheselectedoscillator.
AMS1(F) (Alternate Modulation Source1)
Pitch at note-on
99+99
Base Note
Faderate.
Thisparameterenables/disablestheLFOsynchroniza
tionwithSequencer1Tempo.
The LFO frequency will synchronize to
On
thetempo(MIDIClock)ofSequencer1.In
thiscase,thevaluesyouspecifiedforFre
quency (see page120) and Frequency
modulation (see page121) will be
ignored.
Selectsthesourcethatwilladjustthefrequencyofthe
selectedoscillatorLFO1(seeAMS(AlternateModula
tionSource)listonpage123).LFO1canbemodulated
byLFO2.
Intensity (AMS1 Intensity)
Thisparameterspecifiesthedepthanddirectionofthe
effectthatAMS1(F)willhave.Whenthisparameteris
set to a value of 16, 33, 49, 66, 82, or 99, the LFO fre
quencybeingcanbeincreasedbyamaximumof2,4,8,
16,32,or64timesrespectively(ordecreasedby1/2,1/4,
1/8,1/16,1/32,or1/64respectively).
Forexample,ifAMS1(F)isNoteNumber,positive(+)
valuesofthisparameterwillcausetheoscillatorLFOto
speedupasyouplayhighernotes.Negative()values
willcausetheoscillatorLFOtoslowdownasyouplay
higher notes. This change will be centered on the C4
note.
If AMS1(F) is set to JS +Y, raising the value of this
parameter will cause the oscillator LFO1 speed to
increase as the joystick is moved away from yourself.
With a setting of +99, moving the joystick all the way
away from yourself will increase the LFO speed by
approximately64times.
99+99
Intensityvalue.
AMS2(F) (Alternate Modulation Source2)
Intensity (AMS2 Intensity)
Makesettingsforasecondalternatemodulationsource
that will adjust the frequency of the oscillator LFO1
(seeaboveAMS1(F)(AlternateModulationSource1)
andIntensity(AMS1Intensity)).
122
PAGE 18 - LFO2
HereyoucanmakesettingsfortheLFO2,whichisthe
secondLFOthatcanbeappliedtotheselectedoscilla
tor.SeePage17LFO1formoreinformationonthe
parametersvalue.
HoweverinFrequencymodulation,theLFOcannot
be selected as a modulation source in AMS1 or
AMS2.
PAGE 19 - EFFECTS
HereyoucanselecttwoeffectsforthewholeProgram,
switchthemon/off,andspecifychaining.
Usethisparametertosendtheoutputofeffect2tothe
inputofeffect1.
000127
Level of the signal exiting the effect 2
goingbacktotheeffect1.
Send to Master
Usetheseparameterstoselecttheeffecttypeforeffect
1/2.SeetheEffectschapterformoreinformation.
Note:If000:NoEffectisselected,theoutputfromthemas
tereffectwillbemuted.
Send
Sendlevelforeacheffect.
123
Pitch EG
Pitch EG
Filter EG
Amp EG
LFO1
LFO2
Note Number
Note number
Velocity
Velocity
Polyphonic After Touch (transmitted from the microARRANGER only as sequence data)
Joystick X
Joystick +Y
Joystick Y
(a)
Ass.Pedal
CC#18
CC#18
CC#17
CC#17
CC#19
CC#19
CC#20
CC#20
CC#21
CC#21
Damper
CC#65
Sostenuto
CC#80
CC#80
CC#81
CC#81
CC#82
CC#82
CC#83
CC#83
Tempo
(a) After Touch data can only be received via MIDI, or create as a MIDI event in Song Record-Step Recording mode.
+/
+/+
0/+
124
+/0
Amp
Ramp Low
= +50
Ramp High
= +50
Note Number
+ max
AMS = Amp KTrk +/+
AMS Intensity = positive (+) value
zero
Depth and direction of modulation
- max
+ max
AMS = Amp KTrk +/
AMS Intensity = positive (+) value
zero
+ max
AMS = Amp KTrk 0/+
AMS Intensity = positive (+) value
zero
Depth and direction of modulation
- max
+ max
AMS = Amp KTrk +/0
AMS Intensity = positive (+) value
zero
Depth and direction of modulation
- max
125
Whilethispageisonthedisplay,pressENTERtwice.
Theparametersare saved tothe FlashROM,andwill
stayinmemoryevenwhenturningtheinstrumentoff.
MENU
From any page, press MENU to open the Global edit
menu. This menu gives access to the various Global
editpages.
When in this menu, select a section using the VOL
UME/VALUEbuttons,pressPAGE+toselectapage,or
pressEXITtoexitthemenu.
Wheninapage,pressEXITtogobacktocurrentoper
ating mode (Style Play, Song Play, Song, Backing
Sequence).
Thisparameterisneededbysomescalestosetthepre
ferredkey(seeScaleonpage44).
Speakers
Thisparameterturnstheinternalspeakersonoroff.
Note: Speakers are always turned on again each time you
turntheinstrumenton.
Met.Vol (Metronome Volume)
Volumeofthemetronome.
40127
Relativevolume,fromminimumtomaxi
mum.
AutoOff
Thisparametersetstheautopoweroffsetting.
Yes
The power will automatically turn off if
you dont play the keyboard or operate
the instruments buttons for a period of
fourhours.
No
Autopoweroffwillnotoccur.
126
PreOSC
ThispageiswhereyoucanturntheMasterTranspose
onoroff.
Whenthisoptionisselected,allnotesare
transposedimmediatelybeforetheyenter
theinternaltonegenerator.Therefore,the
Scalewillbeappliedbeforetransposition.
Forexample,ifyoualteredanE,andthen
settheMasterTransposeto+1,thealtered
keywillstillbeE(thatwillplayanaltered
F).
Scale
Style/Realtime
ThisisaflagtoturntheMasterTransposeonoroffon
theStyleandRealtime(Keyboard)tracks.
Off
No Master Transpose is applied to the
StyleandRealtimetracks.
Sync
Sync mode. When you press either the
TRANSPOSE [] or [] buttons, the new
transposesettingwillnottakeeffectuntil
the first beat of the next measure is
reached.TheRealtimetrackssoundingat
thetimeofthetransposewillbestopped.
RTime
Realtimemode.Whenyoupresseitherthe
TRANSPOSE [] or [] buttons, the new
transposesettingwilloccurwhenthenext
noteisplayedforboththeStyleandReal
time tracks individually. (Note that any
notes sounding from the Realtime tracks
will be stopped when you press the
TRANSPOSE button) The next key or
chordyoupresswillsoundwiththenew
transposesetting.(Notethatifyouplaya
Realtime track prior to a new chord, the
Realtimetrackwillplayinthenewkeyas
the Style will continue to play in the old
keyuntilanewchordisentered).
Transpose
Tone
generator
Seepage225foralistoftheassignablefunctions.The
first functions are switchtype functions, while the
remaining(startingfromMasterVolume)arecontinu
ouslikefunctions.
P/S (Pedal/Switch)
FunctionassignedtotheASSIGNABLESLIDERonthe
frontpanel.
Damper Pol. (Damper Polarity)
Seq 1/2
PolarityoftheDamperpedal.
ThisisaflagtoturntheMasterTransposeonoroffon
thetwoonboardSequencerstracks.
PolarityoftheAssignablepedalorfootswitch.
Midi In
ThisisaflagtoturntheMasterTransposeonoroffon
thereceivedMIDImessages.
Scales
TheScaleTransposePositionallowsyoutodecidethe
relationbetweentheScaleandtheMasterTranspose.
PostKB
Whenthisoptionisselected,noteswillbe
transposed immediately after they leave
thekeyboard.TheScalewillbeappliedto
thetransposednotes.Forexample,ifyou
altered an E, and then set the Master
Transposeto+1,theEkeywillplayF,and
thealteredkeywillbeE(thatwillplayan
alteredE).
Transpose
Scale
Tone
generator
127
Internal
MIDI
Clock Send
Local
TheLocalparameterturnsthekeyboardonoroff.
Note: TheLocalparameteris alwaysturnedonagain each
timeyouturntheinstrumenton.
On
When you play on the keyboard, MIDI
data issent to theinternal soundgenera
torandtotheMIDIOUTport.
Off
The keyboard is connected to the MIDI
OUT, but cannot play the internal sound
generator.
Thisisveryusefulwhenworkingwithan
externalsequencer,tosendnotesandcon
trollersfromthekeyboardtotheexternal
sequencer,andthenletthesequencersend
thembacktothesoundgenerator,without
overlapping.SeetheMIDIchapter.
Clock
ThisparameterselectstheMIDIClocksource.
Note:TheClockparameterisalwayssettoInteachtime
youturntheinstrumenton.
Channel
128
Control
NotesenteringthischannelaresenttotheChordRec
ognitionengine.
Chord2 channel
NotesenteringthischannelaresenttotheChordRec
ognitionengine.
Velocity Input
129
Lower
Upper13
Drum
Perc
Bass
Acc15
S1T116
S2T116
SQTr0116
Chord
Filters
SelectedMIDIINfilters.
Off
Nofilter.
PitchBend PitchBend.
MonoTouch Mono(orChannel)AfterTouch.
PolyTouch PolyAfterTouch.
PrgChange ProgramChange.
SysExcl
SystemExclusive.
AllCC
AllControlChangemessages.
0127
Control Change message #0127. See
MIDI Controllers on page228 for a list
ofavailableControlChangemessages.
Lowertrack.
OneoftheUppertracks.
Drumtrack.
Percussiontrack.
Basstrack.
OneoftheAutoaccompanimenttracks.
OneofSequencer1tracks.
OneofSequencer2tracks.
Usethesechannelstosenddatagenerated
byatrackwiththesamenameoneitheror
bothonboardsequencersatthesametime.
Usethischanneltosendnotesrecognized
by the Chord Recognition engine to the
MIDIOUT.Thisisuseful,forexample,to
control an external Harmonizer from the
microARRANGER,usingtheLowertrack
toplaychords,evenifthetrackisinmute.
Channel
Filters
SelectedMIDIOUTfilters.
Off
Nofilter.
PitchBend PitchBend.
MonoTouch Mono(orChannel)AfterTouch.
PolyTouch PolyAfterTouch.
PrgChange ProgramChange.
SysExcl
SystemExclusive.
AllCC
AllControlChangemessages.
0127
Control Change message #0127. See
MIDI Controllers on page228 for a list
ofavailableControlChangemessages.
130
Warning!NeverremoveacardwhentheWRITE/CARDIN
USELEDisturnedon!
SUPPORTED CARDS
Youcanusethefollowingtypesofcardstosaveorload
data to and from the microARRANGERs internal
memory:
SD(HighSpeed,UltraII,SDHC)
MMC
MicroSDwithanSDadapter
MiniSDwithanSDadapter
Note:BeforeyoucanusetheSD/MMCcard,youmustformat
itonthemicroARRANGER.Dontuseyourcomputerordigi
talcameratoformat(initialize)acardyouplantousewiththe
microARRANGER. If the card was formatted on a different
device,itmaynotworkcorrectlywiththemicroARRANGER
Note:TheSD/MMCcardisnotincluded.Itmustbepurchased
separately.
Note:ThemicroARRANGERsupportsSDcardswithapower
supplyvoltageof2.73.6V.
SDcardshaveawriteprotectswitchthatpreventsthe
data from being overwritten accidentally and lost. If
yousetthecardsswitchtotheprotectedsetting,itwill
beimpossibletowriteorerasedataonthecard,orto
formatit.Ifyouneedtosaveediteddataonthecard,
move the switch back to its original unprotected set
ting.
Write-protect
switch
Protected
Inserting/exchanging cards
Insertingacard
Insertthecard,makingsurethatitisorientedcorrectly.
The gold contacts should be facing down, and the
angledcornertoyourright.
SD card slot
SD card
Removingacard
Pressthecardinwardandreleaseit,andthecardwill
popout.
Note:BeforeyoucanuseanSDcard,youmustformatiton
themicroARRANGER.Thecardmaynotworkifitwasfor
mattedonanotherdevice.
MYDIR.SET
GLOBAL
BANK01.GBL
PERFORM
BANK01.PRF
1-1 Grand Piano
CARD STRUCTURE
Eachcard(andtheinternalmemory)cancontainfiles
andfolders.ThedatastructureinmicroARRANGERis
slightly more rigorously determined than in a com
puter, due to the preconfigured data structure inside
the instruments memory. The diagram on the right
shows the global structure of a microARRANGER
card.
Note:Stylebanksfrom1to16(FactoryStyles)canbeseen
inCardmodeonlywhentheFactoryStyleProtectparam
eter is set to Off (see page142), and only when loading or
savingasingleStylebank.
1 Piano 1
64 SynBrass22
USER02.PCG
1 SopranoSax
64 Noise
USERDK.PCG
1 Standard Kit
64 Orchestral Kit
STYLE
BANK01.STY
FILE TYPES
The following tables describe all the file and folder
typesthemicroARRANGERcanmanage.Herearethe
filesyoucanreadorwriteonthemicroARRANGER.
1-1 8 Beat 1
1-16 8 Beat 16
BANK.STY
BANK16.STY
Extension
File/folder type
SET
GBL
PRF
Performance
PCG
User Program
STY
User Style
16-1 Traditional 1
16-8 Traditional 16
USER01.STY
U1-1 User 1
U1-16 User 16
USER02.STY
U2-1 User 1
U2-16 User 16
USER03.STY
Extension
File type
MID
KAR
Karaoke file
JBX
Jukebox
U3-1 User 1
U3-16 User 16
131
132
Page header
ThislineshowstheCardpageyouarein.
Card content
Toseeafoldersize,firstmoveittothefirstlineofthe
display,thenkeeptheSHIFTbuttonpressed,andpress
the F3 (OPEN) function button under the display. A
dialogboxwillappear,showingthesizeofthefolder:
NAVIGATION TOOLS
WheninaCardpage,youcanuseanyofthefollowing
commandstobrowsethroughthefilesandfolders,or
throughthelistofcommands.
PressEXITtoexitthisdialog.
EF (Scroll Up)
PAGE STRUCTURE
HereisthetypicalstructureofaCardpage.
Operating mode icon
Page header
Scrollthelistup.KeepSHIFTpressedandpressoneof
thesebuttonstojumptothepreviousalphabeticalsec
tion.
GH (Scroll Down)
Scrollthelistdown.KeepSHIFTpressedandpressone
of these buttons to jump to the next alphabetical sec
tion.
TEMPO/VALUE section
Thesecontrolsscrollthelistupordown.
F-1 (SD)
Pressthisbuttonafterreplacingacardinthecardslot.
After pressing this button, the new card will be
scanned,andthefilelistshownonthedisplaywillbe
updated.
Card content
Page commands
Executestheshownoperation.
Operating mode icon
F-3 (OPEN)
WhenintheCardEditenvironment,oneoftheoperat
ingmodesisstillactiveinthebackground.Theoperat
ing mode icon shows which mode is currently active.
Press EXIT to go back to the current operating mode
fromanyoftheCardpages.
133
Menu
MENU
Note:Dataloadedfromcard,anddataalreadyinmem
oryismerged.Forexample,ifthereisdatainallthree
USER Style banks in memory (USER01, USER02,
USER03),andthereisonlytheUSER01Stylebankon
the card, the USER01 bank is overwritten, while
USER02andUSER03banksareleftunchanged.
As a result, you will have a STYLE folder in memory
containingtheUSER01bankyoujustloaded,andthe
oldUSER02andUSER03banks.
PAGE 1 - LOAD
Inthispageyoucanloadfilesfromacardtotheinter
nalmemory.
PressSDCARDandusetheMENUbuttontoreachthis
page.
YoucanloadallUserdataofaspecifiedtype(UserPro
grams,UserStyles,Performances)withasingleopera
tion.
1. Insertthesourcecardintothecardslot.
2. PressF1toscanthecardandshowthefilelist.
3. Use the EH (Scroll) buttons (or the TEMPO/
VALUE controls) to select the .SET folder con
tainingthedatayouwishtoload.
Move the folder to the first line of the display. If
thefolderyouarelookingforisinanotherfolder,
usetheF3(OPEN)buttontoopenit.UsetheF4
(CLOSE)buttontogobacktotheparentfolder.
4. PressF3(OPEN)toopenthe.SETfolder.Alist
of User data appears (Performance, Program,
Style,Global).
5.
6.
134
5.
6.
9.
Scrolltheavailablelocationsinmemory,usingthe
EH(Scroll)buttons(ortheTEMPO/VALUEcon
trols).
10. When the target bank is selected (i.e., it is in the
firstlineofthedisplay),pressF2(LOAD)toload
thebank.TheAreyousuremessagewillappear.
PressENTERtoconfirm,orEXITtoabort.
Warning:Afterconfirming,allUserdatacontainedin
thebankinmemoryisdeleted.
Whentheoperationiscompleted(theWaitindi
cator disappears), the source page comes back in
thedisplay,andyoumayperformfurtherloading
operations.
5.
7.
8.
6.
7.
In the page above, the previously selected Style
bank will be loaded into the bank 1 (USER1 but
ton)inmemory.TheexistingStylesinmemorywill
bedeletedandoverwritten.
135
Page 2 - Save
8.
PressF3(OPEN)toopentheselectedbank.Alist
ofUseritemsappears.
PAGE 2 - SAVE
Inthispage,youcansaveUserdatafromtheinternal
memorytoacard.Youcansavefiles,banks,orallthe
Userfilesoftheinternalmemory.
PressSDCARDandusetheMENUorPAGEbuttons
toreachthispage.
9.
contains
ALL
A .SET folder
Style
Program
Perform (Performances)
The Performances
.GBL file
4.
Atthispoint,youcan:
Createanew.SETfolder(seeCreatinganew
.SETfolderonpage138).
Saveontoanexisting.SETfolder.
Ifyouaresavingintoanexistingfolder,movethe
desired.SETfoldertothefirstlineofthedisplay,
using the EH (Scroll) buttons (or the TEMPO/
VALUEcontrols).
136
5.
Oncethetargetfolderisselected,pressF2(SAVE)
tosavethefiles.TheAreyousure?messagewill
appear.PressENTERtoconfirm,orEXITtoabort.
Warning:Afterconfirming,alldatainthetargetfolder
isdeleted.
Whentheoperationiscompleted(theWaitindi
cator disappears), the source page comes back in
the display, and you may perform further saving
operations.
3.
4.
3.
4.
5.
5.
6.
6.
7.
Atthispoint,youcan:
Createanew.SETfolder(seeCreatinganew
.SETfolderonpage138).
Saveontoanexisting.SETfolder.
Ifyouaresavingintoanexistingfolder,movethe
desired.SETfoldertothefirstlineofthedisplay,
using the EH (Scroll) buttons (or the TEMPO/
VALUEcontrols).
Oncethetargetfolderisselected,pressF2(SAVE)
tosavethefiles.TheAreyousure?messagewill
appear.PressENTERtoconfirm,orEXITtoabort.
Warning:Afterconfirming,alldatainthetargetfolder
isdeleted.
Whentheoperationiscompleted(theWaitindi
cator disappears), the source page comes back in
7.
8.
Atthispoint,youcan:
Createanew.SETfolder(seeCreatinganew
.SETfolderonpage138).
Saveontoanexisting.SETfolder.
Ifyouaresavingintoanexistingfolder,movethe
desired.SETfoldertothefirstlineofthedisplay,
137
Page 2 - Save
6.
7.
8.
3.
4.
5.
Atthispoint,youcan:
Createanew.SETfolder(seeCreatinganew
.SETfolderonpage138).
Save ontoanexisting.SETfolder (saveddata
ismergedwiththeexistingdataonthecard).
9. Ifyouaresavingintoanexistingfolder,movethe
desired.SETfoldertothefirstlineofthedisplay,
using the EH (Scroll) buttons (or the TEMPO/
VALUEcontrols).
10. Press F2 (SAVE) to confirm. A list of files on the
target device appears. Only files of the selected
typeareshown.
138
PAGE 3 - COPY
Whensavingdata(Saveoperations),youcansaveonto
existingfolders,oryoucancreateanew.SETfolder.
Hereishowtodoit.
1. When the file list of the target card is in the dis
play,usetheEH(Scroll)buttons(ortheTEMPO/
VALUEcontrols)tomovetheNEW_NAME.SET
itemtothefirstlineofthedisplay.
Note:ANEW_NAME.SETitemisalwaysthefirst
iteminanydirectory.
2. When the NEW_NAME.SET item is selected,
pressoneoftheAVOLUME/VALUEbuttons.You
arepromptedtoassignanametothenewfolder:
Inthispageyoucancopysinglefiles(i.e.,midifilesof
Jukebox files), whole folders (generic or .SET fold
ers), or a generic folders content. Note that you can
copydataonlyinsidethesamecard.
To preserve the data structure integrity, during Copy
operations you cant open a .SET folder, and copy
oneofitsfiles.Youcanonlyopengenericfolders.
PressSDCARDandusetheMENUorPAGEbuttons
toreachthispage.
3.
4.
MovethecursorusingtheDOWN/andUP/+but
tons. Select a character using the DIAL. Insert a
character at the cursor position by pressing the
INSERT button. Delete a character at the cursor
positionbypressingtheDELETEbutton.
When you have finished writing a name for the
newfolder,pressF2(SAVE)toconfirm.TheAre
you sure? message will appear. Press ENTER to
confirm,orEXITtoabort.
5.
139
Page 4 - Erase
6.
7.
Oncethetargetisselected,pressF2(COPY).The
Overwrite?messageappears:
8.
9.
Oncethetargetisselected,pressF2(COPY).The
Overwrite?messageappears:
PAGE 4 - ERASE
Copying a single file
Youcancopyasinglefilefromagenericfoldertoadif
ferentfolder.Thefilemustresideontheroot(themain/
highest folder in the card hierarchy) or into a generic
folder.Youcantcopysinglefilesfroma.SETfolder.
1. Insertthecardintothecardslot.
2. PressF1toscanthecardandshowthefilelist.
3. Move the folder, containing the file you wish to
copy, to the first line of the display. If it is con
tained in another folder, use the F3 (OPEN) but
tontoopenit.PressF4(CLOSE)togobacktothe
previoushierarchiclevel.
4. PressF3(OPEN)toopenthefoldercontainingthe
filetocopy.
5. Movethefiletocopytothefirstlineofthedisplay.
6. Oncethefileisonthefirstline,pressF2(COPY)
to confirm its selection. The windows header
changesfromCopyfromtoCopyto.
TheErasefunctionletsyouerasefilesandfoldersfrom
cards.
Erase procedure
1. Ifthefiletobedeletediscontainedinacard,insert
thecardintothecardslot.
2. PressF1toselectadevice.Devicesareselectedin
thisorder:SDSSDSD
Device
Type
SD
SSD
3.
4.
7.
140
PAGE 5 - FORMAT
3.
TheFormatfunctionletsyouinitializeacard.
PressSDCARDandusetheMENUorPAGEbuttons
toreachthispage.
4.
Warning:Whenformattingacard,alldataitcontainsislost.
SD Card
PressoneoftheAVOLUME/VALUEbuttons.You
arepromptedtoassignanametothenewfolder:
MovethecursorusingtheDOWN/andUP/+but
tons. Select a character using the DIAL. Insert a
character at the cursor position by pressing the
INSERT button. Delete a character at the cursor
positionbypressingtheDELETEbutton.
Press F2 (CREATE) to confirm. The Are you
sure?messageappears.PressENTERtoconfirm,
EXITtoabort.
PAGE 7 - RENAME
Use the Rename function to change the name of a
folderorafile.Topreservedatastructureconsistence,
youcantrenamesinglefilesinsidea.SETfolder,or
the.SETfoldernameextension.
PressSDCARDandusetheMENUorPAGEbuttons
toreachthispage.
Rename procedure
1. Insertthecardthatcontainsthefiletoberenamed
intothecardslot.
2. PressF1toscanthecard.
3. Move the item to rename to the first line. Then
pressoneoftheAVOLUME/VALUEbuttons.You
arepromptedtochangethename:
4.
New folder procedure
1. Insertacardintothecardslot.
2. PressF1toscanthecard.
MovethecursorusingtheDOWN/andUP/+but
tons. Select a character using the DIAL. Insert a
character at the cursor position by pressing the
INSERT button. Delete a character at the cursor
positionbypressingtheDELETEbutton.
Press F2 (RENAME) to confirm. The Are you
sure?messageappears.PressENTERtoconfirm,
EXITtoabort.
141
Page 8 - Utilities 1
PAGE 8 - UTILITIES 1
Thispageincludesasetofcardutilities.
PressSDCARDandusetheMENUorPAGEbuttons
toreachthispage.
KeepSHIFTpressed,andpressENTERtoformat
thecard.
Backup Data
SD info
KeepSHIFTpressed,andpressENTERtoformat
thecard.
SSD info
Restore Data
SelectthiscommandtoseethefreespaceontheSolid
StateDisk(SSD),usedasthesystemsinternalmemory.
Thiscommandrestoresthebackupoftheinternalfac
torydata,executedwiththeBackupDatacommand.
Note: ShouldyourFactoryData cardbecomecorrupt,you
candownloadthedatafromhttp://www.korgpa.com/,orask
yourlocalKORGdealer.
Warning:Dontplayonthekeyboardwhilerestoringdata,
andstayintheCardmode.WaituntiltheWaitmessage
disappears,andtheWRITE/CARDINUSELEDturnsoff.
1. Prepare a card containing the Backup folder and
insertitintothedrive.
2. Selectthiscommand.
3. The Are you sure? message appears. Press
ENTERtocontinue,EXITtoabort.
4. Waituntilthebackupcardhasbeenread.
5. WhentheWaitmessagehasdisappeared,andthe
WRITE/CARD IN USE LED has turned off, turn
theinstrumentoff,thenonagain.
Note:AttheendofaRestoreDataoperation,theSomefiles
missingerrormessagemayappear.Thisisduetothelackof
Performancebanks1120onolderversionsoftheoperating
systemofPa80,whosedatayouareprobablyreading.How
ever,thisisnotaproblem.PressEXITtoclosethemessage
Save OS
142
PAGE 9 - UTILITIES 2
ThispageincludestheProtectfunctions.
Global Protect
Whenloadinga.SETfile,thisparameter(ifOn)pro
tects the Global from being reprogrammed by the
loaded data. All Global parameters are therefore left
unchanged.
When loading a single .GLB file, this parameter is
ignored, and the Global is overwritten by the loaded
data.
Note:ThisparameterisautomaticallysettoOffwhenturn
ingtheinstrumentoff.
Factory Style Protect
APPENDIX
Factory Data
144
Styles
CC#0 CC#32
CC#0 CC#32
CC#0 CC#32
Guitar Bld1
Groove Bld
Guitar Bld2
Diva
Stndrd8Beat
8Bt Analog1
RockBallad1
Unplug8Bt 1
Analogyst
Folk Ballad
Love 8 Beat
8Bt Analog2
PopBallad 2
Half Beat
Trendy Beat
HalfTimeBld
UK 8 Beat
Slow Ballad
CountryBld1
8BeatGroove
6Strings Bt
4/4 Ballad
UK RnB
Std 16Beat 1
Love Ballad
10
PopBallad 1
Std 16Beat 2
NaturalBeat
11
10
HipHop Beat
10
Unpl.16Beat
10
Celtic Bld
12
11
LightRock 1
11
Pop 16Beat1
11
16BtAnalog1
13
12
LightRock 2
12
Pop 16Beat2
12
Color Beat
14
13
Miami Beat
13
Cinema Bld
13
PopBallad 3
15
14
ClassicBeat
14
Windy Beat
14
8Bt Analog3
16
15
Unplug8Bt 2
15
Home Beat
15
16BtAnalog2
PC
Bank: Ballroom
PC
Bank: Dance
PC
Bank: Rock
Slow Pop
HouseGarage
Open Rock 1
Slow Rock 1
House
Open Rock 2
Slow Rock 2
Dream
Pop Rock
Unpl.SlRock
Techno
Fire Rock
BigBnd Fox1
Underground
Hard Rock
Slow Waltz1
Progressive
Heavy Rock
Slow Waltz2
Jungle
RockShuffle
Foxtrot 1
Rap
RockBallad2
BigBnd Fox2
Hip Hop
Half Time
10
Slow Fox
Disco 70
Rock 6/8
11
10
Foxtrot 2
10
80's Dance
10
Abbey Road
12
11
Operetta
11
Love Disco
11
Surf Rock
13
12
BigBnd Fox3
12
Disco Party
12
Pop Shuffle
14
13
Charleston
13
Disco Funky
13
BluesShuffl
15
14
Quick Step
14
Disco Gully
14
60's Rock
16
15
New Jive
15
Twist
15
PC
PC
Bank: World 1
PC
Bank: World 2
CC#0 CC#32
0
CC#0 CC#32
Ballad
Soft Beat
CC#0 CC#32
PC
Pop Beat
CC#0 CC#32
PC
PC
CC#0 CC#32
0
CC#0 CC#32
Rubber Funk
OberkrWaltz
Bluegrass
Groove Funk
OberkrPolka
Country 8Bt
Acid Jazz
Bavar.Pop 1
Country16Bt
Double Beat
Bavar.Pop 2
CountryBeat
Groove
Party Polka
Mod.Country
Jazz Funk
Pop Polka
CntryBoogie
Al Swing
Flipper 6/8
CountryShf1
HipHop Funk
Flipper 4/4
CountryShf2
HipHop Soul
Schlager 1
CountryBld2
10
MotownShufl
Schlager 2
Country 3/4
11
10
PopBallad 4
10
Schlager 3
10
Orleans
12
11
RhythmBlues
11
Schlager 4
11
Jig
13
12
Soul
12
PopSchlager
12
CelticDream
14
13
Memphis
13
Trucker
13
Norteno
15
14
Motown
14
Cajun
14
Quebradita
16
15
Gospel
15
Zydeco
15
Tejano
Factory Data
Styles
#
1
CC#0 CC#32
0
PC
Bank: World 3
Hora
Sevillana 1
CC#0 CC#32
0
10
PC
Bank: Latin 1
UnplugBossa
Basic Bossa
CC#0 CC#32
0
11
PC
Bank: Latin 2
Engl. Tango
Orch. Tango
Sevillana 2
L.A. Bossa
Tango.it
Jota
New Bossa
Habanera 1
Copla
Miss Bossa
Habanera 2
Classic 3/4
Lite Bossa
Mambo 1
Bolero
GrooveBossa
Mambo 2
Minuetto
DiscoChaCha
Salsa 1
Baroque
Salsa 2
10
New Age
Sabor
Mariachi
11
10
Tarantella
10
ChaCha Funk
10
Reggae 1
12
11
Raspa
11
Latin Rock
11
Reggae 2
13
12
Vahde
12
UnplugLatin
12
Reggae 3
14
13
Oriental
13
Beguine 1
13
Pasodoble 1
15
14
Roman
14
Beguine 2
14
PasDobBanda
16
15
Ciftetelli
15
Slow Bolero
15
Pasodoble 2
PC
PC
Bank: Jazz 1
PC
Bank: Jazz 2
#
1
CC#0 CC#32
0
12
Samba
Sambalegre
CC#0 CC#32
0
13
Jazz Brush
Med. Swing
CC#0 CC#32
0
14
Big Band 3
Sw. Shuffle
Disco Samba
Slow Swing
FastBigBand
Samba Funk
SwingBallad
LatinBigBnd
Merengue 1
JazzWaltz 1
BigBnd Fox4
Merengue 2
JazzWaltz 2
Dixieland
Cumbia
5/4 Swing
Hollywood
Latin Dance
Mood Swing
Broadway
Batucada
Be Bop
Acid Jazz
10
Rumba
Unpl.Swing1
New Jazz
11
10
Gipsy
10
Unpl.Swing2
10
Latin Jazz
12
11
Rumba Pop
11
B.BndBallad
11
Fusion
13
12
Calypso
12
BigBandMed.
12
Ragtime Pno
14
13
Lambada
13
Big Band 1
13
Shuffle Pno
15
14
Meneito
14
BigBand40's
14
Boogie Pno
16
15
Macarena
15
Big Band 2
15
Bossa Pno
#
1
CC#0 CC#32
0
15
PC
0
Bank: Trad
Ital.Valzer
CC#0 CC#32
0
17
PC
0
Bank: User 1
Foxtrot 3
CC#0 CC#32
0
18
PC
0
Bank: User 2
16Beat John
Valzer
Hully Gully
8 Beat John
GermWaltz 1
Mazurka 3
2Bt Country
GermWaltz 2
Polka 3
Bajon
Laendler
It. Valzer2
Ipanema
WalzMusette
Slow Waltz3
SanbaDeSol
ViennaWaltz
Trad.Bolero
Ricky
Viennese
NewBeguine
Mambo 99
Mazurka 1
SchlagerMx1
PopShuffle2
10
Mazurka 2
SchlagerMx2
Front Beat
11
10
Polka 1
10
Dance Mix
10
Long Train
12
11
Polka 2
11
Soca Dance
11
2000 Hits
13
12
Germ. Polka
12
60's Dance
12
Questions
14
13
Trad. Polka
13
70's Disco
13
8BeatRock1
15
14
Marsch
14
Motown 2
14
8BeatRock2
16
15
FrenchMarsc
15
Dance 80
15
L.A. R & B
145
Factory Data
146
Style Elements
#
1
CC#0 CC#32
0
19
PC
Bank: User 3
Soul 2
Boston Boy
6/8 JazzPop
J-Pop
HipHopFunk2
Schuffle
Jazz Funk 2
Blues
6/8 Swing
10
The Avalon
11
10
6/8 R & B
12
11
Groovin'
13
12
90's Funk
14
13
Party Funk
15
14
6/8 Blues
16
15
Fusion Funk
CC#0 CC#32
0
2931
PC
015
Bank: Direct SD
Page 12, 34, 56
*.SET
STYLE ELEMENTS
Note:YoucanremotelyselectthevariousStyleElementsonthemicroARRANGER,bysendingitProgramChange
messagesontheControlchannel(seepage128).
PC
Style Element
PC
Style Element
PC
Style Element
PC
Style Element
PC
Style Element
80
Var.1
81
Var.2
82
Var.3
83
Var.4
84
Intro 1
85
Intro 2
86
Fill 1
87
Fill 2
88
Ending 1
89
Ending 2
93
Bass Inversion
94
Manual Bass
90
Break/Count IN
91
Fade IN/OUT
92
Memory
95
Tempo Lock
96
Single Touch
97
Style Change
CC#32
PC
STS
PC
STS
PC
STS
PC
STS
64
STS 1
65
STS 2
66
STS 3
66
STS 4
Factory Data
147
Name
CC00
CC32
PC
Bank: Piano
Grand Piano
121
Class.Piano
121
L/R Piano
121
AcPianoWide
121
Ac. Piano
121
BrightPian
121
ElGranPian
121
ElGrandWide
121
AcPianoDark
121
BrPianoWide
121
90's Piano
121
M1 Piano
121
2000'sPiano
121
ChorusPiano
121
Honky-Tonk
121
Honky-Wide
121
Piano Pad
121
Piano Pad 2
121
PnoStrngPad
121
Pno&Strings
121
PianoLayers
121
Piano&Vibes
121
Harpsichord
121
Harpsi Oct.
121
Harpsi Wide
121
HarpsiK.Off
121
Harpsi Korg
121
Clav
121
Pulse Clav
121
Clav Wah
121
Clav Snap
121
Sticky Clav
121
Bank: E. Piano
ClubElPiano
121
11
DynoTine EP
121
10
Vintage EP
121
Pro-Dyno EP
121
ProStage EP
121
Studio EP
121
StereoDigEP
121
ClassDigiEP
121
EP Phase
121
Hybrid EP
121
Class.Tines
121
PhantomTine
121
10
Sweeping EP
121
12
WhitePad EP
121
13
CC00
CC32
ThinElPiano
121
PC
4
DW8000 EP
121
11
El.Piano 1
121
El.Piano 2
121
DetunedEP 1
121
EP1Veloc.sw
121
60'sElPiano
121
DetunedEP 2
121
EP2Veloc.sw
121
EP Legend
121
R&B E.Piano
121
SynPiano X
121
Vibraphone
121
11
Vibraphone2
121
11
Vibrap.Wide
121
11
Marimba
121
12
MarimbaWide
121
12
RimbaKeyOff
121
12
MonkeySkuls
121
12
Xylophone
121
13
12
Balaphon
121
Celesta
121
Glocken
121
9
10
Music Box
121
Sistro
121
Orgel
121
10
Digi Bell
121
98
Vs Bell Boy
121
98
Steel Drums
121
114
Warm Steel
121
114
TubularBell
121
14
Church Bell
121
14
Carillon
121
14
KrystalBell
121
98
ChurchBell2
121
14
Tinkle Bell
121
112
Dulcimer
121
15
Santur
121
15
Kalimba
121
108
VeloKalimba
121
108
MalletClock
121
12
Gamelan
121
112
BaliGamelan
121
112
GarbageMall
121
112
Bank: Accordion
Sweet Harm.
121
22
Harmonica
121
22
Harmonica 2
121
22
Cassotto
121
21
Fisa Master
121
21
Fisa 16+8
121
21
Fisa 16+4
121
21
MusetteClar
121
21
Musette 1
121
21
Musette 2
121
21
Accordion
121
21
TangoAccord
121
23
Fisa Tango!
121
23
148
Factory Data
Programs (bank order)
Name
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
CC00
CC32
PC
Akordeon
121
21
DistortionG
121
30
Accordion 2
121
21
Nylon Bossa
121
24
Arab.Accord
121
10
21
NylonKeyOff
121
24
Steel Gtr 2
121
25
AcGtrKeyOff
121
24
Club J.Gtr2
121
26
Vintage S.
121
27
CleanMutGtr
121
28
Stereo Dist
121
30
Nylon Gtr 2
121
24
Gtr Strings
121
24
FingerK.Off
121
25
St12Strings
121
25
Jazz Guitar
121
26
SingleCoil
121
27
Clean Funk
121
28
JoystGtr Y-
121
30
Reso.Guitar
121
12
25
St.Folk Gtr
121
25
Steel&Body
121
25
Hackbrett
121
25
Jazz Man
121
28
DetCleanGtr
121
27
R&R Guitar
121
28
OverdriveGt
121
29
Ukulele
121
24
Mandolin
121
25
Mandol.KOff
121
10
25
MandoTrem
121
11
25
Banjo
121
105
BanjoKeyOff
121
105
Bouzouki
121
104
Tambra
121
104
Finger Tips
121
25
MidToneGtr
121
27
Chorus Gtr
121
27
ProcesElGtr
121
27
NewStra.Gtr
121
27
DistRhytmGt
121
30
Bank: Organ 1
Jimmy Organ
BX3 Velo Sw
ClassiClick
M1 Organ
Jazz Organ
Dist. Organ
RotaryOrgan
DarkJazzOrg
Bx3ShortDec
SuperBXPerc
Percuss.BX3
Killer B
Drawb.Organ
DetDrawbOrg
It60'sOrgan
DrawbOrgan2
Old Wheels
Perc. Organ
Det.PercOrg
Perc.Organ2
Rock Organ
Good Old B
Dirty B
IperDarkOrg
FullDrawbar
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
10
1
4
5
8
5
8
4
7
6
4
2
0
1
2
3
3
0
1
2
0
10
3
5
6
18
18
18
17
16
18
17
16
17
18
17
18
16
16
16
16
17
17
17
17
18
16
18
16
16
DWGS Organ
121
16
GospelOrgan
121
16
PercShorDec
Perc.Wheels
DirtyJazOrg
VOX Legend
TeknoOrgBas
ArabianOrg.
121
121
121
121
121
121
8
9
7
11
6
12
18
18
18
16
17
16
Bank: Organ 2
PipeMixture
121
19
WetDistGtr
121
30
FlautoPipes
121
20
SoloDistGtr
121
30
Pipe Tutti
121
19
L&R El.Gtr
121
27
PositiveOrg
121
19
L&R El.Gtr2
121
10
27
ChurchOrg.1
121
19
RhythmElGtr
121
28
ChurchOcMix
121
19
Guitarish
121
27
DetunChurch
121
19
Country Nu
121
11
27
ChurchPipes
121
19
Stra. Chime
121
28
Full Pipes
121
19
MuteMonster
121
30
Reed Organ
121
20
Disto Mute
121
28
Puff Organ
121
20
FunkyCutGtr
121
28
Small Pipe
121
20
MuteVeloGtr
121
28
Bank: Guitar
FeedbackGtr
121
30
NylonGuitar
24
Guitar Pinc
121
29
24
Ped.Steel 2
121
26
25
PedSteelGtr
121
26
25
GtrFeedback
121
31
26
PowerChords
121
30
27
FunkyWhaSw
121
12
27
28
VoxWahChick
121
120
EGHarmonics
121
31
Spanish Gtr
SteelGuitar
12StringGtr
Club J.Gtr1
CleanGuitar
MutedGuitar
121
121
121
121
121
121
121
0
6
0
1
2
0
0
Factory Data
149
Name
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
CC00
CC32
GtrHarmonic
121
31
Odissey
121
50
Sitar
121
104
Grand Choir
121
11
52
Sitar 2
121
104
Slow Choir
121
10
52
SitarTambou
121
104
Symph. Bows
121
10
48
IndianStars
121
104
Cyber Choir
121
85
Oud
121
105
Choir Light
121
12
52
Kanun
121
107
Vocalesque
121
54
Kanun Trem.
121
107
Synth Voice
121
54
Kanun Mix
121
107
Voice Lead
121
85
Shamisen
121
106
Choir Pad
121
91
Koto
121
107
Halo Pad
121
94
Taisho Koto
121
107
FullVox Pad
121
91
IndianFrets
121
104
121
40
StringQuart
121
48
121
11
48
St. Strings
121
48
Analog Str
121
50
i3 Strings
121
48
Oh-AhVoices
121
52
Take Voices
121
52
Slow Violin
121
40
Camera Str.
121
12
48
ArcoStrings
121
48
PC
FreshBreath
121
91
EtherVoices
121
85
DreamVoice
121
54
Humming
121
53
AnalogVoice
121
54
Mmmh Choir
121
52
StringChoir
121
13
52
ClassicVox
121
54
Doolally
121
53
Fresh Air
121
91
Vocalscape
121
54
Heaven
121
91
Airways
121
53
Yang Chin
121
46
LegatoStrng
121
48
MasterPad
121
89
N Strings
121
48
MonoTrumpet
121
56
OhSlowVoice
121
52
Flugel Horn
121
56
TakeVoices2
121
52
TrumptPitch
121
56
SlowAttViol
121
40
TrumpetExpr
121
56
PizzEnsembl
121
45
HardTrombon
121
57
Fiddle
121
110
SoftTrombon
121
57
PizzSection
121
45
Wha Trumpet
121
59
SweeperStr.
121
49
Muted Trp
121
59
AnalogVelve
121
50
Dual Trump
121
56
Aaah Choir
121
52
Warm Flugel
121
56
Oooh Voices
121
52
Trumpet
121
56
Violin
121
40
Trumpet 2
121
56
Viola
121
41
Trombone
121
57
Cello
121
42
Trombone 2
121
57
Contrabass
121
43
PitchTromb
121
57
Tremolo Str
121
44
BeBopCornet
121
56
PizzicatoSt
121
45
DarkTrumpet
121
56
Choir Aahs
121
52
Tuba
121
58
Voice Oohs
121
53
Tuba Gold
121
58
StringsEns1
121
48
Ob.Tuba
121
58
StringsEns2
121
49
Dynabone
121
58
Orches.Harp
121
46
BrightTromb
121
57
60s Strings
121
48
Muted Trp 2
121
59
Oct.Strings
121
48
Bank: Brass
SynStrings3
121
50
Oooh Choir
121
52
Choir Aahs2
121
52
String&Bras
121
48
Dbl Strings
121
45
ArabStrings
121
13
48
SynStrings1
121
50
SynStrings2
121
51
BigBandBrs
121
61
Tight Brass
121
61
121
61
Glen&Friend
121
61
MutEnsemble
121
59
121
60
Syn Brass
121
62
Orches. Hit
121
55
150
Factory Data
Programs (bank order)
Name
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
BrassSect.1
121
61
Bank: Woodwind
Fat Brass
121
13
61
Trumpet Ens
121
61
121
61
MutEnsembl2
121
59
French Horn
121
60
Syn Brass 2
121
63
Brass Hit
121
25
61
AttackBrass
121
61
BrassSect.2
121
61
TromboneEns
121
10
61
121
61
Flute Muted
121
73
FrenchHorn2
121
60
Syn Brass 3
121
62
Euro Hit
121
55
TightBrass2
121
12
61
Dyna Brass
121
14
61
Trombones
121
11
61
Brass Band
121
16
61
Brass Pad
121
63
French Sect
121
60
Syn Brass 4
121
63
6th Hit
121
55
Power Brass
121
21
61
Brass Expr.
121
15
61
Dyna Brass2
121
22
61
Film Brass
121
17
61
Brass Slow
121
18
61
ClassicHorn
121
60
ElectrikBrs
121
62
BrassImpact
121
55
Fanfare
121
19
61
Movie Brass
121
20
61
Sfz Brass
121
23
61
Jump Brass
121
62
AnalogBras1
121
62
AnalogBras2
121
63
Syn Brass 5
121
62
Brass Fall
121
26
61
BassHitPlus
121
55
Dbl Brass
121
24
61
Bank: Sax
Tenor Noise
121
66
Alto Breath
121
65
Sweet Sprno
121
64
Barit Growl
121
67
BreathyBari
121
67
Soft Tenor
121
66
SaxEnsemble
121
65
Folk Sax
121
66
Tenor Sax
121
66
Alto Sax
121
65
Soprano Sax
121
64
BaritoneSax
121
67
TenorBreath
121
66
Tenor Growl
121
66
BreathyAlto
121
65
AltSaxGrowl
121
65
CC00
CC32
PC
Jazz Flute
121
73
Old Shaku
121
77
FluteSwitch
121
73
FluteDyn5th
121
73
Flute Frull
121
73
Pan Flute
121
75
Jazz Clarin
121
71
Flute 2
121
73
Double Reed
121
68
EnglisHorn2
121
69
Recorder 2
121
74
Nay
121
72
Orch. Flute
121
73
WoodenFlute
121
73
War Pipes
121
109
ClarinetEns
121
71
Woodwinds
121
71
Small Orch
121
72
Kawala
121
75
Shaku 2
121
77
Whistle 2
121
78
Sect Winds
121
71
Sect Winds2
121
71
Clarinet G
121
71
Folk Clarin
121
71
Oboe
121
68
EnglishHorn
121
69
Bassoon
121
70
Clarinet
121
71
Piccolo
121
72
Flute
121
73
Recorder
121
74
Bambu Flute
121
73
BlownBottle
121
76
Shakuhachi
121
77
Whistle
121
78
Ocarina
121
79
Bag Pipe
121
109
Zurna
121
111
Hichiriki
121
111
Shanai
121
111
Flute Click
121
121
The Pad
121
89
Future Pad
121
91
Air Clouds
121
97
Dark Pad
121
89
Tinklin Pad
121
97
Pods In Pad
121
97
Analog Pad
121
89
Analog Pad2
121
89
Money Pad
121
89
TsunamiWave
121
91
RavelianPad
121
91
AstralDream
121
95
Meditate
121
95
Reso Down
121
97
Sky Watcher
121
90
Bank: Synth 1
Factory Data
151
Name
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
CC00
CC32
Super Sweep
121
90
Mega Synth
121
90
Wave Sweep
121
90
TecnoPhonic
121
10
90
Cross Sweep
121
90
DarkElement
121
95
Digi IcePad
121
101
Band Passed
121
102
Crimson5ths
121
86
Cat Lead
121
87
Freedom Pad
121
89
Pan Reso
121
102
Noble Pad
121
97
Square Rez
121
11
80
Mellow Pad
121
95
Rezbo
121
11
81
Lonely Spin
121
100
Auto Pilot
121
14
38
Cinema Pad
121
95
MetallicRez
121
84
VirtualTrav
121
88
Square Bass
121
87
Syn Ghostly
121
100
Syn Pianoid
121
12
81
MotionOcean
121
96
Brian Sync
121
84
Moon Cycles
121
102
Arp Twins
121
84
Farluce
121
11
90
Arp Angeles
121
88
Bell Pad
121
98
121
87
Bell Choir
121
98
Caribbean
121
96
Warm Pad
121
89
Lead Square
121
80
Sweep Pad
121
95
Lead Saw
121
81
Soundtrack
121
97
Calliope
121
82
Sine Pad
121
89
Chiff
121
83
Itopia Pad
121
91
Charang
121
84
Big Panner
121
63
Fifths Lead
121
86
Dance ReMix
121
10
91
121
87
Rave
121
97
121
88
ElastickPad
121
97
Polysynth
121
90
Moving Bell
121
98
Bank: Synth 2
Old Portam
121
80
Power Saw
121
81
Octo Lead
121
81
ElectroLead
121
87
Rich Lead
121
87
ThinAnaLead
121
87
Dance Lead
121
80
Wave Lead
121
80
Sine Wave
121
80
Synchro Cit
121
84
PC
BowedGlass
121
92
MetallicPad
121
93
Crystal
121
98
Atmosphere
121
99
Brightness
121
100
LeadSquare2
121
80
Lead Sine
121
80
Lead Saw 2
121
81
LeadSawPuls
121
81
LeadDblSaw
121
81
Seq. Analog
121
81
Wire Lead
121
84
Soft Wrl
121
87
Wild Arp
121
55
EspressLead
121
87
HipHop Lead
121
87
Acous. Bass
121
32
Analog Lead
121
80
Finger Bass
121
33
Seq Lead
121
81
Picked Bass
121
34
Old&Analog
121
80
Fretl. Bass
121
35
PhatSawLead
121
81
Slap Bass 1
121
36
Glide Lead
121
81
Slap Bass 2
121
37
Gliding Sq.
121
80
SynthBass 1
121
38
Flip Blip
121
55
SynthBass 2
121
39
Power Synth
121
89
AcBass Buzz
121
32
Sine Switch
121
10
80
Fing ElBass
121
33
Reso Sweep
121
90
Pick ElBass
121
34
Syn Sweeper
121
90
Fret. Bass2
121
35
Cosmic
121
93
SuperSwBass
121
36
MotionRaver
121
101
SuperSwBas2
121
36
Sync Kron
121
84
SynBassWarm
121
38
Fire Wave
121
10
81
SynBassReso
121
38
Dig PolySix
121
90
121
32
121
91
FingElBass2
121
33
Noisy Stabb
121
90
PickElBass2
121
34
Bank: Bass
152
Factory Data
Programs (bank order)
Name
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
CC00
CC32
PC
Fretless Sw
121
35
SFX Kit
120
56
Thumb Bass
121
37
Percus.Kit1
120
64
Finger Slap
121
33
Latin P.Kit
120
65
Attack Bass
121
39
TRI-Per.KIT
120
66
Rubber Bass
121
39
ArabianKit1
120
116
FingElBass3
121
33
ArabianKit2
120
117
DarkR&BBass
121
35
Timpani
121
47
Sweet Fret
121
35
Agogo
121
113
Dyna Bass
121
37
Log Drum
121
12
Stick Bass
121
33
Woodblock
121
115
Gtr Bass
121
34
Taiko Drum
121
116
Bass Mute
121
34
Melodic Tom
121
117
Dr. Octave
121
16
38
Synth Drum
121
118
Nasty Bass
121
39
Reverse Cym
121
119
30303 Bass
121
38
Dragon Gong
121
119
Stein Bass
121
34
Castanets
121
115
Euro Bass
121
39
Concert BD
121
116
Jungle Rez
121
39
MelodicTom2
121
117
30303Square
121
38
Rhyt.BoxTom
121
118
Bass Square
121
38
Electr.Drum
121
118
Phat Bass
121
39
Rev Tom
121
117
SynBass Res
121
38
Rev Snare
121
118
Clav Bass
121
38
i30Perc.Kit
120
67
Hammer
121
38
Bank: SFX
AttackPulse
121
39
Goblins
121
101
Digi Bass 1
121
38
Echo Drops
121
102
BlindAsABat
121
12
38
Star Theme
121
103
PoinkerBass
121
39
GtFretNoise
121
120
Digi Bass 3
121
11
38
BreathNoise
121
121
Jungle Bass
121
13
38
Seashore
121
122
Hybrid Bass
121
15
38
Bird Tweet
121
123
Digi Bass 2
121
10
38
AcBassStrng
121
120
Telephone
121
124
120
Helicopter
121
125
Std. Kit2
120
Applause
121
126
Std. Kit3
120
Gun Shot
121
127
Std. Kit4
120
SynthMallet
121
98
AcousticKit
120
Echo Bell
121
102
Room Kit1
120
Echo Pan
121
102
Room Kit2
120
12
GtrCutNoise
121
120
Jungle Kit
120
10
Rain
121
122
HipHop Kit1
120
Thunder
121
122
HipHop Kit2
120
13
Wind
121
122
Techno Kit1
120
11
Stream
121
122
Techno Kit2
120
14
Bubble
121
122
Techno Kit3
120
15
Dog
121
123
Power Kit1
120
16
HorseGallop
121
123
Power Kit2
120
17
Bird Tweet2
121
123
Electro Kit
120
24
Telephone 2
121
124
Analog Kit
120
25
Door Creak
121
124
House Kit1
120
26
Door
121
124
House Kit2
120
27
Scratch
121
124
House Kit3
120
28
Wind Chime
121
124
House Kit4
120
29
Car Engine
121
125
Jazz Kit
120
32
Car Stop
121
125
Brush Kit1
120
40
Car Pass
121
125
Brush V.S.2
120
41
Car Crash
121
125
OrchestraK.
120
48
Siren
121
125
Bdrum&Sdrum
120
50
Train
121
125
Factory Data
Programs (bank order)
Name
CC00
CC32
PC
Jetplane
121
125
Starship
121
125
Burst Noise
121
125
Laughing
121
126
Screaming
121
126
Punch
121
126
Heart Beat
121
126
Footsteps
121
126
Machine Gun
121
127
Lasergun
121
127
Explosion
121
127
Ice Rain
121
96
Jaw Harp
121
105
HitInIndia
121
55
Stadium
121
126
153
154
Factory Data
Programs (Program Change order)
CC00 CC32
PC
Name
microARRANGER
GM2
Bank
121
Ac. Piano
Piano
121
AcPianoWide
Piano
121
AcPianoDark
Piano
121
Grand Piano
Piano
121
Class.Piano
Piano
121
L/R Piano
Piano
121
Piano&Vibes
Piano
121
Pno&Strings
Piano
121
BrightPiano
Piano
121
BrPianoWide
Piano
121
Piano Pad
Piano
121
Piano Pad 2
Piano
121
PnoStrngPad
Piano
121
ElGranPiano
Piano
121
ElGrandWide
Piano
121
M1 Piano
Piano
121
90's Piano
Piano
121
2000'sPiano
Piano
121
ChorusPiano
Piano
121
PianoLayers
Piano
121
Honky-Tonk
Piano
121
Honky-Wide
Piano
121
El.Piano 1
E.Piano
121
DetunedEP 1
E.Piano
121
EP1Veloc.sw
E.Piano
121
60'sElPiano
E.Piano
121
Vintage EP
E.Piano
121
Pro-Dyno EP
E.Piano
121
ProStage EP
E.Piano
121
Studio EP
E.Piano
121
R&B E.Piano
E.Piano
121
ThinElPiano
E.Piano
121
10
DynoTine EP
E.Piano
121
11
ClubElPiano
E.Piano
121
El.Piano 2
E.Piano
121
DetunedEP 2
E.Piano
121
EP2Veloc.sw
E.Piano
121
EP Legend
E.Piano
121
EP Phase
E.Piano
121
SynPiano X
E.Piano
121
StereoDigEP
E.Piano
121
ClassDigiEP
E.Piano
121
Hybrid EP
E.Piano
121
Class.Tines
E.Piano
121
10
PhantomTine
E.Piano
121
11
DW8000 EP
E.Piano
121
12
Sweeping EP
E.Piano
121
13
WhitePad EP
E.Piano
121
Harpsichord
Piano
PC
Name
microARRANGER
GM2
Bank
121
Harpsi Oct.
Piano
121
Harpsi Wide
Piano
121
HarpsiK.Off
Piano
121
Harpsi Korg
Piano
121
Clav
Piano
121
Pulse Clav
Piano
121
Clav Wah
Piano
121
Clav Snap
Piano
121
Sticky Clav
Piano
121
Celesta
121
Glocken
121
Sistro
121
10
Music Box
121
10
Orgel
121
11
Vibraphone
121
11
Vibrap.Wide
121
11
Vibraphone2
121
12
Marimba
121
12
MarimbaWide
121
12
RimbaKeyOff
121
12
MonkeySkuls
121
12
Log Drum
121
12
MalletClock
121
12
Balaphon
121
13
Xylophone
121
14
TubularBell
121
14
Church Bell
121
14
Carillon
121
14
ChurchBell2
121
15
Dulcimer
121
15
Santur
121
16
Drawb.Organ
Organ 1
121
16
DetDrawbOrg
Organ 1
121
16
It60'sOrgan
Organ 1
121
16
DrawbOrgan2
Organ 1
121
16
DarkJazzOrg
Organ 1
121
16
IperDarkOrg
Organ 1
121
16
FullDrawbar
Organ 1
121
16
DWGS Organ
Organ 1
121
16
Jazz Organ
Organ 1
121
16
GospelOrgan
Organ 1
121
10
16
Good Old B
Organ 1
121
11
16
VOX Legend
Organ 1
121
12
16
ArabianOrg.
Organ 1
121
17
Perc. Organ
Organ 1
121
17
Det.PercOrg
Organ 1
121
17
Perc.Organ2
Organ 1
121
17
Old Wheels
Organ 1
121
17
Percuss.BX3
Organ 1
121
17
M1 Organ
Organ 1
121
17
TeknoOrgBas
Organ 1
121
17
Bx3ShortDec
Organ 1
121
17
RotaryOrgan
Organ 1
121
18
Rock Organ
Organ 1
121
18
BX3 Velo Sw
Organ 1
121
18
Killer B
Organ 1
121
18
Dirty B
Organ 1
121
18
ClassiClick
Organ 1
121
18
Dist. Organ
Organ 1
Factory Data
155
CC00 CC32
PC
Name
microARRANGER
GM2
Bank
CC00 CC32
PC
Name
microARRANGER
GM2
Bank
121
18
SuperBXPerc
Organ 1
121
27
CleanGuitar
Guitar
121
18
DirtyJazOrg
Organ 1
121
27
DetCleanGtr
Guitar
121
18
PercShorDec
Organ 1
121
27
MidToneGtr
Guitar
121
18
Perc.Wheels
Organ 1
121
27
Chorus Gtr
Guitar
121
10
18
Jimmy Organ
Organ 1
121
19
ChurchOrg.1
Organ 2
121
27
Vintage S.
Guitar
121
27
ProcesElGtr
Guitar
121
19
ChurchOcMix
Organ 2
121
27
SingleCoil
Guitar
121
19
DetunChurch
Organ 2
121
27
NewStra.Gtr
Guitar
121
19
PipeMixture
Organ 2
121
27
Guitarish
Guitar
121
19
ChurchPipes
Organ 2
121
27
L&R El.Gtr
Guitar
121
19
Full Pipes
Organ 2
121
10
27
L&R El.Gtr2
Guitar
121
19
Pipe Tutti
Organ 2
121
11
27
Country Nu
Guitar
121
19
PositiveOrg
Organ 2
121
12
27
FunkyWhaSw
Guitar
121
20
Reed Organ
Organ 2
121
28
MutedGuitar
Guitar
121
20
Puff Organ
Organ 2
121
28
FunkyCutGtr
Guitar
121
20
Small Pipe
Organ 2
121
28
MuteVeloGtr
Guitar
121
20
FlautoPipes
Organ 2
121
28
Jazz Man
Guitar
121
21
Accordion
Accordion
121
28
R&R Guitar
Guitar
121
21
Accordion 2
Accordion
121
21
Akordeon
Accordion
121
28
Stra.Chime
Guitar
121
28
CleanMutGtr
Guitar
121
21
Musette 1
Accordion
121
28
RhythmElGtr
Guitar
121
21
Musette 2
Accordion
121
28
Clean Funk
Guitar
121
21
MusetteClar
Accordion
121
28
Disto Mute
Guitar
121
21
Fisa 16+8
Accordion
121
29
OverdriveGt
Guitar
121
21
Fisa 16+4
Accordion
121
29
Guitar Pinch
Guitar
121
21
Fisa Master
Accordion
121
30
DistortionG
Guitar
121
21
Cassotto
Accordion
121
30
FeedbackGtr
Guitar
121
10
21
Arab.Accord
Accordion
121
30
DistRhytmGt
Guitar
121
22
Harmonica
Accordion
121
30
JoystGtr Y-
Guitar
121
22
Sweet Harm.
Accordion
121
30
PowerChords
Guitar
121
22
Harmonica 2
Accordion
121
30
MuteMonster
Guitar
121
23
TangoAccord
Accordion
121
23
Fisa Tango!
Accordion
121
24
NylonGuitar
Guitar
121
30
Stereo Dist
Guitar
121
24
Ukulele
Guitar
121
31
GtrHarmonic
Guitar
121
24
NylonKeyOff
Guitar
121
31
GtrFeedback
Guitar
121
24
Nylon Gtr 2
Guitar
121
31
EGHarmonics
Guitar
121
30
WetDistGtr
Guitar
121
30
SoloDistGtr
Guitar
121
24
Nylon Bossa
Guitar
121
32
Acous. Bass
Bass
121
24
AcGtrKeyOff
Guitar
121
32
AcBass Buzz
Bass
121
24
Spanish Gtr
Guitar
121
32
Bass
121
24
Gtr Strings
Guitar
121
33
Finger Bass
Bass
121
25
SteelGuitar
Guitar
121
33
Finger Slap
Bass
121
25
12StringGtr
Guitar
121
33
Fing ElBass
Bass
121
25
Mandolin
Guitar
121
33
FingElBass2
Bass
121
25
Steel&Body
Guitar
121
33
FingElBass3
Bass
121
25
Steel Gtr 2
Guitar
121
33
Stick Bass
Bass
121
25
St12Strings
Guitar
121
34
Picked Bass
Bass
121
25
Hackbrett
Guitar
121
34
Pick ElBass
Bass
121
25
FingerK.Off
Guitar
121
34
PickElBass2
Bass
121
25
Finger Tips
Guitar
121
34
Stein Bass
Bass
121
25
St.Folk Gtr
Guitar
121
34
Gtr Bass
Bass
121
10
25
Mandol.KOff
Guitar
121
34
Bass Mute
Bass
121
11
25
MandoTrem
Guitar
121
35
Fretl. Bass
Bass
121
12
25
Reso.Guitar
Guitar
121
35
Fret. Bass2
Bass
121
26
Jazz Guitar
Guitar
121
35
Fretless Sw
Bass
121
26
PedSteelGtr
Guitar
121
35
Sweet Fret
Bass
121
26
Club J.Gtr1
Guitar
121
35
DarkR&BBass
Bass
121
26
Club J.Gtr2
Guitar
121
36
Slap Bass 1
Bass
121
26
Ped.Steel 2
Guitar
121
36
SuperSwBass
Bass
156
Factory Data
Programs (Program Change order)
CC00 CC32
PC
Name
microARRANGER
GM2
Bank
121
36
SuperSwBas2
Bass
121
37
Slap Bass 2
Bass
121
37
Thumb Bass
121
37
Dyna Bass
121
38
SynthBass 1
Bass
121
38
SynBassWarm
121
38
SynBassReso
121
38
121
121
CC00 CC32
PC
Name
microARRANGER
GM2
Bank
121
49
StringsEns2
121
49
SweeperStr.
Bass
121
50
SynStrings1
Bass
121
50
SynStrings3
121
50
Analog Str
Bass
121
50
AnalogVelve
Bass
121
50
Odissey
Clav Bass
Bass
121
51
SynStrings2
38
Hammer
Bass
121
52
Choir Aahs
38
30303 Bass
Bass
121
52
Choir Aahs2
121
38
30303Square
Bass
121
52
Oooh Voices
121
38
Bass Square
Bass
121
52
OhSlowVoice
121
38
SynBass Res
Bass
121
52
Take Voices
121
38
Digi Bass 1
Bass
121
52
TakeVoices2
121
10
38
Digi Bass 2
Bass
121
52
Oooh Choir
121
11
38
Digi Bass 3
Bass
121
52
Aaah Choir
121
12
38
BlindAsABat
Bass
121
52
Mmmh Choir
121
13
38
Jungle Bass
Bass
121
52
Oh-AhVoices
121
14
38
Auto Pilot
Synth 2
121
10
52
Slow Choir
121
15
38
Hybrid Bass
Bass
121
11
52
Grand Choir
121
16
38
Dr. Octave
Bass
121
12
52
Choir Light
121
39
SynthBass 2
Bass
121
13
52
StringChoir
121
39
Attack Bass
Bass
121
53
Voice Oohs
121
39
Rubber Bass
Bass
121
53
Humming
121
39
AttackPulse
Bass
121
53
Doolally
121
39
Euro Bass
Bass
121
53
Airways
121
39
Jungle Rez
Bass
121
54
Synth Voice
121
39
Nasty Bass
Bass
121
54
AnalogVoice
121
39
Phat Bass
Bass
121
54
Vocalesque
121
39
PoinkerBass
Bass
121
54
Vocalscape
121
40
Violin
121
54
ClassicVox
121
40
SlowAttViol
121
54
DreamVoice
121
40
Solo Violin
121
55
Orches. Hit
Brass
121
40
Slow Violin
121
55
BassHitPlus
Brass
121
41
Viola
121
55
6th Hit
Brass
121
42
Cello
121
55
Euro Hit
Brass
121
43
Contrabass
121
55
BrassImpact
Brass
121
44
Tremolo Str
121
55
HitInIndia
SFX
121
45
PizzicatoSt
121
55
Wild Arp
Synth 2
121
45
PizzEnsembl
121
55
Flip Blip
Synth 2
121
45
PizzSection
121
56
Trumpet
121
45
Dbl Strings
121
56
DarkTrumpet
121
46
Orches.Harp
121
56
Trumpet 2
121
46
Yang Chin
121
56
MonoTrumpet
121
47
Timpani
121
56
TrumpetExpr
121
48
StringsEns1
121
56
TrumptPitch
121
48
String&Bras
121
56
Dual Trump
121
48
60s Strings
121
56
Flugel Horn
121
48
St. Strings
121
56
Warm Flugel
121
48
LegatoStrng
121
56
BeBopCornet
121
48
i3 Strings
121
57
Trombone
121
48
N Strings
121
57
Trombone 2
121
48
ArcoStrings
121
57
BrightTromb
121
48
Oct.Strings
121
57
HardTrombon
121
48
StringQuart
121
57
SoftTrombon
121
10
48
Symph. Bows
121
57
PitchTromb
121
11
48
121
58
Tuba
121
12
48
Camera Str.
121
58
Ob.Tuba
121
13
48
ArabStrings
121
58
Tuba Gold
Factory Data
157
CC00 CC32
PC
Name
microARRANGER
GM2
Bank
CC00 CC32
PC
Name
microARRANGER
GM2
Bank
121
58
Dynabone
121
59
Muted Trp
121
66
TenorBreath
Sax
121
66
Tenor Growl
Sax
121
59
Muted Trp 2
121
66
Folk Sax
Sax
121
59
Wha Trumpet
121
67
BaritoneSax
Sax
121
59
MutEnsemble
121
67
Barit Growl
Sax
121
59
MutEnsembl2
121
67
BreathyBari
Sax
121
60
French Horn
Brass
121
68
Oboe
Woodwind
121
60
FrenchHorn2
Brass
121
68
Double Reed
Woodwind
121
60
French Sect
Brass
121
69
EnglishHorn
Woodwind
121
60
ClassicHorn
Brass
121
69
EnglisHorn2
Woodwind
121
60
Brass
121
70
Bassoon
Woodwind
121
61
BrassSect.1
Brass
121
71
Clarinet
Woodwind
121
61
BrassSect.2
Brass
121
71
Jazz Clarin
Woodwind
121
61
Tight Brass
Brass
121
71
Clarinet G
Woodwind
121
61
Glen&Friend
Brass
121
71
Sect Winds
Woodwind
121
61
BigBandBrs
Brass
121
71
Sect Winds2
Woodwind
121
61
Brass
121
71
ClarinetEns
Woodwind
121
61
Brass
121
71
Woodwinds
Woodwind
121
61
Brass
121
71
Folk Clarin
Woodwind
121
61
AttackBrass
Brass
121
72
Piccolo
Woodwind
121
61
Trumpet Ens
Brass
121
72
Small Orch
Woodwind
121
10
61
TromboneEns
Brass
121
72
Nay
Woodwind
121
11
61
Trombones
Brass
121
73
Flute
Woodwind
121
12
61
TightBrass2
Brass
121
73
Jazz Flute
Woodwind
Woodwind
121
13
61
Fat Brass
Brass
121
73
FluteSwitch
121
14
61
Dyna Brass
Brass
121
73
FluteDyn5th
Woodwind
121
15
61
Brass Expr.
Brass
121
73
Flute Frull
Woodwind
121
16
61
Brass Band
Brass
121
73
Orch. Flute
Woodwind
121
17
61
Film Brass
Brass
121
73
Flute Muted
Woodwind
121
18
61
Brass Slow
Brass
121
73
WoodenFlute
Woodwind
121
19
61
Fanfare
Brass
121
73
Bambu Flute
Woodwind
121
20
61
Movie Brass
Brass
121
73
Flute 2
Woodwind
121
21
61
Power Brass
Brass
121
74
Recorder
Woodwind
121
22
61
Dyna Brass2
Brass
121
74
Recorder 2
Woodwind
121
23
61
Sfz Brass
Brass
121
75
Pan Flute
Woodwind
121
24
61
Dbl Brass
Brass
121
75
Kawala
Woodwind
121
25
61
Brass Hit
Brass
121
76
BlownBottle
Woodwind
121
26
61
Brass Fall
Brass
121
77
Shakuhachi
Woodwind
121
62
Syn Brass 1
Brass
121
77
Old Shaku
Woodwind
121
62
Syn Brass 3
Brass
121
77
Shaku 2
Woodwind
121
62
AnalogBras1
Brass
121
78
Whistle
Woodwind
121
62
Jump Brass
Brass
121
78
Whistle 2
Woodwind
121
62
ElectrikBrs
Brass
121
79
Ocarina
Woodwind
121
62
Syn Brass 5
Brass
121
80
Lead Square
Synth 2
121
63
Syn Brass 2
Brass
121
80
LeadSquare2
Synth 2
121
63
Syn Brass 4
Brass
121
80
Lead Sine
Synth 2
121
63
AnalogBras2
Brass
121
80
Old Portam
Synth 2
121
63
Brass Pad
Brass
121
80
Dance Lead
Synth 2
121
63
Big Panner
Synth 1
121
80
Wave Lead
Synth 2
121
64
Soprano Sax
Sax
Synth 2
121
64
Sweet Sprno
Sax
121
65
Alto Sax
Sax
121
80
Sine Wave
121
80
Analog Lead
Synth 2
121
80
Old&Analog
Synth 2
121
65
Alto Breath
Sax
121
80
Gliding Sq.
Synth 2
121
65
SaxEnsemble
Sax
121
10
80
Sine Switch
Synth 2
121
65
BreathyAlto
Sax
121
11
80
Square Rez
Synth 2
121
65
AltSaxGrowl
Sax
121
81
Lead Saw
Synth 2
121
66
Tenor Sax
Sax
121
81
Lead Saw 2
Synth 2
121
66
Tenor Noise
Sax
121
81
LeadSawPuls
Synth 2
121
66
Soft Tenor
Sax
121
81
LeadDblSaw
Synth 2
158
Factory Data
Programs (Program Change order)
CC00 CC32
PC
Name
microARRANGER
GM2
Bank
CC00 CC32
PC
Name
microARRANGER
GM2
Bank
121
81
Seq. Analog
Synth 2
121
91
Itopia Pad
Synth 1
121
81
Power Saw
Synth 2
121
91
Fresh Air
121
81
Octo Lead
Synth 2
121
91
Heaven
Synth 1
121
81
Seq Lead
Synth 2
121
91
Synth 1
121
81
PhatSawLead
Synth 2
121
91
Future Pad
Synth 1
121
81
Glide Lead
Synth 2
121
91
TsunamiWave
Synth 1
121
10
81
Fire Wave
Synth 2
121
91
FreshBreath
Synth 1
121
11
81
Rezbo
Synth 2
121
91
RavelianPad
Synth 1
121
12
81
Syn Pianoid
Synth 2
121
91
FullVox Pad
Synth 1
121
82
Calliope
Synth 2
121
10
91
Dance ReMix
Synth 1
121
83
Chiff
Synth 2
121
92
BowedGlass
Synth 1
121
84
Charang
Synth 2
121
93
MetallicPad
Synth 1
121
84
Wire Lead
Synth 2
121
93
Cosmic
Synth 1
121
84
Synchro City
Synth 2
121
94
Halo Pad
Synth 1
121
84
Sync Kron
Synth 2
121
95
Sweep Pad
Synth 1
121
84
MetallicRez
Synth 2
121
95
AstralDream
Synth 1
121
84
Brian Sync
Synth 2
121
95
Meditate
Synth 1
121
84
Arp Twins
Synth 2
121
95
DarkElement
Synth 1
121
85
Voice Lead
121
95
Mellow Pad
Synth 1
121
85
EtherVoices
121
95
Cinema Pad
Synth 1
121
85
Cyber Choir
121
96
Ice Rain
Synth 1
121
86
Fifths Lead
Synth 2
121
96
MotionOcean
Synth 1
121
86
Crimson5ths
Synth 2
121
96
Caribbean
Synth 1
121
87
Synth 2
121
97
Soundtrack
Synth 1
121
87
Soft Wrl
Synth 2
121
97
Air Clouds
Synth 1
121
87
ElectroLead
Synth 2
121
97
Reso Down
Synth 1
121
87
Rich Lead
Synth 2
121
97
Tinklin Pad
Synth 1
121
87
ThinAnaLead
Synth 2
121
97
Pods In Pad
Synth 1
121
87
EspressLead
Synth 2
121
97
Noble Pad
Synth 1
121
87
HipHop Lead
Synth 2
121
97
Rave
Synth 1
121
87
Square Bass
Synth 2
121
97
ElastickPad
Synth 1
121
87
Synth 2
121
98
Crystal
Synth 2
121
87
Cat Lead
Synth 2
121
98
SynthMallet
SFX
121
88
Synth 1
121
98
Vs Bell Boy
121
88
VirtualTrav
Synth 1
121
98
KrystalBell
121
88
Arp Angeles
Synth 1
121
98
Digi Bell
121
89
Warm Pad
Synth 1
121
98
Moving Bell
Synth 1
121
89
Sine Pad
Synth 1
121
98
Bell Pad
121
89
MasterPad
Synth 1
121
98
Bell Choir
Synth 1
121
89
Power Synth
Synth 1
121
99
Atmosphere
Synth 2
121
89
The Pad
Synth 1
121
100
Brightness
Synth 2
121
89
Money Pad
Synth 1
121
100
Lonely Spin
Synth 1
121
89
Dark Pad
Synth 1
121
100
Syn Ghostly
Synth 1
121
89
Freedom Pad
Synth 1
121
101
Goblins
SFX
121
89
Analog Pad
Synth 1
121
101
MotionRaver
Synth 2
121
89
Analog Pad2
Synth 1
121
101
Digi IcePad
Synth 1
121
90
Polysynth
Synth 1
121
102
Echo Drops
SFX
121
90
Reso Sweep
Synth 1
121
102
Echo Bell
SFX
121
90
Sky Watcher
Synth 1
121
102
Echo Pan
SFX
121
90
Syn Sweeper
Synth 1
121
102
Band Passed
Synth 2
121
90
Super Sweep
Synth 1
121
102
Pan Reso
Synth 2
121
90
Wave Sweep
Synth 1
121
102
Moon Cycles
Synth 1
121
90
Cross Sweep
Synth 1
121
103
Star Theme
SFX
121
90
Dig PolySix
Synth 1
121
104
Sitar
Guitar
121
90
Noisy Stabb
Synth 1
121
104
Sitar 2
Guitar
121
90
Mega Synth
Synth 1
121
104
SitarTambou
Guitar
121
10
90
TecnoPhonic
Synth 1
121
104
IndianStars
Guitar
121
11
90
Farluce
Synth 1
121
104
IndianFrets
Guitar
121
91
Choir Pad
Synth 1
121
104
Bouzouki
Guitar
Factory Data
159
CC00 CC32
PC
Name
microARRANGER
GM2
Bank
CC00 CC32
PC
Name
microARRANGER
GM2
Bank
121
122
Thunder
SFX
121
122
Wind
SFX
Guitar
121
122
Stream
SFX
Oud
Guitar
121
122
Bubble
SFX
105
Jaw Harp
SFX
121
123
Bird Tweet
SFX
106
Shamisen
Guitar
121
123
Dog
SFX
121
107
Koto
Guitar
121
123
HorseGallop
SFX
121
107
Taisho Koto
Guitar
121
123
Bird Tweet2
SFX
121
107
Kanun
Guitar
121
124
Telephone 1
SFX
121
107
Kanun Trem.
Guitar
121
124
Telephone 2
SFX
121
107
Kanun Mix
Guitar
121
124
Door Creak
SFX
121
108
Kalimba
121
124
Door
SFX
121
108
VeloKalimba
121
124
Scratch
SFX
121
109
Bag Pipe
Woodwind
121
124
Wind Chime
SFX
121
109
War Pipes
Woodwind
121
125
Helicopter
SFX
121
110
Fiddle
121
125
Car Engine
SFX
121
111
Shanai
Woodwind
121
125
Car Stop
SFX
121
111
Zurna
Woodwind
121
125
Car Pass
SFX
121
111
Hichiriki
Woodwind
121
125
Car Crash
SFX
121
112
Tinkle Bell
121
125
Siren
SFX
121
112
Gamelan
121
125
Train
SFX
121
112
BaliGamelan
121
125
Jetplane
SFX
121
112
GarbageMall
121
125
Starship
SFX
121
113
Agogo
121
125
Burst Noise
SFX
121
114
Steel Drums
121
126
Applause
SFX
121
114
Warm Steel
121
126
Laughing
SFX
121
115
Woodblock
121
126
Screaming
SFX
121
115
Castanets
121
126
Punch
SFX
121
116
Taiko Drum
121
126
Heart Beat
SFX
121
116
Concert BD
121
126
Footsteps
SFX
121
117
Melodic Tom
121
126
Stadium
SFX
121
117
MelodicTom2
121
127
Gun Shot
SFX
121
117
Rev Tom
121
127
Machine Gun
SFX
121
118
Synth Drum
121
127
Lasergun
SFX
121
118
Rhyt.BoxTom
121
127
Explosion
SFX
121
118
Electr.Drum
121
118
Rev Snare
121
119
Reverse Cym
121
119
Dragon Gong
121
120
GtFretNoise
SFX
121
120
GtrCutNoise
SFX
121
120
AcBassStrng
SFX
121
120
VoxWahChick
Guitar
121
121
BreathNoise
SFX
121
121
Flute Click
Woodwind
121
122
Seashore
SFX
121
122
Rain
SFX
121
104
Tambra
Guitar
121
105
Banjo
Guitar
121
105
BanjoKeyOff
121
105
121
121
160
Factory Data
Drum Kits
DRUM KITS
CC00 CC32
PC
Name
GM2
120
Std. Kit1
120
Std. Kit2
120
Std. Kit3
120
AcousticKit
120
Std. Kit4
120
120
Room Kit1
120
HipHop Kit1
120
10
Jungle Kit
120
11
Techno Kit1
120
12
Room Kit2
120
13
HipHop Kit2
120
14
Techno Kit2
120
15
Techno Kit3
120
16
Power Kit1
120
17
Power Kit2
120
120
24
Electro Kit
120
25
Analog Kit
120
26
House Kit1
57: (remap to 0)
PC
Name
120
27
House Kit2
120
28
House Kit3
120
29
House Kit4
120
120
120
120
40
Brush Kit1
120
41
Brush V.S.2
120
120
120
120
120
120
120
120
120
64
Percus.Kit1
120
65
Latin P.Kit
120
66
TRI-Per.KIT
120
67
i30 Perc.Kit
120
120
72115: (remap to 0)
120
116
Arabian Kit 1
120
117
Arabian Kit 2
120
GM2
Jazz Kit
OrchestraK.
56
Bdrum&Sdrum
SFX Kit
118127: (remap to 0)
Factory Data
161
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
Note
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
BD-House 1
99-SD
88-BD
88-SD
SD-Full Room
SD-Processed
BD-Dry 1
BD-Tight
SD-Dry 1
HH1 Closed2
BD-Dry 3
SideStickAmb
SD-Orch.
SD-Orch.Roll
DrumStickHit
SD-Orch.
SD-Orch.Roll
FingerSnaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ-Scratch2
DJ-Scratch2
DrumStickHit
Zap1
Click
Triangle-Open
BD-Dry 3
BD-Dry 1
SideStickAmb
SD-Dry 2
Hand Claps
SD-Full Room
Tom 2-Floor
HH1 Open 2
Tom 2-Floor
HH2 Foot
Tom 2-Lo
HH1 Open 1
Tom 2-Lo
Tom 2-Hi
Crash Cymbal 1
Tom 2-Hi
Ride-Edge 2
China Cymbal
Ride-Jazz
Tambourin-Acc2
Splash Cymbal
Cowbell
Crash Cymbal 1
Vibraslap
Ride-Edge 2
BongoHi-Open
BongoLo-Open
CongaLoMtSlp
CongaHi-Open
CongaLo-Open
TimbaleHi-Rim2
TimbaleLo-Open
Agogo-Bell
Agogo-Bell
Cabasa-Up
MaracasPush
SambaWhistle
SambaWhistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica-Hi
Cuica-Lo
Triangle-Mute
Triangle-Open
Cabasa-Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
CastSingle
TimbaleLo-Mute
TimbaleLo-Open
Stadium
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
BD-House 1
99-SD
88-BD
88-SD
SD-Off Center
SD-Processed
BD-Pillow
BD-Amb.Rocker
SD-BrushHit
HH1 Closed2
BD-Jazz
SideStickDry
SD-Brasser
SD-Dry 2
DrumStickHit
SD-Orch.
SD-Orch.Roll
FingerSnaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ-Scratch2
DJ-Scratch2
DrumStickHit
Zap1
Click
Triangle-Open
BD-Dry 1
BD-Tubby
SideStickAmb
SD-Jazz Ring
88-Claps
SD-Amb.Piccolo
Tom 2-Floor
HH2 Closed1
Tom 2-Floor
HH2 Foot
Tom 2-Lo
HH1 Open 1
Tom 2-Lo
Tom 2-Hi
Crash Cymbal 1
Tom 2-Hi
Ride-Edge 2
China Cymbal
Ride-Jazz
Tambourin-Acc2
Splash Cymbal
Cowbell
Crash Cymbal 1
Vibraslap
Ride-Edge 2
BongoHi-Open
BongoLo-Open
CongaHiMtSlap
CongaHi-Open
CongaLo-Open
TimbaleHi-Rim2
TimbaleLo-Open
Agogo-Bell
Agogo-Bell
Cabasa-Up
MaracasPush
SambaWhistle
SambaWhistle
Guiro Short
Guiro Long
Claves
Woodblock1
Woodblock1
Cuica-Hi
Cuica-Lo
Triangle-Mute
Triangle-Open
Cabasa-Down
Sleigh Bell
Marc Tree
CastSingle
TimbaleLo-Mute
TimbaleLo-Open
Stadium
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
162
Factory Data
Drum Kit instruments
Note
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
120-0-3: AcousticKit
120-0-4: Std. Kit4
Sample
Excl.
Sample
17
BD-House 1
Off
17
BD-House 1
125 99-SD
Off
125 99-SD
123 88-BD
Off
123 88-BD
124 88-SD
Off
124 88-SD
38
SD-Off Center
Off
38
SD-Off Center
49
SD-CrackerRoom
Off
48
SD-Processed
6
BD-Pillow
Off
27
BD-Amb.Rocker
27
BD-Amb.Rocker
Off
12
BD-Tight
40
SD-Amb.Piccolo
Off
39
SD-Jazz Ring
87
HH1 Closed2
1
87
HH1 Closed2
5
BD-Jazz
Off
2
BD-Dry 3
72
SideStickDry
Off
72
SideStickDry
120 SD-Orch.
7
32
SD-Dry 2
119 SD-Orch.Roll
7
31
SD-Dry 1
74
DrumStickHit
Off
74
DrumStickHit
120 SD-Orch.
7
120 SD-Orch.
119 SD-Orch.Roll
7
119 SD-Orch.Roll
121 FingerSnaps
Off
121 FingerSnaps
Off
143 Zap2
143 Zap2
281 Noise White
Off
281 Noise White
145 DJ-Scratch2
7
145 DJ-Scratch2
145 DJ-Scratch2
7
145 DJ-Scratch2
74
DrumStickHit
Off
74
DrumStickHit
142 Zap1
Off
142 Zap1
249 Click
Off
249 Click
213 Triangle-Open
Off
213 Triangle-Open
3
BD-Normal
Off
2
BD-Dry 3
06 BD-Dry 1BD-Pillow
Off
12
BD-Tight
73
SideStickAmb
Off
73
SideStickAmb
40
SD-Amb.Piccolo
3536 SD-Ghost fSD-Ghost p Off
122 Hand Claps
Off
127 88-Claps
37
SD-Full Room
3536 SD-Ghost fSD-Ghost p Off
79
Tom 2-Floor
Off
79
Tom 2-Floor
90
HH1 Open 2
1
90
HH1 Open 2
79
Tom 2-Floor
Off
79
Tom 2-Floor
94
HH2 Foot
1
94
HH2 Foot
78
Tom 2-Lo
Off
78
Tom 2-Lo
89
HH1 Open 1
1
89
HH1 Open 1
78
Tom 2-Lo
Off
78
Tom 2-Lo
77
Tom 2-Hi
Off
77
Tom 2-Hi
104 Crash Cymbal 1
Off
104 Crash Cymbal 1
77
Tom 2-Hi
Off
77
Tom 2-Hi
113 Ride-Edge 2
Off
113 Ride-Edge 2
106 China Cymbal
Off
106 China Cymbal
115 Ride-Cup
Off
114 Ride-Jazz
212 Tambourin-Acc2
Off
212 Tambourin-Acc2
107 Splash Cymbal
Off
107 Splash Cymbal
225 Cowbell
Off
225 Cowbell
104 Crash Cymbal 1
Off
104 Crash Cymbal 1
198 Vibraslap
Off
198 Vibraslap
114 Ride-Jazz
Off
113 Ride-Edge 2
171 BongoHi-Open
Off
171 BongoHi-Open
168 BongoLo-Open
Off
168 BongoLo-Open
163 CongaHiMtSlap
Off
163 CongaHiMtSlap
161 CongaHi-Open
Off
161 CongaHi-Open
158 CongaLo-Open
Off
158 CongaLo-Open
207 TimbaleHi-Rim2
Off
207 TimbaleHi-Rim2
202 TimbaleLo-Open
Off
202 TimbaleLo-Open
224 Agogo-Bell
Off
224 Agogo-Bell
224 Agogo-Bell
Off
224 Agogo-Bell
219 Cabasa-Up
Off
219 Cabasa-Up
182 MaracasPush
Off
182 MaracasPush
234 SambaWhistle
2
234 SambaWhistle
234 SambaWhistle
2
234 SambaWhistle
181 Guiro Short
3
181 Guiro Short
3
180 Guiro Long
180 Guiro Long
199 Claves
Off
199 Claves
200 Woodblock1
Off
200 Woodblock1
200 Woodblock1
Off
200 Woodblock1
215 Cuica-Hi
4
215 Cuica-Hi
216 Cuica-Lo
4
216 Cuica-Lo
214 Triangle-Mute
5
214 Triangle-Mute
213 Triangle-Open
5
213 Triangle-Open
220 Cabasa-Down
Off
220 Cabasa-Down
228 Sleigh Bell
Off
228 Sleigh Bell
231 Marc Tree
Off
231 Marc Tree
178 CastSingle
Off
178 CastSingle
203 TimbaleLo-Mute
6
203 TimbaleLo-Mute
202 TimbaleLo-Open
6
202 TimbaleLo-Open
243 Stadium
Off
243 Stadium
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Factory Data
163
Note
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
164
Factory Data
Drum Kit instruments
Note
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Factory Data
165
Note
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
166
Factory Data
Drum Kit instruments
Note
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Factory Data
167
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
Note
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
4
4
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
2
Off
3
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
4
4
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
2
Off
3
168
Factory Data
Drum Kit instruments
(continued)
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
Note
F6
F#6
G6
G#6
A6
A#6
B6
C7
120-0-48: OrchestraK
Excl.
Sample
Excl.
Excl.
3
3
5
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Excl.
3
3
5
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Factory Data
169
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
0
296
235
153
148
154
145
286
287
292
294
290
291
143
258
144
145
74
143
249
224
289
286
287
286
121
246
245
256
255
248
247
244
260
261
145
231
262
263
264
265
254
266
281
267
298
258
269
270
271
252
253
250
259
272
Excl.
181
209
210
211
211
212
212
209
212
319
233
230
BD-Dry 1
Off
197
Amp Noise
Off
172
Chinese Gong
Off
173
DJ-BD Rub
Off
170
DJ-Scratch3c
Off
211
DJ-SD Rub
Off
224
DJ-Scratch2
Off
273
GtCutNois1
Off
224
GtCutNois2
Off
174
E.GtrPick1
Off
200
Gtr Scratch1
Off
199
Dist.Slide1
Off
201
Dist.Slide2
Off
225
Zap2
Off
200
GunShot 1
Off
179
DJ-Scratch1
7
184
DJ-Scratch2
7
217
DrumStickHit
Off
186
Zap2
Off
182
Click
Off
184
Agogo-Bell
Off
219
Fret Noise
Off
190
GtCutNois1
Off
192
GtCutNois2
Off
198
GtCutNois1
Off
189
FingerSnaps
Off
214
Laughing
Off
116
Scream
Off
213
Punch
Off
181
Heart-Beat
Off
311
Footsteps 2
Off
180
Footsteps 1
Off
232
Applause
Off
231
DoorCreak
Off
182
DoorSlam
Off
122
DJ-Scratch2
Off
127
Marc Tree
Off
144
Car Engine
Off
145
Car Stop
Off
150
Car Pass
Off
234
Car Crash
Off
234
Crickets
Off
165
Train
Off
166
Noise White
Off
161
Helicopter
Off
158
Swish Terra
Off
215
GunShot 1
Off
216
MachineGun
Off
208
Laser gun
Off
207
Explosion
Off
206
Dog
Off
202
Gallop
Off
135
136
Bird 1
Off
Rainstick
Off
121
Thunder
Off
196
(continues on the next page)
120-0-64: Percus.Kit1
Sample
Excl.
Guiro Short
Tambourin-Push
Tambourin-Pull
Tambourin-Acc1
Tambourin-Acc1
Tambourin-Acc2
Tambourin-Acc2
Tambourin-Push
Tambourin-Acc2
Rek-Jingle
Flexatone
Finger Cymbal
Tsuzumi
BongoHi-Slap
BongoHi-Stk1
BongoLo-Stk
Tambourin-Acc1
Agogo-Bell
Wind
Agogo-Bell
BongoHi-Stk2
Woodblock1
Claves
Woodblock2
Cowbell
Woodblock1
CastDouble
Baya-Open
Shaker1
Baya-Mute1
MaracasPush
Baya-Open
Cabasa-Up
Tabla-Open
Tabla-Mute1
Vibraslap
Tabla-Na
Triangle-Mute
BD-Orch.
Triangle-Open
Guiro Short
Jingle Bell
Guiro Long
Marc Tree LP
Marc Tree
MaracasPush
Hand Claps
88-Claps
DJ-Scratch1
DJ-Scratch2
DJ-HitRub
SambaWhistle
SambaWhistle
CongaHi-Slap2
CongaHeel
CongaHi-Open
CongaLo-Open
Cuica-Hi
Cuica-Lo
Timbale-Paila
TimbaleHi-Rim2
TimbaleHi-Rim1
TimbaleLo-Open
88-Clave
88-Cowbell
FingerSnaps
Taiko Rim
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
3
Off
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
240
238
237
241
214
213
233
230
136
179
178
121
121
99
236
197
197
197
116
116
224
224
158
159
164
165
137
161
214
213
159
162
165
211
161
170
170
173
202
174
202
211
208
205
208
205
207
206
318
318
318
319
227
200
201
225
182
227
219
217
225
220
220
Hit It
Yeah!-Solo
Yeah!
Uhhhh Solo
Triangle-Mute
Triangle-Open
Flexatone
Finger Cymbal
88-Cowbell
CastDouble
CastSingle
FingerSnaps
FingerSnaps
HH-Old TiteClos
Metal Hit
Tsuzumi
Tsuzumi
Tsuzumi
BD-Orch.
BD-Orch.
Agogo-Bell
Agogo-Bell
CongaLo-Open
CongaLoMtSlp
CongaHi-Slap1
CongaHi-Slap2
88-Maraca
CongaHi-Open
Triangle-Mute
Triangle-Open
CongaLoMtSlp
CongaHiMute
CongaHi-Slap2
Tambourin-Acc1
CongaHi-Open
BongoLo-Stk
BongoLo-Stk
BongoHi-Stk1
TimbaleLo-Open
BongoHi-Stk2
TimbaleLo-Open
Tambourin-Acc1
Timbale-Paila
TimbaleHi-Edge
Timbale-Paila
TimbaleHi-Edge
TimbaleHi-Rim2
TimbaleHi-Rim1
Rek-dom-ak
Rek-dom-ak
Rek-dom-ak
Rek-Jingle
Mambo Bell
Woodblock1
Woodblock2
Cowbell
MaracasPush
Mambo Bell
Cabasa-Up
Shaker1
Cowbell
Cabasa-Down
Cabasa-Down
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Factory Data
170
(continued)
Note
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
115
117
118
119
120
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
F6
F#6
G6
G#6
A6
A#6
B6
C7
C#7
D7
D#7
E7
F7
F#7
G7
G#7
A7
A#7
B7
C8
C#8
D8
D#8
E8
F8
F#8
G8
G#8
A8
A#8
B8
C9
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
120-0-64: Percus.Kit1
Sample
195 Taiko Open
143 Zap2
119 SD-Orch.Roll
120 SD-Orch.
117 Orch Cymb
117 Orch Cymb
336 Udu-f-open
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
155 Orchestra Hit
290 Dist.Slide1
291 Dist.Slide2
286 GtCutNois1
287 GtCutNois2
292 E.GtrPick1
293 E.GtrPick2
294 Gtr Scratch1
295 Gtr Scratch2
289 Fret Noise
288 Power Chord
288 Power Chord
296 Amp Noise
Excl.
Off
Off
5
5
6
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
5
5
6
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
3
3
3
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
5
Off
Off
Off
2
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Factory Data
Drum Kit instruments
Note
0
C-1
1
C#-1
2
D-1
3
D#-1
4
E-1
5
F-1
6
F#-1
7
G-1
8
G#-1
9
A-1
10
A#-1
11
B-1
12
C0
13
C#0
14
D0
15
D#0
16
E0
17
F0
18
F#0
19
G0
20
G#0
21
A0
22
A#0
23
B0
24
C1
25
C#1
26
D1
D#1
27
28
E1
29
F1
30
F#1
31
G1
32
G#1
33
A1
34
A#1
35
B1
36
C2
37
C#2
38
D2
39
D#2
40
E2
41
F2
42
F#2
43
G2
44
G#2
45
A2
46
A#2
47
B2
48
C3
49
C#3
50
D3
51
D#3
52
E3
53
F3
54
F#3
55
G3
56
G#3
57
A3
58
A#3
59
B3
60
C4
61
C#4
62
D4
63
D#4
64
E4
65
F4
66
F#4
67
G4
68
G#4
69
A4
70
A#4
71
B4
72
C5
73
C#5
74
D5
75
D#5
76
E5
77
F5
78
F#5
79
G5
80
G#5
81
A5
82
A#5
120-0-66: TRI-Per.KIT
Sample
322
321
320
319
318
303
195
317
316
315
314
313
196195
197
175175
177176
185184
186187
188303
190190
191194
192193
189193
192
116
257
121
122
214
213
179
178
179
180
181
180
198
199
135
216216
215215
202
200
204
200
203
200
205
207
226
206
227
208208
168
225
169
225
171
174
172172
158158
160
159
163
161161
162
166
164
167
165
224
Excl.
Rik3
Off
Rik2
Off
Rik1
Off
Rek-Jingle
Off
Rek-dom-ak
Off
Djembe-Bass
Off
Taiko Open
Off
Pand-Pattern4
Off
Pand-Pattern3
Off
Pand-Pattern2
Off
Pand-Pattern1
Off
Pand-Open
Off
Taiko RimTaiko Open
Off
TsuzumiTsuzumi
Off
Djembe-OpenDjembe-Open
Off
Djembe-SlapDjembe-Mute
Off
Baya-GheBaya-Open
Off
Baya-Mute1Baya-Mute2
Off
Baya-Mute5Djembe-Bass
Off
Tabla-OpenTabla-Open
Off
Tabla-TinTabla-Mute3
Off
Tabla-Mute1Tabla-Mute2
Off
Tabla-NaTabla-Mute2
6
Tabla-Mute1
Off
BD-Orch.
Off
Tribe
Off
FingerSnaps
Off
Hand Claps
Off
Triangle-Mute
1
Triangle-Open
1
CastDouble
Off
CastSingle
Off
CastDouble
Off
Guiro Long
2
Guiro Short
2
Guiro Long
2
Vibraslap
Off
Claves
Off
88-Clave
Off
Cuica-LoCuica-Lo
3
Cuica-HiCuica-Hi
Off
TimbaleLo-Open
Off
Woodblock1
Off
TimbaleLo-Rim
Off
Woodblock1
Off
TimbaleLo-Mute
Off
Woodblock1
Off
TimbaleHi-Edge
Off
TimbaleHi-Rim2
Off
ChachaBell
Off
TimbaleHi-Rim1
Off
Mambo Bell
Off
Timbale-PailaTimbale-Paila
Off
BongoLo-Open
Off
Cowbell
Off
BongoLo-Slap
Off
Cowbell
Off
BongoHi-Open
Off
BongoHi-Stk2
Off
Off
BongoHi-SlapBongoHi-Slap
CongaLo-OpenCongaLo-Open
Off
CongaLoSlap
Off
CongaLoMtSlp
Off
CongaHiMtSlap
Off
CongaHi-OpenCongaHi-Open
Off
CongaHiMute
Off
CongaHeel
Off
CongaHi-Slap1
Off
CongaToe
Off
CongaHi-Slap2
Off
Agogo-Bell
Off
(continues on the next page)
209
212
189
233
230
197
172
173
170
211
224
273
224
174
200
199
201
225
200
179
184
217
186
182
184
219
190
192
198
189
214
116
213
181
311
180
232
231
182
122
127
144
145
150
234
234
165
166
161
158
215
216
208
207
206
202
135
136
121
196
195
143
Tambourin-Push
Tambourin-Acc2
Tabla-Na
Flexatone
Finger Cymbal
Tsuzumi
BongoHi-Slap
BongoHi-Stk1
BongoLo-Stk
Tambourin-Acc1
Agogo-Bell
Wind
Agogo-Bell
BongoHi-Stk2
Woodblock1
Claves
Woodblock2
Cowbell
Woodblock1
CastDouble
Baya-Open
Shaker1
Baya-Mute1
MaracasPush
Baya-Open
Cabasa-Up
Tabla-Open
Tabla-Mute1
Vibraslap
Tabla-Na
Triangle-Mute
BD-Orch.
Triangle-Open
Guiro Short
Jingle Bell
Guiro Long
Marc Tree LP
Marc Tree
MaracasPush
Hand Claps
88-Claps
DJ-Scratch1
DJ-Scratch2
DJ-HitRub
SambaWhistle
SambaWhistle
CongaHi-Slap2
CongaHeel
CongaHi-Open
CongaLo-Open
Cuica-Hi
Cuica-Lo
Timbale-Paila
TimbaleHi-Rim2
TimbaleHi-Rim1
TimbaleLo-Open
88-Clave
88-Cowbell
FingerSnaps
Taiko Rim
Taiko Open
Zap2
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
3
Off
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
171
172
Factory Data
Drum Kit instruments
Note
83
B5
84
C6
85
C#6
86
D6
87
D#6
88
E6
89
F6
90
F#6
91
G6
92
G#6
93
A6
94
A#6
95
B6
96
C7
97
C#7
98
D7
99
D#7
100
E7
101
F7
102
F#7
103
G7
104
G#7
105
A7
106
A#7
107
B7
108
C8
109
C#8
110
D8
111
D#8
112
E8
F8
113
114
F#8
115
G8
115
G#8
117
A8
118
A#8
119
B8
120
C9
(continued)
120-0-66: TRI-Per.KIT
Sample
224
Agogo-Bell
183182 MaracasPullMaracasPush
217217 Shaker1Shaker1
218218 Shaker2Shaker2
221220 Cabasa-TapCabasa-Down
219221 Cabasa-UpCabasa-Tap
222223 Caxixi-HardCaxixi-Soft
209
Tambourin-Push
211211 Tambourin-Acc1Tambourin-Acc1
210
Tambourin-Pull
212
Tambourin-Acc2
228228 Sleigh BellSleigh Bell
234
SambaWhistle
234
SambaWhistle
229
RapSleighBell
234
SambaWhistle
231
Marc Tree
234
SambaWhistle
312
Bells Open
259
Rainstick
235
Chinese Gong
250
Bird 1
250
Bird 1
251
Bird 2
279
Cricket Spectrum
231
Marc Tree
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
4
4
Off
4
5
4
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Excl.
5
5
6
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
3
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Factory Data
173
Performances
PERFORMANCES
AllPerformancesareusereditable.UsethefollowingtableasamodelforyourownPerfomancelists.
Note:YoucanremotelyselectPerformancesonthemicroARRANGER,bysendingitBankSelectMSB(CC#0),BankSelect
LSB(CC#32)andProgramChangemessagesontheControlchannel(seepage128).
#
1
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
Bank: 1
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
Bank: 2
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
Bank: 3
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
Bank: 5
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
Bank: 6
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
Bank: 7
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
PC
Bank: 9
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
Bank: 10
CC#0 CC#32
1
10
PC
Bank: 11
CC#0 CC#32
1
11
PC
12
PC
Bank: 13
CC#0 CC#32
1
13
PC
Bank: 14
CC#0 CC#32
1
14
PC
Bank: 15
CC#0 CC#32
1
15
PC
16
PC
0
Bank: 17
CC#0 CC#32
1
17
PC
0
Bank: 18
CC#0 CC#32
1
18
PC
0
Bank: 19
CC#0 CC#32
1
19
Bank: 16
CC#0 CC#32
Bank: 12
CC#0 CC#32
Bank: 8
CC#0 CC#32
Bank: 4
PC
0
Bank: 20
174
Factory Data
MIDI Setup
MIDI SETUP
DEFAULT
Master Kbd
Sequencer1
Sequencer 2
Accordion 1
S1_Tr 1
Global
S1_Tr 1
S2_Tr 1
Global
S1_Tr 2
S1_Tr 2
S2_Tr 2
Lower
S1_Tr 3
S1_Tr 3
S2_Tr 3
Bass
S1_Tr 4
S1_Tr 4
S2_Tr 4
S1_Tr 5
S1_Tr 5
S2_Tr 5
S1_Tr 6
S1_Tr 6
S1_Tr 7
S1_Tr 8
9
10
MIDI IN
Channel
Accordion 2
Accordion 3
Ext. Seq
Upp1
Upp1
S1_Tr 1
Lower
Lower
S1_Tr 2
Bass
S1_Tr 3
Upp2
Upp2
S1_Tr 4
Upp3
Upp3
S1_Tr 5
S2_Tr 6
S1_Tr 6
S1_Tr 7
S2_Tr 7
S1_Tr 7
S1_Tr 8
S2_Tr 8
S1_Tr 8
S1_Tr 9
S1_Tr 9
S2_Tr 9
Bass
S1_Tr 9
S1_Tr 10
S1_Tr 10
S2_Tr 10
Drum
Drum
Drum
S1_Tr 10
11
S1_Tr 11
S1_Tr 11
S2_Tr 11
Perc
Perc
Perc
S1_Tr 11
12
S1_Tr 12
S1_Tr 12
S2_Tr 12
Acc1
Acc1
Acc1
S1_Tr 12
13
S1_Tr 13
S1_Tr 13
S2_Tr 13
Acc2
Acc2
Acc2
S1_Tr 13
14
S1_Tr 14
S1_Tr 14
S2_Tr 14
Acc3
Acc3
Acc3
S1_Tr 14
15
S1_Tr 15
S1_Tr 15
S2_Tr 15
Acc4
Acc4
Acc4
S1_Tr 15
16
S1_Tr 16
S1_Tr 16
S2_Tr 16
Acc5
Acc5
Acc5
S1_Tr 16
1 Upp1
Upp1
S1_Tr 1
S2_Tr 1
Upp1
S1_Tr 1
S2_Tr 1
Upp. 1
Upp2
Upp2
S1_Tr 2
S2_Tr 2
Upp2
S1_Tr 2
S2_Tr 2
Upp3
Upp3
S1_Tr 3
S2_Tr 3
Upp3
S1_Tr 3
S2_Tr 3
Lower
Lower
S1_Tr 4
S2_Tr 4
Lower
S1_Tr 4
S2_Tr 4
S1_Tr 5
S2_Tr 5
S1_Tr 5
S2_Tr 5
S1_Tr 6
S2_Tr 6
S1_Tr 6
S2_Tr 6
S1_Tr 7
S2_Tr 7
S1_Tr 7
S2_Tr 7
S1_Tr 8
S2_Tr 8
S1_Tr 8
S2_Tr 8
Bass
Bass
S1_Tr 9
S2_Tr 9
Bass
S1_Tr 9
S2_Tr 9
10
Drum
Drum
S1_Tr 10
S2_Tr 10
Drum
S1_Tr 10
S2_Tr 10
11
Perc
Perc
S1_Tr 11
S2_Tr 11
Perc
S1_Tr 11
S2_Tr 11
12
Acc1
Acc1
S1_Tr 12
S2_Tr 12
Acc1
S1_Tr 12
S2_Tr 12
13
Acc2
Acc2
S1_Tr 13
S2_Tr 13
Acc2
S1_Tr 13
S2_Tr 13
14
Acc3
Acc3
S1_Tr 14
S2_Tr 14
Acc3
S1_Tr 14
S2_Tr 14
15
Acc4
Acc4
S1_Tr 15
S2_Tr 15
Acc4
S1_Tr 15
S2_Tr 15
16
Acc5
Acc5
S1_Tr 16
S2_Tr 16
Acc5
S1_Tr 16
S2_Tr 16
MIDI IN Velocity
Normal
Normal
Normal
Normal
110
110
Normal
Normal
Chord 1 Chann.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Chord 2 Chann.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
MIDI OUT
Channel
Effects
175
Diagrams
18. EFFECTS
microARRANGER is equipped with four powerful
Effect Processors (A, B, C, D). You can send them the
internaltracks.
Note
MIDI(CC#19)
MIDI(CC#20)
DIAGRAMS
MIDI(CC#21)
Modulation source
Diagram
Left
Off
No modulation
Gate1
Portamento Switch
Sostenu: #66
Sostenuto Pedal
MIDI(CC#80)
MIDI(CC#81)
MIDI(CC#82)
MIDI(CC#83)
Tempo
Whenthe
symbolisencoutered,aDynamicMod
ulationcanbeappliedtothecorrespondingparameter.
The following table shows the available modulation
sources.
Note
Prta.SW: #65
Right
Modulation source
Damper: #64
FILTER/DYNAMIC
Filter and dynamics control effects
000: No Effect
Select this option when you do not use any effects.
Whenthisoptionisselected,theeffectismuted.
Gate1+Dmpr
Thiseffectsimulatesthefrequencyresponsecharacter
istics of guitar amplifiers. It is also effective for organ
anddrumsounds.
Gate2
Gate2+Dmpr
Note Nr
Note Number
Velocity
Note Velocity
ATouch
After Touch
JS X
Joystick Left/Right
JS+Y: CC#01
Joystick Forward
JS-Y: CC#02
Joystick Backward
MIDI(CC#04)
Right
Wet / Dry
MIDI(CC#12)
Wet/Dry
Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds
MIDI(CC#13)
MIDI(CC#16)
MIDI(CC#18)
MIDI(CC#17)
Amplifier Type
Selects the type of guitar amplifier
Src
Selects the modulation source of the effect balance
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance
100...+100
176
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
002: Compressor
003: Limiter
(Stereo Compressor)
(Stereo Limiter)
Thiseffectcompressestheinputsignaltoregulatethe
levelandgiveapunchyeffect.Itisusefulforguitar,
piano, and drum sounds. This is a stereo compressor.
Youcanlinkleftandrightchannels,oruseeachchan
nelseparately.
TheLimiterregulatestheinputsignallevel.Itissimilar
totheCompressor,exceptthattheLimitercompresses
only signals that exceed the specified level to lower
unnecessarypeaksignals.TheLimiterappliesapeak
ingtype EQ to the trigger signal (which controls the
degree of the Limiter effect), allowing you to set any
bandwidthtobecovered.Thiseffectisastereolimiter.
Youcanlinkleftandrightchannels,oruseeachchan
nelindividually.
Wet / Dry
EQ Trim
LEQ
HEQ
Compressor
Output Level
Envelope - Control
Envelope Select
Envelope - Control
LEQ
Output Level
Compressor
EQ Trim
Left
Wet / Dry
HEQ
Gain Adjust
Right
Limiter
Wet / Dry
Side PEQ
Envelope - Control
+
Envelope Select
Envelope Select
L/R Mix, L/R Individually
Determines whether the left and right channels are linked or used separately
Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
1...100
Attack
Sets the attack level
1...100
EQ Trim
Sets the EQ input level
0...100
15.0...+15.0dB
15.0...+15.0dB
0...100
Gain Adjust
Wet / Dry
Envelope Select
L/R Mix, L Only, R Only, L/R Individually
Selects from linking both channels, controlling only from left channel, only
from the right channel, or controlling each channel individually
Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied
100...+100
e
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
1...100
Release
Sets the release time
1...100
Src
Selects the modulation source for the output gain
Inf, 38...+24dB
,
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the output gain
63...+63
Off, On
Trigger Monitor
Switches between effect output monitor and trigger signal monitor
Off, On
100...+100
a: Envelope Select
This parameter selects whether the left and right channels are
linked to control both signals simultaneously, or whether each
channel is controlled independently.
b: Sensitivity, f: Output Level
The Sensitivity parameter sets the sensitivity of the compressor. If this parameter is set to a higher value, lower level
sounds will be boosted. With a higher Sensitivity, the overall
volume level is higher. To adjust the final volume level, use
the Output Level parameter.
40...0dB
Attack
Sets the attack time
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the compressor output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the compressor output level
Limiter
Right
Output Level
Sets the output level of the compressor
Trigger Monitor
Envelope - Control
Q
Sets the EQ bandwidth for the trigger signal
Gain [dB]
Sets the EQ gain for the trigger signal
20...12.00kHz
0.5...10.0
18.0...+18.0dB
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Compressor - Sensitivity
Level
Wet
Louder
Sensitivity=100
Dry
Sensitivity=40
Time
c: Attack
This parameter controls the attack level.
Compressor - Attack
Level
Attack=80
Attack=20
Wet
Dry
Time
a: Envelope Select
When L/R Mix is selected for this parameter, the left and right
channels are linked to control the Limiter using the mixed signal. If L Only (or R Only) is selected, the left and right channels are linked, and the Limiter is controlled via only the left
(or right) channel.
With L/R individually, the left and right channels control the
Limiter individually.
b: Ratio, c: Threshold [dB], e: Gain Adjust [dB]
This parameter sets the signal compression Ratio. Compression is applied only when the signal level exceeds the
Threshold value.
Effects
177
Filter/Dynamic
004: MBandLimit
(Multiband Limiter)
Ratio=4.0 : 1
Louder
Ration=Inf : 1
Louder
Input Level
Left
Level
Dry
Band-Pass Filters
Low
Ratio=1.0 : 1
Ratio=2.0 : 1
Ratio=4.0 : 1
Threshold
Mid
Wet / Dry
Limiter
Envelope - Control
Low Offset
Limiter
Envelope - Control
High Mid Offset
Ratio=Inf : 1
Gain Adjust
Limiter
Time
d: Attack, d: Release
These parameters set the attack time and release time. A
higher attack time will cause the compression to be applied
more slowly.
Right
Envelope - Control
High Offset
Wet / Dry
Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied
Attack
Sets the attack time
1...100
Fx:003
Release
Sets the release time
1...100
Fx:003
40...0dB
40...0dB
40...0dB
40...0dB
Fx:003
Ratio=Inf : 1
Attack=1
Release=1
Wet
Ratio=Inf : 1
Attack=100
Release=100
Wet
Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003,
Release
Attack
Src
Selects the modulation source for the output gain
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the output gain
Off...Tempo
63...+63
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
178
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
005: Gate
The Attack and Release parameters set the Gate attack time
and release time.
(Stereo Gate)
Gate - Threshold
Output Level
Louder
Threshold
Louder
Input Level
Left
Wet / Dry
Gate - Attack / Release
Delay
Gate
Threshold
Envelope - Control
Envelope - Control
Envelope Select
Delay
Dry
Gate
Right
Wet / Dry
Gate+Sus
Envelope Select
D-mod, L/R Mix, L Only, R Only
Selects from Control via the modulation source, mixing the left and right signals, Only left, and Only right
,
a
Src
Off...Gate2+Dmpr
Selects the modulation source that controls the gate when Envelope Select =
D-mod
b
Polarity
Switches between non-reversed and reversed Gate on/off
+,
Threshold
Sets the level to which the Gate is applied
0...100
Attack
Sets the attack time
1...100
Release
Sets the release time
1...100
0...100msec
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
Attack=1
Release=1
Wet
Attack=100
Release=100
Release
Attack
e: Delay Time
This parameter sets the delay time of the Gate input. If the
sound has a very fast attack, increase the delay time so that
the signal will be input after the Gate is opened. This will preserve the attack part of the sound.
006: OD/HGainWah
(Overdrive/Hi.Gain Wah)
ThisdistortioneffectutilizesanOverdrivemodeanda
HiGain mode. Controlling the wah effect, the 3band
EQ, and the amp simulation will allow you to create
versatile distortion sounds. This effect is suitable for
guitarandorgansounds.
100...+100
Wet
Wet / Dry
Pre Low-cut
Wah
Right
Wet / Dry
D-mod
Wah
Switches Wah on/off
a
Off, On
,
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that switches the Wah on and off
Sw
Toggle, Moment
Selects the switching mode for the modulation source that switches the Wah
on and off
10...+10
,
b
Wah Sweep Src
Selects the modulation source that controls the Wah
c
Drive Mode
Switches between overdrive and hi-gain distortion
Off...Tempo
Overdrive, Hi-Gain
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion
1...100
d
Pre Low-cut
Sets the low range cut amount of the distortion input
Output Level
Sets the output level
e
Src
Selects the modulation source for the output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the output level
0...10
0...50
Off...Tempo
50...+50
Effects
179
Filter/Dynamic
20...1.0kHz
f
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 176
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1
007: Param.4B Eq
0.5...10.0
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
Direct Mix
Sets the amount of the dry sound mixed to the distortion
Trim
0.5...10.0
PEQ
PEQ
LEQ
HEQ
LEQ
Trim
18...+18dB
PEQ
Wet / Dry
PEQ
HEQ
PEQ
PEQ
PEQ
Right
0...50
Wet / Dry
D-mod
i
Speaker Simulation
Switches the speaker simulation on/off
Off, On
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
Trim
Sets the input level
Band1 Type
Selects the type of Band 1
Peaking, Shelving-Low
Band4 Type
Selects the type of Band 4
Peaking, Shelving-High
100...+100
a: Wah
The Wah parameter switches the wah effect on/off.
a: Sw
This parameter sets how the wah effect is switched on and off
via the modulation source.
When Sw = Moment, the wah effect is usually turned off. It
is turned on only when you press the pedal or operate the joystick.
When a value for the modulation source is less than 64, off speed
is selected, and when the value is 64 or higher, on is selected.
Off...Tempo
Amt [dB]
Sets the modulation amount of Band 2 gain
18...+18dB
20...1.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
18.0...+18.0dB
50...10.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
0...100
18.0...+18.0dB
,
300...10.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
18.0...+18.0dB
500...20.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
18.0...+18.0dB
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
3dB
Band4 Type=Shelving High
Band4 Type=Peaking
0dB
Gain
Band4 Cutoff
180
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
D-mod
+15dB
009: Wah/AutoWah
Band2 Cutoff
+6dB
+6dB
0dB
0dB
Band2 Cutoff
9dB
Band2 Gain[dB]= +6.0
Band2 Dynamic Gain Amt[dB]= +9.0
D-mod
Thisstereowaheffectallowsyoutocreatesoundsfrom
vintagewahpedalsimulationtoautowahsimulation,
andmuchbroaderrangesettings.
008: Graph.7B Eq
Wet / Dry
Wah
Envelope Sens
Thisisastereo7bandgraphicequalizer.Thebargraph
of the gain setting for each band gives you a clear,
visual idea of frequency responses. You can select a
center frequency setting for each band from twelve
types,accordingtothesound.
Wah
Frequency Bottom
Sets the lower limit of the wah center frequency
0...100
Frequency Top
Sets the upper limit of the wah center frequency
0...100
Sweep Mode
Auto, D-mod, LFO
Selects the control from auto-wah, modulation source, and LFO
,
Type
1:Wide 1, 2:Wide 2, 3:Wide 3, 4:Half Wide 1, 5:Half Wide 2, 6:Half
Wide 3, 7:Low, 8:Wide Low, 9:Mid, 10:Wide Mid, 11:High, 12:Wide High
Selects a combination of center frequencies for each band
Trim
Sets the input level
Band1 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
18.0...+18.0dB
Band2 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
18.0...+18.0dB
Band3 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
18.0...+18.0dB
Band4 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
18.0...+18.0dB
Band5 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 5
18.0...+18.0dB
Band6 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 6
18.0...+18.0dB
Band7 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 7
18.0...+18.0dB
0...100
0...100
0...100
100...+100
0.02...20.00Hz
,
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
,
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Base Note
, , , , , , ,
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
x1...x16
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
0...100
Off, On
100...+100
a: Type
This parameter selects a combination of center frequencies
for each band. Each center frequency is shown on the right
edge of the LCD.
Response
Sets the response speed when Sweep Mode = Auto or D-mod
Envelope Shape
Sets the sweep curve of auto-wah
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the wah when Sweep Mode=D-mod
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
Wet / Dry
Trim
LFO
Right
Left
Trim
Sweep Mode
Auto
D-mod
LFO
Envelope Shape
Response
D-mod
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Effects
181
Filter/Dynamic
Wah
Higher
Bottom=60
Wah
Left
Woo
Wet / Dry
Top=30
Woo
Bottom=25
Higher
Frequency
Filter
D-mod
Higher
Zero
D-mod
Higher
Zero
Max
Max
Filter
Right
Sweep Mode=Auto
Wet / Dry
Frequency
Frequency
LFO Phase
Wah
Bottom=75
Wah
Higher
Higher
Top=75
Wah
Woo
Woo
Bottom=25
LFO: Step-Tri/Random
Envelope
Top=25
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Woo
Envelope
Time
Envelope
Time
b: Sweep Mode
This parameter changes the wah control mode. Setting
Sweep Mode to Auto will select an auto-wah that sweeps
according to envelope changes in the input signal level. Autowah is frequently used for funk guitar parts and clav sounds.
When Sweep Mode is set to D-mod, you can control the filter directly via the modulation source in the same way as a
wah pedal.
When Sweep Mode is set to LFO, the effect uses LFO to
sweep in cycle.
c: Envelope Sens (Envelope Sensitivity)
This parameter sets the sensitivity of auto-wah. Increase the
value if the input signal is too low to sweep. Reduce the value
if the input signal is so high that the filter is stopped temporarily.
c: Envelope Shape
This parameter determines the sweep curve for auto-wah.
20.00...+20.00Hz
0.05...50.00Hz
,
50.00...+50.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009,
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
x1...x16
Fx:009
value = 0...+100
g
Time
0.02...20.00Hz
,
Envelope Shape
value = 0...100
180...+180
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source used for both LFO speed and step speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Level
Envelope
Step-Tri, Random
x1...x32
Manual
Sets the filter center frequency
0...100
Depth
Sets the modulation depth of filter center frequency
0...100
Src
Selects the modulation source of filter modulation
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of filter modulation
100...+100
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
0...100
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
,
j
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
182
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
011: Excit/Enhan
(Stereo Exciter/Enhancer)
ThiseffectisacombinationoftheExciter,whichaddsa
punch to the sound and the Enhancer, which adds
spreadandpresence.
LFO Frequency
Random
Left
Wet / Dry
LEQ
HEQ
Exciter
EQ Trim
Delay
EQ Trim
Delay
Depth
Exciter
Enhancer
LFO Phase
0
Right
Wet / Dry
D-mod
180
90
0 [degree]
Exciter Blend
Sets the intensity (depth) of the Exciter effect
100...+100
,
Src
Selects the modulation source of the Exciter intensity
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the Exciter intensity
100...+100
Emphatic Point
Sets the frequency to be emphasized
b
0...70
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the frequency to be emphasized
Amt
70...+70
Sets the amount of modulation of the frequency to be emphasized
0.0...50.0msec
0.0...50.0msec
Enhancer Depth
0...100
Sets the determines to what degree the Enhancer effect is applied
e
Src
Selects the modulation source of the Enhancer width
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the Enhancer width
100...+100
EQ Trim
Sets the 2-band EQ input level
0...100
15.0...+15.0dB
15.0...+15.0dB
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
a: Exciter Blend
This parameter sets the depth (intensity) of the Exciter effect.
Positive values give a frequency pattern (to be emphasized)
different from negative values.
b: Emphatic Point
This parameter sets the frequency to be emphasized. Higher
values will emphasize lower frequencies.
c: Enhancer Dly L [msec], d: Enhancer Dly R [msec]
These parameters set the delay time for the Enhancer left
and right channel. Specifying a slightly different delay time for
the left and right channel will add a stereo image, depth, and
width to the sound.
Effects
183
Filter/Dynamic
(Talking Modulator)
Thiseffectaddsverylowfrequenciestotheinputsig
nal. It is very useful when simulating a roaring drum
soundoremphasizingpowerfullowrange.Thiseffect
isdifferentfromtheequalizerinthatyoucanaddvery
lowrangeharmonics.Youcanalsoadjusttheoscillator
frequencytomatchaparticularnotenumber,foruseas
anoctaver.
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Talking Modulator
A-I-U-E-O
Envelope Shape
Envelope Sens Pre LPF
D-mod
Note No.
Fixed Frequency
Note Interval, Fine
Fixed
Sine Oscillator
Right
D-mod
LFO
Envelope Shape
Right
OSC Mode
Note (Key Follow), Fixed
Determines whether the oscillator frequency follows the note number or
whether it is fixed
Note Fine
Fine adjustment of the oscillator frequency
100...+100
Off...Tempo
Voice Top
Selects a vowel sound at the top end of control
A, I, U, E, O
10.0...80.0Hz
Voice Center
Selects a vowel sound in the center of control
A, I, U, E, O
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the oscillator frequency when OSC
Mode=Fixed
Voice Bottom
Selects a vowel sound at the bottom end of control
A, I, U, E, O
Envelope Shape
Sets the oscillators volume envelope curve
0...100
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
100...+100
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Src
Selects the modulation source that controls the voice pattern
Amt
80...+80Hz
Sets the oscillator frequency modulation amount when OSC Mode=Fixed
d
Sweep Mode
D-mod, LFO
Switches between modulation source control and LFO control
Manual Voice Control
Voice pattern control
Note Interval
48...0
Sets the pitch difference from the note number when OSC Mode=Note (Key
Follow)
D-mod
LFO
Wet / Dry
a
a
Wet / Dry
Voice Top: A
Voice Center: I
Voice Bottom: U
Sweep Mode
x1...x16
Fx:009
Formant Shift
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
100...+100
Resonance
Sets the Level of resonance of the voice pattern
0...100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
184
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
014: Decimator
(Stereo Decimator)
Voice Center
Voice Top
A
I
U
E
Thiseffectcreatesaroughsoundlikeacheapsampler
by lowering the sampling frequency and data bit
length.Youcanalsosimulatenoiseuniquetoasampler
(aliasing).
D-mod
JS X
Ribbon
JS +Y
JS Y
etc
Max
Zero
+ Max
Wet / Dry
High Damp Output Level
Decimator
+ Max
Zero
h: Formant Shift
This parameter adjusts the frequency level to which the effect
is applied. If you wish to apply the effect to a higher-range
sound, set this parameter to a higher value; to apply the effect
to a lower-range sound, set this to a lower value.
h: Resonance
This parameter sets the intensity of resonance for the voice
pattern. A larger value will add more character to the sound.
D-mod
Sampling Frequency
LFO
Decimator
Pre LPF
Resolution
Right
Wet / Dry
Pre LPF
Off, On
Selects whether the harmonic noise caused by a decrease in sampling frequency is generated or not
0...100%
1.00k...48.00kHz
Src
Selects the modulation source of the sampling frequency
Off...Tempo
Amt
48.00k...+48.00kHz
Sets the modulation amount of the sampling frequency
LFO Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO speed
c
0.02...20.00Hz
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
Depth
Sets the depth of the sampling frequency LFO modulation
d
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the LFO modulation source of the sampling frequency
Amt
Sets the LFO modulation amount of the sampling frequency
100...+100
Resolution
Sets the data bit length
Output Level
Sets the output level
0...100
4...24
0...100
Src
Selects the modulation source for the output level
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the output level
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
a: Pre LPF
If a sampler with a very low sampling frequency receives very
high-pitched sound that could not be heard during playback, it
could generate pitch noise that is unrelated to the original
sound. Set Pre LPF to ON to prevent this noise from being
generated.
If you set the Sampling Freq to about 3kHz and set Pre
LPF to OFF, you can create a sound like a ring modulator.
e: Resolution, f: Output Level
If you set a smaller value for the Resolution parameter, the
sound may be distorted. The volume level may also be
changed. Use Output Level to adjust the level.
Effects
185
Pitch/Phase Mod.
PITCH/PHASE MOD.
016: Chorus
(Stereo Chorus)
Pre EQ
EQ Trim
Pre EQ
Analog Record
Simulation
Thiseffectaddsthicknessandwarmthtothesoundby
modulatingthedelaytimeoftheinputsignal.Youcan
addspreadtothesoundbyoffsettingthephaseofthe
leftandrightLFOsfromeachother.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Right
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
LEQ
HEQ
Chorus
Speed [RPM]
Sets the r.p.m. of a record
33 1/3, 45, 78
Flutter
Sets the modulation depth
0...100
Noise Density
Sets the noise density
0...100
Noise Tone
Sets the noise tone
0...100
Noise Level
Sets the noise level
0...100
EQ Trim
LEQ
Chorus
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
Src
Selects the modulation source for the noise level
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the noise level
100...+100
Click Level
Sets the click noise level
e
0...100
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
180...+180
Fx:010
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the click noise level
100...+100
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
Q
Sets the EQ band width
Gain [dB]
Sets the EQ gain
0...100
300...10.00kHz
100...+100
b: Flutter
This parameter enables you to set the depth of the modulation caused by a warped turntable.
e: Click Level
This parameter enables you to set the level of the click noise
that occurs once every rotation of the turntable. This simulation reproduces record noise, and the noise generated after
the music on a vinyl record finishes.
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
18.0...+18.0dB
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
x1...x16
Fx:009
0.0...50.0msec
0.0...50.0msec
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
20.00...+20.00Hz
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
0.5...10.0
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Selects the modulation source for the click noise level
HEQ
EQ Trim
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
g
0...100
Src
Selects the modulation source of the LFO modulation depth
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth
100...+100
EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0...100
15.0...+15.0dB
15.0...+15.0dB
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Fx:010,
j
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
186
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
017: Harm.Chorus
(Stereo Harmonic Chorus)
This effect applies chorus only to higher frequencies.
This can be used to apply a chorus effect to a bass
soundwithoutmakingthesoundthinner.Youcanalso
usethischorusblockwithfeedbackasaflanger.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Low Level
Chorus/Flanger
High Damp
Feedback
High Damp
Wet / Dry
High Level
High Level
Chorus/Flanger
h: Feedback
Sets the feedback amount of the chorus block. Increasing the
feedback will allow you to use the effect as a flanger.
Low Level
Right
Left
Tap1 Delay
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sine
Tap2 Delay
Wet / Dry
Feedback
Wet / Dry
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Tap3 Delay
Tap4 Delay
Triangle, Sine
Right
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
0...30
L6...L1, C, R1...R6
0...570msec
Depth
Sets the Tap2 chorus depth
0...30
Level
Sets the Tap2 output level
0...30
Pan
Sets the Tap2 stereo image
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth
100...+100
Tap3(090) [msec]
Sets the Tap3 (LFO phase=90 degrees) delay time
L6...L1, C, R1...R6
0...570msec
Depth
Sets the Tap3 chorus depth
0...30
Level
Sets the Tap3 output level
0...30
100...+100
Pan
Sets the Tap3 stereo image
h
High Damp [%]
Sets the high range damping amount of the chorus block
0...570msec
0...100
1...100
0.02...13.00Hz
0...30
Off...Tempo
Wet / Dry
Depth
Sets the Tap1 chorus depth
Src
Selects the modulation source of the LFO modulation depth
Feedback
Sets the feed back amount of the chorus block
0...100%
L6...L1, C, R1...R6
Low Level
Sets the low range output level
0...100
Tap4(270) [msec]
Sets the Tap4 (LFO phase=270 degrees) delay time
0...100
Depth
Sets the Tap4 chorus depth
0...30
High Level
Sets the high range (chorus) output level
Level
Sets the Tap4 output level
0...30
Pan
Sets the Tap4 stereo image
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
0...570msec
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Tap2(180) [msec]
Sets the Tap2 (LFO phase=180 degrees) delay time
x1...x16
Fx:009
0.0...50.0msec
Pan
Pan
Sets the Tap1 stereo image
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Level
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Pan
Pan
Tap1(000) [msec]
Sets the Tap1 (LFO phase=0 degrees) delay time
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
Level
Level
LFO: Triangle
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Pan
0 [degree]
180 [degree]
90 [degree]
270 [degree]
180...+180
Fx:010
Level
Tap1 Feedback
Sets the Tap1 feedback amount
100...+100
f
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of Tap1 feedback amount and effect balance
Amt
Sets the Tap1 feedback amount and modulation amount
L6...L1, C, R1...R6
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
g
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Effects
187
Pitch/Phase Mod.
019: Ensemble
020: Flanger
(Stereo Flanger)
Wet / Dry
Left
Ensemble
Wet / Dry
Flanger
Feedback
Right
Wet / Dry
High Damp
Shimmer
Flanger
LFO
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
Speed
Sets the LFO speed
a
1...100
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
100...+100
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
b
0...100
Src
Selects the modulation source of the LFO modulation depth
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth
100...+100
Shimmer
Sets the amount of shimmering of the LFO waveform
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
100...+100
180...+180
Fx:010
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
100...+100
c: Shimmer
This parameter sets the amount of shimmering of the LFO
waveform. Increasing this value adds more shimmering, making the chorus effect more complex and richer.
Triangle, Sine
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
0.0...50.0msec
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
0...100
LFO Shape
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
f
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
x1...x16
Fx:009
0...100
Ensemble LFO
Level
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
Shimmer
100...+100
g
High Damp [%]
Sets the feedback damping amount in the high range
0...100%
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Fx:010,
Time
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
b: LFO Shape
Changing the LFO waveform shape controls the peak sweep
of flanging effects.
LFO Shape
LFO Waveform=Sine
g: Feedback, h: Wet/Dry
The peak shape of the positive and negative Feedback
value is different. The harmonics will be emphasized when
the effect sound is mixed with the dry sound if you set a posi-
188
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
tive value for both Feedback and Wet/Dry, and if you set a
negative value for both Feedback and Wet/Dry.
g: High Damp [%]
This parameter sets the amount of damping of the feedback
in the high range. Increasing the value will cut high-range harmonics.
022: Envel.Flang
(Stereo Envelope Flanger)
This Flanger uses an envelope generator for modula
tion.Youwillobtainthesamepatternofflangingeach
timeyouplay.YoucanalsocontroltheFlangerdirectly
usingthemodulationsource.
021: RandomFlang
Wet / Dry
Flanger
Thestereoeffectusesastepshapewaveformandran
dom LFO for modulation, creating a unique flanging
effect.
Feedback
High Damp
Flanger
Right
D-mod
Wet / Dry
D-mod
EG Attack/Decay
Flanger
Feedback
High Damp
Flanger
Right
LFO Phase
EG
Wet / Dry
Sweep Mode
0.0...50.0msec
Fx:009
0.0...50.0msec
Fx:009
0.0...50.0msec
Fx:009
0.0...50.0msec
Fx:009
a
Wet / Dry
LFO: Step-Tri/Random
b
a
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
0.0...50.0msec
180...+180
Fx:010
0.05...50.00Hz
Fx:010,
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
x1...x16
Fx:009
x1...x32
Fx:010
0...100
100...+100
Fx:020
i
High Damp [%]
Sets the feedback damping amount in the high range
0...100%
Fx:020
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Fx:010, 020,
j
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
EG Attack
Sets the EG attack speed
1...100
EG Decay
Sets the EG decay speed
1...100
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
Fx:020
50.00...+50.00Hz
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009, 010
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that triggers the EG (when EG is selected for
Sweep Mode), or modulation source that causes the flanger to sweep (when
D-mod is selected for Sweep Mode)
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:010,
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source used for both LFO speed and step speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Sweep Mode
EG, D-mod
Determines whether the flanger is controlled by the envelope generator or by
the modulation source
,
Step-Tri, Random
Fx:010
0...100%
Fx:020
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Fx:010, 020,
g
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
d: EG Attack, d: EG Decay
Attack and Decay speed are the only adjustable parameters
on this EG.
Effects
189
Pitch/Phase Mod.
023: Phaser
024: RandomPhser
(Stereo Phaser)
Wet / Dry
Phaser
Wet / Dry
Phaser
Resonance
High Damp
Resonance
Phaser
High Damp
Phaser
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
Right
LFO: Step-Tri/Random
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sine
LFO Shape
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
a
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
100...+100
Fx:020
180...+180
Fx:010
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
20.00...+20.00Hz
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO step speed
0.05...50.00Hz
Fx:010,
50.00...+50.00Hz
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009, 010
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
x1...x16
Fx:009
Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
0...100
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
Step Base Note
Selects the type of notes to specify the LFO step speed
Fx:010,
Src
Selects the modulation source for the LFO modulation depth
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth
100...+100
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
100...+100
Times
Sets the number of notes to specify the LFO step speed
0...100
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
High Damp [%]
Sets the resonance damping amount in the high range
0...100%
Fx:023
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Fx:010, 023,
100...+100
g: Resonance, h: Wet/Dry
The peak shape of the positive and negative Feedback value
is different. The harmonics will be emphasized when the
effect sound is mixed with the dry sound, if you set a positive
value for both Resonance and Wet/Dry, and if you set a
negative value for both Resonance and Wet/Dry.
g: High Damp [%]
This parameter sets the amount of damping of the resonance
in the high range. Increasing the value will cut high-range harmonics.
100...+100
Fx:023
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
x1...x32
Fx:010
Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
0...100%
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Fx:010,
x1...x16
Fx:009
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:010,
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
180...+180
Fx:010
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source commonly used for LFO speed and step
speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
190
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
025: Envel.Phser
026: BiphaseMod.
Thisstereophaserusesanenvelopegeneratorformod
ulation. You will obtain the same pattern of phasing
each time you play. You can also control the Phaser
directlyusingthemodulationsource.
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Phaser
Chorus/Flanger
Resonance
High Damp
Feedback
High Damp
Phaser
High Damp
Chorus/Flanger
Right
D-mod
D-mod
EG Attack/Decay
Wet / Dry
Right
Wet / Dry
Sweep Mode
180 [degree]
EG
LFO1: Tri / Sine
LFO2: Tri / Sine
Sweep Mode
EG, D-mod
Determines whether the flanger is controlled by the envelope generator or by
the modulation source
Fx:022,
c
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that triggers the EG (when EG is selected for
Sweep Mode), or modulation source that causes the flanger to sweep (when
D-mod is selected for Sweep Mode)
EG Attack
Sets the EG attack speed
1...100
Fx:022
EG Decay
Sets the EG decay speed
1...100
Fx:022
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
LFO Phase Sw
0 degree, 180 degree
Switches the LFO phase difference between left and right
0.02...30.00Hz
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO1&2 speed
Off...Tempo
30.00...+30.00
0.02...30.00Hz
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO2 speed
Depth1
Sets the depth of LFO1 modulation
e
0...100%
Fx:023
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Triangle, Sine
100...+100
Fx:023
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Fx:010, 023,
LFO2 Waveform
Selects LFO2 waveform
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO1 speed
Triangle, Sine
b
R Manu Top (R Manual Top)
0...100
Sets the upper limit of the frequency range for the effect on the right channel
Fx:009
LFO1 Waveform
Selects LFO1 waveform
30.00...+30.00
0...100
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO1&2 modulation depth
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO1 modulation depth
100...+100
Depth2
Sets the depth of LFO2 modulation
0...100
f
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO2 modulation depth
100...+100
0.0...50.0msec
Fx:016
0.0...50.0msec
Fx:016
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
Fx:017
i
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
0...100%
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Fx:010,
j
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
Bi-Phase Modulation LFO
LFO1
Depth1
LFO2
Depth2
100...+100
Effects
191
Pitch/Phase Mod.
027: Vibrato
(Stereo Vibrato)
Thiseffectcausesthepitchoftheinputsignaltoshim
mer. Using the AutoFade allows you to increase or
decreasetheshimmeringspeed.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Vibrato
Vibrato
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine
AutoFade
LFO Shape
Fade-In Delay
LFO Frequency
AUTOFADE Src
Selects the modulation source that starts AutoFade
Off...Tempo
,
a
Fade-In Rate
Sets the rate of fade-in
1...100
The effect is off when a value for the dynamic modulation source
specified for the AUTOFADE Src parameter is smaller than 64,
and the effect is on when the value is 64 or higher. The AutoFade
function is triggered when the value changes from 63 or smaller to
64 or higher.
AUTOFADE
00...2000msec
Gate1 Signal
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
Note On
c
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
d
100...+100
Fx:020
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
g
x1...x16
Fx:009
0...100
Src
Selects the modulation source of the LFO modulation depth
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
AUTOFADE
AutoFade
AUTOFADE Src=Gate1
LFO Frequency[Hz]=1.0
LFO Freq. Mod=AUTOFADE
Amt=+3.0
Fade-In Rate
Fade-In Dealy
192
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
028: AutoFadeMod.
Thisstereochorus/flangereffectenablesyoutocontrol
theLFOspeedandeffectbalanceusingautofade,and
youcanspreadthesoundbyoffsettingthephaseofthe
leftandrightLFOsfromeachother.
Wet / Dry
High Damp
Left
Wet / Dry
Resonator
Trim
Delay
Feedback
Resonator
Trim
High Damp
High Damp
Delay
Level
Pan
Level
Pan
Resonance
Right
Wet / Dry
Right
D-mod
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sine
Invert: On/Off
Pitch, Fine [cent]
LFO
Control Mode
LFO Shape
Manual
AutoFade
LFO Frequency
Wet / Dry
AUTOFADE Src
Selects the modulation source that starts AutoFade
a
Rate
Sets the rate of fade-in
Fade-In Dly (Fade-In Delay) [msec]
Sets the fade-in delay time
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Off...Tempo
Control Mode
Switches the controls of resonance intensity
a
Fx:027,
1...100
Fx:027
00...2000msec
Fx:027
180...+180
Fx:010
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Mod. Depth
100...+100
Sets the amount of resonance intensity control via LFO/D-mod
c
0.0...500.0msec
100...+100
0...100%
Voice1: Level
Sets the Voice1 output level
0...100
Pan
Sets the Voice1 stereo image
L6...R6
Voice2: Pitch
Sets the Voice2 Pitch for resonance
C0...B8
g
Fine [cent]
Fine-adjusts the voice 2 pitch for resonance
0...200
100...+100
Fx:020
Voice2: Resonance
Sets the intensity of resonance when Control Mode = Manual
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount of resonant sound in the high range
100...+100
0...100%
Voice2: Level
Sets the Voice2 output level
0...100
Pan
Sets the Voice2 stereo image
L6...R6
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
50...+50
0...100%
Fx:020
Wet/Dry Mod
D-mod, AUTOFADE
Switches between D-mod and AUTOFADE for the effect balance modulation
Fx:027
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
50...+50
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Fx:010, 020,
j
C0...B8
Voice1: Resonance
Sets the intensity of resonance when Control Mode = Manual
20.00...+20.00Hz
Voice1: Pitch
Sets the voice1 Pitch for resonance
Fine [cent]
Fine-adjusts the voice 1 pitch for resonance
Off...Tempo
0...100
0.0...500.0msec
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
Trim
Sets the input level at the resonator
0.02...20.00Hz
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0.02...20.00Hz
D-mod Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that controls resonance intensity
Off, On
b
100...+100
Fx:020
LFO/D-mod Invert
Reverses the Voice 1 and 2 control when LFO/D-mod is selected
LFO Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO speed
Triangle, Sine
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Effects
193
Pitch/Phase Mod.
ThiseffectsimulatestheDopplereffectofamoving
soundwithachangingpitch,similartothesirenofan
passing ambulance. Mixing the effect sound with the
drysoundwillcreateauniquechoruseffect.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Doppler
Wet / Dry
Pan Depth
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO
-mod
Trigger
LFO Mode
Switches LFO operation mode
a
Src
Off...Tempo
When LFO Mode is set to 1-Shot, this modulation source triggers the LFO
LFO Sync
Off, On
Switches between LFO reset on and off when LFO Mode is set to Loop
LFO Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO speed
Loop, 1-Shot
,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Off...Tempo
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
x1...x16
Fx:009
0...100
Src
Selects the modulation source of pitch variation
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of pitch variation
100...+100
Pan Depth
Sets the panning of the moving sound
100...+100
,
Src
Selects the modulation source of panning
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of panning
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
e: Pitch Depth
With the Doppler effect, the pitch is raised when the sound
approaches, and the pitch is lowered when the sound goes
away. This parameter sets this pitch variation.
f: Pan Depth
This parameter sets the width of the stereo image of the effect
sound. With larger values, the sound seems to come and go
from much further away. With positive values, the sound
moves from left to right; with negative values, the sound
moves from right to left.
Doppler - Pitch / Pan Depth
Pitch
Pan Depth
= (+) value
Pan Depth
= () value
Pitch Depth
Original Pitch
Center
Left
Right
Pan Depth
<
<
<
Louder
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
Higher
030: Doppler
Pitch Depth
Sets the pitch variation of the moving sound
Lower
When Control Mode = LFO, the intensity of resonance varies according to the LFO. The LFO sways between positive
and negative values, causing resonance to occur between
specified pitches an octave apart in turn.
When Control Mode = D-mod, the resonance is controlled
by the dynamic modulation source. If JS X or Ribbon is
assigned as the modulation source, the pitch an octave
higher and lower can be controlled, similar to when LFO is
selected for Control Mode.
a: LFO/D-mod Invert
When Control Mode = LFO or D-mod, the controlled phase
of either Voice 1 or 2 will be reversed. When the resonance
pitch is set for Voice 1 (Resonance has a positive value),
Voice 2 will resonate at a pitch an octave below (Resonance
has a negative value).
d: Voice1: Pitch, d: Fine [cent], g: Voice2: Pitch, g: Fine
[cent]
The Pitch parameter specifies the pitch of resonance by note
name. The Fine parameter allows for fine adjustment in
steps of cents.
e: High Damp [%], h: High Damp [%]
This parameter sets the damping amount of resonant sound
in the high range. Lower values will make a metallic sound
with a higher range of harmonics.
Volume
>
>
Louder
>
194
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
031: Scratch
Thiseffectisappliedbyrecordingtheinputsignaland
movingthemodulationsource.Itsimulatesthesound
ofscratchesyoucanmakeusingaturntable.
Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Start
Direct
Mix
Scratch
Rec Control
Scratch
Scratch Source
Wet / Dry
D-mod
D-mod
Envelope Control
Input
Envelope Select
Scratch Source
Selects the modulation source for simulation control
Response
Sets the speed of the response to the Scratch Source
Off...Tempo
,
0...100
Envelope Select
D-mod, Input
Selects whether the start and end of recording is controlled via the modulation source or the input signal level
,
c
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that controls recording when Envelope Select
is set to D-mod
Threshold
Sets the recording start level when Envelope Select is set to Input
0...100
Response
Sets the speed of the response to the end of recording
0...100
Direct Mix
Selects how a dry sound is mixed
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
JS X
Ribbon
JS+Y
JSY
etc
-mod
End
Recorded Sound
Right
D-mod
Playback Position
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Scratch!
Max
Zero
Zero
+ Max
+ Max
Effects
195
Mod./P.Shift
MOD./P.SHIFT
Other modulation and pitch shift effects
032: Tremolo
(Stereo Tremolo)
033: EnvelTremol
Thiseffectmodulatesthevolumeleveloftheinputsig
nal. The effect is stereo, and offsetting the LFO of the
leftandrightphasesfromeachotherproducesatrem
oloeffectbetweenleftandright.
Thiseffectusestheinputsignalleveltomodulateaste
reo tremolo. You can simulate a tremolo effect that
becomes deeper as it fades out while the level gets
lower.
Wet / Dry
Tremolo
Wet / Dry
Tremolo
Tremolo
Tremolo
Right
Wet / Dry
Right
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri/Sin/Vintage/Up/Down
LFO Phase
LFO Shape
LFO: Tri/Sin/Vintage
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Envelope
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
100...+100
Fx:020
180...+180
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
100...+100
Fx:020
180...+180
Fx:032
0.02...20.00Hz
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
x1...x16
Fx:009
0...100
0...100
Envelope Amount
100...+100
Sets the changes of the modulation depth according to the input signal level
Src
Selects the modulation source of the depth of modulation
Off...Tempo
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the depth of modulation
100...+100
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
a:LFO Waveform
This parameter selects the LFO waveform. Vintage wave
simulates the characteristics of the tremolo created on a guitar amplifier. Combining this effect with the Amp Simulation
will make a realistic, vintage tremolo amplifier sound.
Tremolo - LFO Waveform
Triangle
Sine
Vintage
Up
Down
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
100...+100
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
0...100
Envelope Shape
Sets the envelope curve shape of the input signal
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Envelope Shape
Envelope Sens
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Wet / Dry
LFO Shape
100...+100
ThefollowingexampleindicatesthattheDepth
is0withanLFOFrequencyof1.0Hzandthemaxi
muminput,andthattheDepthis100withaFre
quencyof8.0Hzwithzeroinput.
196
Effects
Mod./P.Shift
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
Shimmer
Level
Louder
Dry Envelope
LFO Frequency[Hz]=8.0
Envelope Amount[Hz]= 7.0Hz
Depth=100
Envelope Amount= 100
0...100
Src
Selects the modulation source of the depth of modulation
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the depth of modulation
100...+100
Time
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
034: Auto-Pan
f
Wet / Dry
Pan
Depth
Pan
Right
Wet / Dry
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
a: LFO Shape
You can change the panning curve by modifying the LFO
waveform.
b: LFO Phase
This parameter determines the difference in the left and right
LFO phases. When you change the value gradually from 0,
the sound from the left and right channels will chase each
other around. If you set the parameter to +180 or 180, the
sound from each channel will cross over each other.
You need to input different sounds to each channel in order
for this parameter to be effective.
LFO Phase
LFO Shape
L-In
L-In
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
100...+100
180...+180
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
x1...x16
Fx:009
R-In
L-In
L-In
Left
L-In
L-In
R-In
R-In
R-In
R-In
L-In
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
L-In
L-In
R-In
R-In
R-In
R-In
R-In
L-In
L-In
L-In
L-In
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
R-In
R-In
R-In
Right
Center
Output Stereo Image
R-In
L-In
R-In
Effects
197
Mod./P.Shift
035: Phaser/Trem
(Stereo Phaser + Tremolo)
ThiseffecthasastereophaserandtremoloLFOslinked
together. Swelling phaser modulation and tremolo
effectssynchronizewitheachother,creatingasoothing
modulation effect.Itis suitableforelectric piano type
sounds.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Phaser
Tremolo
Phaser Wet / Dry
Resonance
Phaser Wet / Dry
Tremolo
Phaser
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Type
LFO
LFO Shape
LFO Phase
036: RingModulat
(Stereo Ring Modulator)
This effect creates a metallic sound by applying the
oscillatorstotheinputsignal.UsetheLFOorDynamic
Modulationtomodulatetheoscillatortocreatearadi
calmodulation.Matchingtheoscillatorfrequencywith
anotenumberwillproducearingmodulationeffectin
specifickeyranges.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Type:
Phs - Trml...Phs LR - Trml LR
Selects the type of the tremolo and phaser LFOs
Ring Modulator
Pre LPF
Ring Modulator
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Right
Off...Tempo
Note No.
Sine Oscillator
OSC Mode Pitch
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
Pre LPF
0...100
Sets the damping amount of the high range input to the ring modulator
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
OSC Mode
Fixed, Note (Key Follow)
Switching between specifying the oscillator frequency and using a note
number
Phaser Manual
Sets the phaser frequency range
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
x1...x16
Fx:009
0...100
d
Resonance
Sets the phaser resonance amount
Phaser Depth
Sets the phaser modulation depth
0...100
Phaser Wet/Dry
Wet...2:99, Dry, 2:99...Wet
Sets the balance between the phaser effect and dry sounds
Tremolo Shape
Sets the degree of the tremolo LFO shaping
Tremolo Depth
Sets the tremolo modulation depth
100...+100
Fx:020
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
0...100
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
,
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
LFO Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation for the oscillator frequency
100...+100
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the tremolo modulation depth
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the tremolo modulation depth
Note Offset
48...+48
Sets the pitch difference from the original note when OSC Mode is set to
Note (Key Follow)
Note Fine
Fine-adjusts the oscillator frequency
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the oscillator frequency when OSC Mode
is set to Fixed
Amt
12.00...+12.00kHz
Sets the modulation amount of the oscillator frequency when OSC Mode is
set to Fixed
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the phaser modulation depth
Amt
Sets the modulation amount for the phaser modulation depth
Fixed
20.00...+20.00Hz
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Wet / Dry
Fixed Frequency
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Wet / Dry
Pre LPF
x1...x16
Fx:009
0...100
Src
Selects the modulation source of the depth of modulation
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the depth of modulation
100...+100
198
Effects
Mod./P.Shift
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
037: Detune
Using this effect, you can obtain a detune effect that
offsets the pitch of the effect sound slightly from the
pitch of the input signal. Compared to the chorus
effect,amorenaturalsoundthicknesswillbecreated.
Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Input Level
High Damp
Detune
Delay
Feedback
Input Level
Right
Wet / Dry
100...+100cent
Src
Selects the modulation source of the pitch shift
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the pitch shift
b
100...+100cent
0...1000msec
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
c
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
0...100%
100...+100
,
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
Off...Tempo
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
Input Level
x1.0
x1.0
Amt= +50
Amt= 50
Amt= 100
Louder
Amt= +100
Louder
a: Pre LPF
This parameter enables you to set the damping amount of the
high range sound input to the ring modulator. If the input
sound contains lots of harmonics, the effect may sound dirty.
In this case, cut a certain amount of high range.
b: OSC Mode
This parameter determines whether or not the oscillator frequency follows the note number.
c: Fixed Frequency [Hz]
This parameter sets the oscillator frequency when OSC
Mode is set to Fixed.
d: Note Offset, d: Note Fine
These parameters for the oscillator are used when OSC
Mode is set to Note (Key Follow). The Note Offset sets the
pitch difference from the original note in semitone steps. The
Note Fine parameter fine-adjusts the pitch in cent steps.
Matching the oscillator frequency with the note number produces a ring modulation effect in the correct key.
x0.5
D-mod
Higher
Zero
x0.5
Max
D-mod
Higher
Zero
Max
Effects
199
Mod./P.Shift
038: PitchShift
(Pitch Shifter)
This effect changes the pitch of the input signal. You
can select from three types: Fast (quick response),
Medium, and Slow (preserves tonal quality). You can
also create an effect in which the pitch is gradually
raised(ordropped)usingthedelaywithfeedback.
Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Input Level
High Damp
Pitch Shifter
Delay
Pre
Input Level
Post
Feedback Position
Feedback
Right
Mode
Switches Pitch Shifter mode
Pitch Shift [1/2tone]
Sets the pitch shift amount by steps of a semitone
Src
Selects the modulation source of pitch shift amount
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of pitch shift amount
Wet / Dry
24...+24
,
Off...Tempo
24...+24
Fine [cent]
Sets the pitch shift amount by steps of a cent
100...+100cent
,
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of pitch shift amount
100...+100cent
Feedback Position
Switches the feedback connection.
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
0...1000msec
Pre, Post
100...+100
f
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
Input Level Dmod [%]
Sets the modulation amount of the input level
0...100%
100...+100
Fx:037,
g
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
a: Mode
This parameter switches the pitch shifter operating mode.
With Slow, tonal quality will not be changed too much. With
Fast, the effect becomes a Pitch Shifter that has a quick
response, but may change the tone. Medium is in between
these two. If you do not need to set too much pitch shift
amount, set this parameter to Slow. If you wish to change the
pitch significantly, use Fast.
b: Pitch Shift [1/2tone], b: Src, b: Amt, c: Fine [cent], c:
Amt
The amount of pitch shift will use the value of the Pitch Shift
plus the Fine value. The amount of modulation will use the
c: Amt value plus d: Amt.
Modulation Source is used both for Pitch Shift and Fine.
e: Feedback Position, f: Feedback
When Feedback Position is set to Pre, the pitch shifter output is again input to the pitch shifter. Therefore, if you specify
a higher value for the Feedback parameter, the pitch will be
raised (or lowered) more and more each time feedback is
repeated.
If Feedback Position is set to Post, the feedback signal will
not pass through the pitch shifter again. Even if you specify a
higher value for the Feedback parameter, the pitch-shifted
sound will be repeated at the same pitch.
200
Effects
Mod./P.Shift
039: PitShiftMod.
040: RotarySpeak
(Rotary Speaker)
Wet / Dry
Horn
Wet / Dry
Rotary Speaker
Horn/Rotor
Balance
Mic Distance
Mic Spread
Rotor
Pitch Shifter
Speaker Simulation
Right
Wet / Dry
D
D-mod
D-mod
-mod
Pan
Right
Wet / Dry
100...+100cent
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Square
Mode Switch
Switches between speaker rotation and stop
a
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Speed Switch
Switches the speaker rotation speed between slow and fast
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
b
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
x1...x16
Fx:009
Depth
Sets the LFO modulation depth for pitch shift amount
100...+100
,
Src
Selects the modulation source of the depth of modulation
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the depth of modulation
100...+100
Pan
Sets the panning effect sound and dry sound separately
L, 1:99...99:1, R
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
Horn Ratio
Stop, 0.50...2.00
Adjusts the (high-range side) horn rotation speed. Standard value is 1.00.
Selecting Stop will stop the rotation
Rotor Acceleration
0...100
Determines how quickly the rotor rotation speed in the low range is switched
e
Rotor Ratio
Stop, 0.50...2.00
Adjusts the (low-range side) rotor rotation speed. Standard value is 1.00.
Selecting Stop will stop the rotation
f
Horn/Rotor Balance
Rotor, 1...99, Horn
Sets the level balance between the high-range horn and low-range rotor
Mic Distance
Sets the distance between the microphone and rotary speaker
0...100
Mic Spread
Sets the angle of left and right microphones
0...100
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that toggles between slow and fast
Horn Acceleration
How quickly the horn rotation speed in the high range is switched
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
,
g
Slow, Fast
Sw
Toggle, Moment
Selects switching mode of the modulation source that toggles between slow
and fast
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that toggles between rotation and stop
Sw
Toggle, Moment
Selects switching mode of the modulation source that toggles between rotation and stop
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Rotate, Stop
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Higher
Pitch
Lower
Original Pitch
LFO Waveform=Triangle
Depth (+value)
Pitch Shift (+ value)
LFO Waveform=Square
Depth (value)
f: Pan, g: Wet/Dry
The Pan parameter pans the effect sound and dry sound to
the left and right. With L, the effect sound is panned left, and
the dry sound is panned right. With a Wet/Dry = Wet setting,
the effect and dry sound will be output in a proportion of 1:1.
a: Sw
This parameter sets how the modulation source switches
between rotation and stop.
When Sw = Toggle, the speaker rotates or stops alternately
each time you press the pedal or operate the joystick.
Each time the value for the modulation source exceeds 64, the
speaker rotates or stops alternately.
Effects
201
Mod./P.Shift
Rotation will occur when the value of the modulation source is less
than 64, and will stop when the value is 64 or greater.
b: Sw
This parameter sets how the rotation speed (slow and fast) is
switched via the modulation source.
When Sw = Toggle, the speed is switched between slow
and fast each time you press the pedal or operate the joystick.
Slow/fast will alternate each time the value of the modulation source
exceeds 64.
Microphone
Mic Distance
Microphone
Mic Distance
When a value for the modulation source is less than 64, slow
speed is selected, and when the value is 64 or higher, fast is
selected.
202
Effects
ER/Delay
042: AutoReverse
ER/DELAY
(Auto Reverse)
This effect records the input signal and automatically
playsitinreverse(theeffectissimilartoatapereverse
sound).
Thiseffectisonlytheearlyreflectionpartofareverber
ationsound,andaddspresencetothesound.Youcan
selectoneofthefourdecaycurves.
Wet / Dry
Direct
Mix
Auto Reverse
Rec/Reverse Play
Control
Right
Left
Wet / Dry
D-mod
EQ Trim
Wet / Dry
D-mod
Envelope Control
Input
Envelope Select
LEQ
HEQ
Pre Delay
Early Reflections
Rec Mode
Sets the recording mode
EQ Trim
Right
Wet / Dry
Single, Multi
20...1320msec
Envelope Select
D-mod, Input
Selects whether the start and end of recording is controlled via the modulation source or the input signal level
,
Type
Sharp, Loose, Modulated, Reverse
Selects the decay curve for the early reflection
ER Time [msec]
Sets the time length of early reflection
Threshold
Sets the recording start level when Envelope Select is set to Input
EQ Trim
Sets the input level of EQ applied to the effect sound
Response
Sets the speed of the response to the end of recording
Direct Mix
Selects how a dry sound is mixed
c
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that controls recording when Envelope Select
is set to D-mod
10...800msec
0...100
15.0...+15.0dB
15.0...+15.0dB
g
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
a: Type
This parameter selects the decay curve for the early reflection.
Early Reflections - Type
Sharp
Loose
Modulated
0...100
Fx:031
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Reverse
Rec Mode/Reverse Time
Rec
Dry
Pre Delay
0...100
Reverse Rec
ER Time
Input
Time
Reverse Time
Reverse Time
Effects
203
ER/Delay
(Stereo/Cross Delay)
Thisisastereodelay,andcanbyusedasacrossfeed
backdelayeffectinwhichthedelaysoundscrossover
between the left and right by changing the feedback
routing.
Wet / Dry
Input Level D-mod
L Delay
Left
Level
Wet / Dry
High Damp Low Damp
C Delay
Spread
Level
Level
Feedback
Input Level D-mod
Delay
Stereo/Cross
Feedback
Spread
R Delay
High Damp Low Damp
Delay
Right
Wet / Dry
Stereo/Cross
Right
Wet / Dry
0...1360msec
a
Level
Sets the output level of TapL
C Delay Time [msec]
Sets the delay time of TapC
0...50
Stereo/Cross
Switches between stereo delay and cross-feedback delay
0.0...680.0msec
0...1360msec
0.0...680.0msec
0...50
b
Level
Sets the output level of TapC
R Delay Time [msec]
Sets the delay time of TapR
c
Level
Sets the output level of TapR
L Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the left channel
0...1360msec
0...50
Feedback (C Delay)
Sets the feedback amountof TapC
100...+100
Src
Selects the modulation source of the TapC feedback amount
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the TapC feedback amount
100...+100
Src
Selects the modulation source of feedback amount
Off...Tempo
Amt L
Sets the modulation amount of the left channel feedback
100...+100
R Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the right channel
100...+100
Amt R
Sets the modulation amount of the right channel feedback
100...+100
0...100%
0...100%
Fx:043
0...100%
0...100%
Fx:043
100...+100
Fx:037,
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
0...50
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
50...+50
Fx:043
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Fx:037,
100...+100
Stereo, Cross
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
204
Effects
ER/Delay
046: Modul.Delay
ThisstereodelayusesanLFOtosweepthedelaytime.
The pitch also varies. You will obtain a delay sound
with swell and shimmering. You can also control the
delaytimeusingamodulationsource.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Left
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Feedback
Delay
Input Level D-mod
Input Level D-mod
Delay
(2)
Mode
(1)
Delay
Tap1=(1)
Tap2=(2)
Spread
Feedback
(2)
Delay
Feedback
Right
Right
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
-mod
Mode: Normal
LFO Sync
Response
LFO: Tri / Sine
D-mod
L/R: +/+ +/
LFO Shape
LFO
LFO Phase Modulation Mode
Mode
Normal, Cross Feedback, Cross Pan1, Cross Pan2
Switches the left and right delay routing
0.0...680.0msec
0.0...680.0msec
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
D-mod Modulation
Reversed L/R control by modulation source
b
100...+100
Src
Selects the modulation source of the Tap2 feedback amount
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
Src
Selects the modulation source that controls delay time
Response
Sets the rate of response to the modulation source
0...100
Feedback (Tap2)
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
Modulation Mode
LFO, D-mod
Switches between LFO modulation control and modulation source control
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
L/R:+/+, L/R:+/
,
Off...Tempo
0...30
Triangle, Sine
c
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
d
100...+100
Fx:020
0.02...20.00Hz
Off, On
,
0...100%
Fx:043
0...100%
Fx:043
Src
Selects the modulation source that resets the LFO
Off...Tempo
100...+100
Fx:037,
180...+180
180...+180
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound
100...+100
L Depth
Sets the depth of the left LFO modulation
0...200
R Depth
Sets the depth of the right LFO modulation
0...200
Fx:043,
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the effect sounds stereo image width
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the effect sounds stereo image width
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
0.0...500.0
L Feedback
Sets the feedback amount of left delay
100...+100
R Feedback
Sets the feedback amount of right delay
100...+100
100...+100
a: Mode
You can change how the left and right delay signals are
panned by modifying the routing of the left and right delay as
shown in the figure above. You need to input different sounds
to each channel in order for this parameter to be effective.
d: Tap1 Level
This parameter sets the output level of Tap1. Setting a different level from Tap2 will add a unique touch to a monotonous
delay and feedback.
0.0...500.0
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Fx:010,
j
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
b: D-mod Modulation
When the modulation source is used for control, this parameter reverses the left and right modulation direction.
e: LFO Sync, e: Src,
f: L LFO Phase [degree], f: R LFO Phase [degree]
The LFO can be reset via a modulation source.
The Src parameter sets the modulation source that resets
the LFO. For example, you can assign Gate as a modulation
Effects
205
ER/Delay
047: Dynam.Delay
(Stereo Dynamic Delay)
Thisstereodelaycontrolsthelevelofdelayaccording
totheinputsignallevel.Youcanusethisasaducking
delay that applies delay to the sound only when you
playkeysatahighvelocityoronlywhenthevolume
levelislow.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
High Damp Low Damp
Delay
Feedback
Spread
Delay
Right
FB
Out
Attack, Release
Envelope
Wet / Dry
Control Target
Threshold
Control Target
Selects from no control, output, and feedback
None, Out, FB
0...100%
Fx:043
0...100%
Fx:043
Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
+,
Threshold
Sets the level to which the effect is applied
0...100
Offset
Sets the offset of level control
0...100
Attack
Sets the attack time of level control
1...100
Release
Sets the release time of level control
1...100
0.0...680.0msec
0.0...680.0msec
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
a: Control Target
This parameter selects no level control, delay output control
(effect balance), or feedback amount control.
a: Polarity, b: Threshold, b: Offset, c: Attack, d: Release
The Offset parameter specifies the value for the Control
Target parameter (that is set to None), expressed as the ratio
relative to the parameter value (the Wet/Dry value with
Control Target=Out, or the Feedback value with Control
Target=FB).
When Polarity is positive, the Control Target value is
obtained by multiplying the parameter value by the Offset
value (if the input level is below the threshold), or equals the
parameter value if the input level exceeds the threshold.
When Polarity is negative, Control Target value equals the
parameter value if the input level is below the threshold, or is
obtained by multiplying the parameter value by the Offset
value if the level exceeds the threshold.
The Attack and Release parameters specify attack time
and release time of delay level control.
a
Polarity
Reverses level control
100...+100
Fx:043
Dynamic Delay
Level
Dry
Threshold
Envelope
Wet
Release
Attack
(Ducking Delay)
Control Target=Out
Polarity= ()
Delay Time
Wet
Control Target=Out
Polarity= (+)
Time
100...+100
206
Effects
ER/Delay
Wet / Dry
High Damp Low Damp
Pan
Delay
Depth
Feedback
Pan
Delay
Left
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
L Delay
Level
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sin
LFO Shape
C Delay
Spread
Level
Feedback
Input Level D-mod
R Delay
Level
0.0...680.0msec
Right
Wet / Dry
Tempo
L Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the left channel
R Delay Time [msec]
Sets the delay time for the right channel
100...+100
BPM
BPM
0.0...680.0msec
b
R Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the right channel
100...+100
0...100%
Fx:043
0...100%
Fx:043
Triangle, Sine
100...+100
Fx:020
180...+180
Fx:034
0.02...20.00Hz
Off...Tempo
Amt
Set the modulation amount of the panning width
100...+100
100...+100
Times
Sets the number of notes to specify the delay time for TapC
x1...x16
0...50
Selects the type of notes to specify the delay time for TapR
,
d
Times
Sets the number of notes to specify the delay time for TapR
Level
Sets the output level of TapR
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
0...50
Level
Sets the output level of TapC
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
x1...x16
Selects the type of notes to specify the delay time for TapC
,
0...100
Src
Selects the modulation source for the panning width
Times
Sets the number of notes to specify the delay time for TapL
Level
Sets the output level of TapL
d
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
MIDI, 40...240
,
Selects the type of notes to specify the delay time for TapL
,
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
x1...x16
0...50
Feedback (C Delay)
Sets the feedback amount of TapC
100...+100
Src
Selects the modulation source for the TapC feedback
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the TapC feedback
100...+100
0...100%
Fx:043
0...100%
Fx:043
100...+100
Fx:037,
g
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
h
Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
0...50
Fx:043
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Effects
207
ER/Delay
Wet / Dry
Delay
High Damp Low Damp
Feedback
Input Level D-mod
Right
Wet / Dry
Tempo
BPM
Stereo In - Stereo Out
BPM
Left
Wet / Dry
Rythm Pattern
Delay
Input Level D-mod
Feedback
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Rhythm Pattern
Selects a rhythm pattern
... 3
Tap1 Pan
Sets the panning of Tap1
L, 1...99, R
Tap2 Pan
Sets the panning of Tap2
L, 1...99, R
Tap3 Pan
Sets the panning of Tap3
L, 1...99, R
R>
----, OVER!!
Display the error message if the right channel delay time exceeds the upper
limit
Tap4 Pan
Sets the panning of Tap4
L, 1...99, R
Selects the type of notes to specify the left channel delay time
Fx:049,
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
Src
Selects the modulation source of feedback amount
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the feedback
100...+100
Delay
Right
Wet / Dry
Tempo
BPM
BPM
Adjust [%]
Adjust [%]
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
a
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:049,
Times
Sets the number of notes to specify the left channel delay time
Adjust [%]
Fine-adjust the left channel delay time
Adjust [%]
Fine-adjust the right channel delay time
2.50...+2.50%
x1...x16
Src
Selects the modulation source of feedback amount
Off...Tempo
Amt L
Sets the modulation amount of the left channel feedback
100...+100
100...+100
e
Amt R
Sets the modulation amount of the right channel feedback
100...+100
0...100%
Fx:043
0...100%
Fx:043
100...+100
Fx:037,
h
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
0...100%
Fx:043
0...100%
Fx:043
100...+100
Fx:037,
f
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
2.50...+2.50%
100...+100
Fx:049
L Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the left channel
R Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the right channel
Fx:049
Times
Sets the number of notes to specify the right channel delay time
x1...x16
Selects the type of notes to specify the right channel delay time
Fx:049,
MIDI, 44...240
,
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
208
Effects
Reverb
REVERB
Reverb effects
Theseeffectssimulatetheambienceofreverberationin
concerthalls.
Thisroomtypereverbemphasizestheearlyreflections
that make the sound tighter. Changing the balance
betweentheearlyreflectionsandreverbsoundallows
youtosimulatenuances,suchasthetypeofwallsofa
room.
057: R.BriteRoom
Thisroomtypereverbemphasizestheearlyreflections
thatmakethesoundbrighter.See056:ReverbRoom.
053: RevSmthHall
(Smooth Hall)
Wet / Dry
ER Level
ERs
EQ Trim
LEQ
HEQ
Reverb
Pre Delay
Reverb Level
ERs
EQ Trim
054: RevWetPlate
ER Level
Right
Wet / Dry
0.1...3.0sec
055: RevDryPlate
Thisplatereverbsimulatesdry(light)reverberation.
0...100%
0...200msec
Fx:052
b
Pre Delay Thru [%]
Sets the mix ratio of non-delay sound
EQ Trim
LEQ
ER Level
Sets the level of early reflections
0...100
Reverb Level
Sets the reverberation level
0...100
EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0...100
Reverb
Pre Delay
EQ Trim
Right
Wet / Dry
0.1...10.0sec
0...100%
0...100%
EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Louder
Level
Dry
Reverb
Pre Delay Thru
Time
Pre Delay
Reverb Time
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
0...200msec
a
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
0...100%
Fx:052
HEQ
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Dry
ER
(Early Reflections)
Louder
Left
Reverb
Time
Reverb Time
Effects
209
059: Par4Eq-Wah
058: Par4Eq-Exc
Thiseffect combinesamonotypefourbandparamet
ric equalizer and a wah. You can change the order of
theconnection.
Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Routing
Parametric 4Band EQ
Thiseffect combinesamonotypefourbandparamet
ricequalizerandanexciter.
Wah/Auto Wah
Wah
Trim
Wet / Dry
Parametric 4Band EQ
Right
Sweep Mode
Exciter
Envelope
D-mod
+
Exciter
Wet / Dry
Auto
D-mod
LFO
LFO
Trim
Right
Wet / Dry
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
50...5.00kHz
20...1.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
0...100
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
d
300...10.00kHz
e
500...20.00kHz
100...+100
Fx:011
0...70
Fx:011
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
300...10.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
500...20.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
0...100
Fx:009
Frequency Top
Sets the upper limit of the wah center frequency
0...100
Fx:009
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
50...5.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
20...1.00kHz
18...+18dB
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
0...100
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
18...+18dB
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
100...+100
0.02...20.00Hz
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
0...100
LPF
Switches the wah low pass filter on and off
Off, On
Routing
PEQ WAH, WAH PEQ
Changes the order of the parametric equalizer and wah connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
210
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
060: 4EqPhsrChFl
(Parametric 4-Band EQ Chorus/Flanger)
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypefourbandparamet
ricequalizerandachorus/flanger.
Left
Wet / Dry
Chorus/Flanger
061: Par4Eq-Phsr
(Parametric 4-Band EQ Phaser)
Parametric 4Band EQ
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypefourbandparamet
ricequalizerandaphaser.
Chorus/Flanger
Trim
Feedback
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry
Left
Wet / Dry
Parametric 4Band EQ
Right
Phaser
Wet / Dry
Phaser
Trim
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
18...+18dB
50...5.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
18...+18dB
50...5.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
300...10.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
18...+18dB
18...+18dB
500...20.00kHz
0.0...50.0msec
0.02...20.00Hz
Triangle, Sine
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
18...+18dB
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
0.02...20.00Hz
0...100
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
[F] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
[F] Cho/Flng Wet/Dry
Sets the effect balance of the chorus/flanger
100...+100
Fx:020
Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Fx:010, 020
i
Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/flanger
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
0...100
[P] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
[P] Phaser Wet/Dry
Sets the phaser effect balance
100...+100
Fx:023
Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Fx:010, 023
i
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode
100...+100
i: Output Mode
When Wet Invert is selected, the right channel phase of the
chorus/flanger effect sound is inverted. This creates pseudostereo effects and adds spread.
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
20...1.00kHz
500...20.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
0...100
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
18...+18dB
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1
300...10.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
Wet / Dry
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Right
20...1.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
Resonance
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
0...100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Effects
211
062: P4Eq-TapDly
063: Cmp-AutoWah
Thiseffect combinesamonotypefourbandparamet
ricequalizerandamultitapdelay.
Left
Left
Wet / Dry
Parametric 4Band EQ
Compressor
Delay
Trim
Wah/Auto Wah
Feedback
Wet / Dry
Routing
Multitap Delay
(2)
Comp
Wah
Output Level
Right
Right
Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control
Sweep Mode
Envelope
Auto
D-mod
-mod
D
a
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
18...+18dB
50...5.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
[E] Band3 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency for Band 3
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
[E] Band4 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency for Band 4
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
18...+18dB
0...680msec
0...100
Fx:045
0...680msec
Feedback
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
h
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
0...100%
Fx:043
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the
effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
0...100
Fx:002
[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
0...100
Fx:009
Frequency Top
Sets the upper limit of the wah center frequency
0...100
Fx:009
0.02...20.00Hz
[W] Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
0...100
Off, On
Routing
CMP WAH, WAH CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and wah connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
1...100
Fx:002
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the wah when Sweep Mode=D-mod
f
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 176
18...+18dB
500...20.00kHz
1...100
Fx:002
300...10.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
LFO
LFO
0...100
20...1.00kHz
Wet / Dry
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
212
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
064: Cmp-AmpSim
065: Cmp-OD/HiG
(Compressor Overdrive/Hi.Gain)
Compressor
EQ Trim LEQ
Left
Wet / Dry
Compressor
Overdrive / Hi-Gain
HEQ
Wet / Dry
Routing
Amp Simulation
3 Band PEQ
Comp
Comp
Output Level
Driver
Output Level
Output Level
Wet / Dry
1...100
Fx:002
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 176
1...100
Fx:002
[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
Right
0...100
Fx:002
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
Routing
CMP AMP, AMP CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and amp simulation connection
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 176
1...100
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
0...100
Fx:002
Overdrive, Hi-Gain
c
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion
1...100
Fx:002
0...100
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
Fx:006,
Src
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
1...100
Fx:006
0...50
Off...Tempo
50...+50
20...1.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 176
18...+18dB
e
g
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
f
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Routing
CMP OD, OD CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and overdrive connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Effects
213
066: Cmp-Par.4Eq
067: Cmp-ChorFlg
(Compressor Chorus/Flanger)
Compressor
Left
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Routing
Compressor
Parametric 4Band EQ
Chorus/Flanger
Comp
Output Level
Comp
Trim
Chorus/Flanger
+
Output Level
Feedback
Right
Right
Envelope - Control
Wet / Dry
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
1...100
Fx:002
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 176
1...100
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
0...100
Fx:002
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
50...5.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
[E] Band4 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency for Band 4
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 176
1...100
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
0...100
Fx:002
[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
0.0...50.0msec
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
[F] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
18...+18dB
0...100
g
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
300...10.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
500...20.00kHz
100...+100
Fx:020
Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Fx:010, 020
h
Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/flanger
18...+18dB
Routing
CMP FLNG, FLNG CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and chorus/flanger connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
j
Routing
CMP PEQ, PEQ CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and parametric EQ connection
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
1...100
Fx:002
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
20...1.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
0...100
Envelope - Control
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
214
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
068: Cmp-Phaser
069: Cmp-MTapDly
(Compressor Phaser)
Left
Compressor
EQ Trim LEQ
Envelope - Control
Phaser
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Resonance
Phaser Wet / Dry
1...100
Fx:002
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 176
1...100
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
0...100
Fx:002
[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0...100
Right
15...+15dB
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
[P] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 176
1...100
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
0...100
Fx:002
[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
0...680msec
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
0...100
Fx:045
0...680msec
Feedback
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
g
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
1...100
Fx:002
0...100
0...100
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
0.02...20.00Hz
Wet / Dry
15...+15dB
100...+100
Fx:023
Routing
CMPDLY, DLYCMP
Switches the order of the compressor and multitap delay connection
h
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode
Routing
CMPPHS, PHSCMP
Switches the order of the compressor and phaser connection
Fx:067
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
(2)
Mt.Dly Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control
Delay
Wet / Dry
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
Feedback
Comp
Right
Multitap Delay
Comp
Output Level
Wet / Dry
Routing
Compressor
Phaser
HEQ
Left
Wet / Dry
Routing
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
0...100%
Fx:043
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Effects
215
070: Lim-Par.4Eq
071: Lim-ChorFlg
(Limiter Chorus/Flanger)
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypelimiterandachorus/
flanger.Youcanchangetheorderoftheeffectconnec
tion.
Limiter
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Routing
Parametric 4Band EQ
Chorus/Flanger
Limiter
Limiter
Chorus/Flanger
Limiter
Trim
Gain Adjust
Gain Adjust
Right
Envelope - Control
[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied
40...0dB
Fx:003
[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
1...100
Fx:003
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
300...10.00kHz
500...20.00kHz
[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
1...100
Fx:003
Release
Sets the release time
1...100
Fx:003
Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
0.0...50.0msec
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
f
100...+100
Fx:020
[F] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
h
Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/flanger
i
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Routing
LMTFLNG, FLNGLMT
Switches the order of the limiter and chorus/flanger connection
Fx:067
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
18...+18dB
j
Routing
LMTPEQ, PEQLMT
Switches the order of the limiter and parametric EQ connection
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
40...0dB
Fx:003
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied
18...+18dB
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
50...5.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
20...1.00kHz
Wet / Dry
0...100
Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003
18...+18dB
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
1...100
Fx:003
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
Envelope - Control
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
Release
Sets the release time
Right
Wet / Dry
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry
Feedback
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
216
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
072: Lim-Phaser
073: Lim-MTapDly
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypelimiterandaphaser.
Youcanchangetheorderoftheeffectconnection.
Wet / Dry
Routing
Limiter
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypelimiterandamulti
tap delay. You can change the order of the effect con
nection.
Phaser
Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Resonance
Feedback
Limiter
Delay
Wet / Dry
Multitap Delay
Limiter
Normal
+
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Gain Adjust
Envelope - Control
Wet / Dry
Routing
Phaser
Limiter
(2)
Mt.Dly Wet / Dry
Right
[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
Envelope - Control
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
Wet / Dry
a
Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied
40...0dB
Fx:003
[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
1...100
Fx:003
Release
Sets the release time
1...100
Fx:003
[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied
Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
0...100
[P] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
f
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
[P] Phaser Wet/Dry
Sets the phaser effect balance
100...+100
Fx:023
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode
h
Routing
LMTPHS, PHSLMT
Switches the order of the limiter and phaser connection
Fx:067
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
1...100
Fx:003
Release
Sets the release time
1...100
Fx:003
Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003
0...680msec
0...100
Fx:045
0...680msec
Feedback (Tap2)
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
f
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
g
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
40...0dB
Fx:003
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
0...100%
Fx:043
Routing
LMTDLY, DLYLMT
Switches the order of the limiter and multitap delay connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Effects
217
074: Exc-Compr
(Exciter Compressor)
075: Exc-Limiter
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypeexciterandalimiter.
Youcanchangetheorderoftheeffectconnection.
(Exciter Limiter)
Limiter
Wet / Dry
Routing
Compressor
Exciter
Wet / Dry
Routing
Exciter
Left
Limiter
Exciter
Gain Adjust
Comp
Exciter
Output Level
Right
Envelope - Control
Right
Envelope - Control
[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
100...+100
Fx:011
0...70
Fx:011
[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
1...100
Fx:002
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 176
1...100
Fx:002
f
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
g
0...100
Fx:002
100...+100
Fx:011
0...70
Fx:011
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
40...0dB
Fx:003
[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
1...100
Fx:003
Release
Sets the release time
1...100
Fx:003
Routing
XCTCMP, CMPXCT
Switches the order of the exciter and compressor connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Routin
XCTLMT, LMTXCT
Switches the order of the exciter and limiter connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003
100...+100
j
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
218
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
076: Exc-ChorFlg
077: Exc-Phaser
(Exciter Chorus/Flanger)
(Exciter Phaser)
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypelimiterandachorus/
flanger.
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypelimiterandaphaser.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Exciter
Left
Wet / Dry
Chorus/Flanger
Exciter
EQ Trim LEQ
HEQ
+
EQ Trim LEQ
Chorus/Flanger
Exciter
Feedback
Normal
Output Mode
[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine
100...+100
Fx:011
0...70
Fx:011
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0.0...50.0msec
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
[F] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
100...+100
15...+15dB
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
0...100
[P] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
100...+100
Fx:023
Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Fx:010, 023
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
15...+15dB
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
h
Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/flanger
0...100
100...+100
Fx:020
Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Fx:010, 020
0...70
Fx:011
g
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
Fx:011
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Wet / Dry
Resonance
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry
Right
Phaser
Exciter
HEQ
Phaser
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Effects
219
078: Exc-MTapDly
079: OD/HG-Amp S
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypeexciterandamulti
tapdelay.
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypeoverdrive/highgain
distortionandanampsimulation.Youcanchangethe
orderoftheeffectconnection.
Wet / Dry
Multitap Delay
Exciter
Left
Wet / Dry
Routing
EQ Trim LEQ HEQ
Overdrive / Hi-Gain
Feedback
Delay
Exciter
(2)
Amp Simulation
3 Band PEQ
Driver
Output Level
Mode: Overdrive / Hi-Gain
Drive
Right
Wet / Dry
Right
Wet / Dry
[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
100...+100
Fx:011
0...70
Fx:011
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
0...680msec
0...100
Fx:045
Fx:006,
0...50
Off...Tempo
50...+50
20...1.00kHz
18...+18dB
0...680msec
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 176
Feedback (Tap2)
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
0...100%
Fx:043
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
1...100
Fx:006
Src
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level
e
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
Overdrive, Hi-Gain
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
100...+100
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Routing
ODAMP, AMPOD
Switches the order of the overdrive and amp simulation connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
220
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
080: OD/HG-ChoFl
081: OD/HG-Phser
(Overdrive/Hi.Gain Chorus/Flanger)
(Overdrive/Hi.Gain Phaser)
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypeoverdrive/highgain
distortion and a chorus/flanger. You can change the
orderoftheeffectconnection.
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypeoverdrive/highgain
distortion and a phaser. You can change the order of
theeffectconnection.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Overdrive / Hi-Gain
Left
Wet / Dry
Routing
Overdrive / Hi-Gain
Driver
Chorus/Flanger
Output Level
Mode: Overdrive / Hi-Gain
Drive
Normal
Output Mode
Feedback
Phaser
Driver
Output Level
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Fx:006,
Src
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level
Off...Tempo
20...1.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 176
18...+18dB
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
0.0...50.0msec
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
18...+18dB
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/flanger
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
100...+100
Fx:023
Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Fx:010, 023
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode
i
Routing
OD PHS, PHS OD
Switches the order of the overdrive and phaser connection
Fx:067
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
0...100
Routing
OD FLNG, FLNG OD
Switches the order of the overdrive and chorus/flanger connection
Fx:067
[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
100...+100
Fx:020
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 176
20...1.00kHz
18...+18dB
50...+50
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
Off...Tempo
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2
Src
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level
0...50
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1
Fx:006,
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level
50...+50
1...100
Fx:006
0...50
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1
Overdrive, Hi-Gain
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion
1...100
Fx:006
Wet / Dry
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion
Overdrive, Hi-Gain
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Resonance
Right
Phaser
3 Band PEQ
3 Band PEQ
Wet / Dry
Routing
Chorus/Flanger
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Effects
221
082: OD/HG-MTDly
083: Wah-AmpSim
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypeoverdrive/highgain
distortionandamultitapdelay.
Wet / Dry
Multitap Delay
Overdrive / Hi-Gain
Left
Wet / Dry
Routing
3 Band PEQ
Delay
Driver
Output Level
Wah/Auto Wah
Feedback
High Damp (1)
Amp Simulation
(2)
Wah
Wet / Dry
Right
Overdrive, Hi-Gain
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion
Fx:006,
Src
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level
0...50
50...+50
b
20...1.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 176
18...+18dB
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2
18...+18dB
0...680msec
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
0...100
Fx:045
0...680msec
Feedback
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
h
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
0...100%
Fx:043
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
0...100
Fx:009
0.02...20.00Hz
[W] Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
0...100
Off, On
Routing
WAH AMP, AMP WAH
Switches the order of the wah and amp simulation connection
Frequency Top
Sets the upper limit of the wah center frequency
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
0...100
Fx:009
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the wah when Sweep Mode=D-mod
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Off...Tempo
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1
LFO
1...100
Fx:006
Wet / Dry
LFO
Sweep Mode
Envelope
Auto
-mod D-mod
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
222
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
084: Decim-Amp S
0...100
Fx:014
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
1...100
Fx:002
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 176
1...100
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
0...100
Fx:002
Off, On
Fx:014
0...100%
Routing
DECICMP, CMPDECI
Switches the order of the decimator and compressor connection
1.00k...48.00kHz
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
a
High Damp [%]
Sets the ratio of high-range damping
[D] Sampling Freq [Hz] (Sampling Frequency)
Sets the sampling frequency
b
Resolution
Sets the data bit length
4...24
Fx:014
0...100
Fx:014
Routing
DECIAMP, AMPDECI
Switches the order of the wah and amp simulation connection
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
086: AmpS-Tremol
(Amp Simulation Tremolo)
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypeampsimulationand
atremolo.
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
Wet / Dry
Amp Simulation
Tremolo
Tremolo
085: Decim-Cmp
(Decimator Compressor)
Right
Wet / Dry
Routing
Compressor
Decimator
High Damp
Output Level
Right
100...+100
Fx:020
[T] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0.02...20.00Hz
0...100
Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Off, On
Fx:014
0...100%
1.00k...48.00kHz
b
Resolution
Sets the data bit length
b
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
Comp
Decimator
Pre LPF
Output Level
Resolution
LFO Shape
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri/Sin/Vintage/Up/Down
4...24
Fx:014
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Effects
223
087: Ch/Fl-MTDly
088: Phser-ChoFl
(Phaser Chorus/Flanger)
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypechorus/flangeranda
multitapdelay.
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypephaserandachorus/
flanger.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Multitap Delay
Chorus/Flanger
Phaser
Chorus/Flanger
Feedback
Chorus/Flanger
EQ LEQ HEQ
Trim
Delay (2)
(1)
Cho/Flng
Wet / Dry High Damp
Resonance
Feedback
Right
Chorus/Flanger
EQ LEQ HEQ
Trim
Phaser
Feedback
Wet / Dry
0.0...50.0msec
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng
Wet / Dry
Right
Wet / Dry
Phaser
Mt.Dly
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
a
[F] LFO Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO speed
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
[F] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
0...100
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
c
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
d
[F] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0...100
15...+15dB
100...+100
Fx:023
Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Fx:010, 023
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
e
Pre HEQ Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of High EQ, on page 176
f
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
100...+100
Fx:020
15...+15dB
0...680msec
0.0...50.0msec
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
g
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
0...100
Fx:045
0...680msec
Feedback (Tap2)
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
100...+100
Fx:020
[F] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0...100
h
[F] Pre LEQ Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 176
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
g
[D] Mt.Delay Wet/Dry
Sets the multitap delay effect balance
i
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
0...100%
Fx:043
h
Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/flanger
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
224
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
089: Rev-Gate
(Reverb Gate)
Thiseffectcombinesamonotypereverbandagate.
Threshold
Sets the gate threshold level
Wet / Dry
Reverb
EQ Trim
Pre Delay
Reverb
Gate
LEQ HEQ
Wet / Dry
Input Reverb Mix
Input
Envelope - Control
Gate+Dmpr
D-mod Envelope Select
Gate
0.1...10.0sec
a
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
b
c
[R] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 176
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
Fx:005
[G] Attack
Sets the attack time
1...100
Fx:005
Release
Sets the release time
1...100
Fx:005
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 175
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 175
100...+100
0...100%
+,
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 175
j
[R] Reverb Time [sec]
Sets the reverberation time
[G] Polarity
Switches between non-invert and invert of the gate on/off state
0...100
Reverb
Balance
Right
f
Src
Off...Gate2+Dmpr
Selects the modulation source that controls the gate when Envelope Select
is set to D-mod
Assignable parameters
225
Function
Meaning
Style Change
Single Touch
Style Up
Style Down
Function
Meaning
Perform. Up
Off
No function assigned
Perform. Down
Start/stop
Program Up
Play/Stop Seq1
Program Down
STS Up
Synchro
STS Down
Tap tempo/Rst
STS1
Tempo lock
STS2
Intro 1
STS3
Ending 1
STS4
Intro 2
Punch In/Out
Ending 2
FX CC12 Sw.
Fill 1
FX CC13 Sw.
Fill 2
Standard FX controllers
Same functions of the control panel buttons
with the same name
Fx A mute
C.In / Break
Fx B mute
Variation 1
Fx C mute
Variation 2
Fx D mute
Variation 3
All Fx mute
Variation 4
Drum mute
Variation up
Perc mute
Variation down
Bass mute
Fade in/out
Acc1 mute
Memory
Acc2 mute
Bass inversion
Acc3 mute
Manual Bass
Acc4 mute
Upper 1 Mute
Acc5 mute
Upper 2 Mute
Upper 3 Mute
Ens. on/off
Ensemble on/off
Lower Mute
Quarter tone
Chord Latch
Song Drum&Bass
Chord Latch+Damper
226
Assignable parameters
List of functions assignable to the Pedal or Assignable Slider
Meaning
Master volume
Master Volume
Accomp.Volume
Accopaniment Volume
Kb Expression
Keyboard Expression
Function
Meaning
Joystick +X
Joystick right
Joystick -X
Joystick left
Joystick +Y
Joystick forward
Joystick -Y
Joystick backward
FX CC12 Ctl
Standard FX controllers
FX CC13 Ctl
SOUND NAME
SOUND NAME
SOUND NAME
ChinaGong
36
DistSlid2
71
Darbuka1
106
HeartBeat
Crash 1
37
Sticks
72
Darbuka2
107
Footstep1
Crash 2
38
Cowbell
73
Darbuka3
108
Footstep2
88 Crash
39
Agogo 1
74
Darbuka4
109
Stadium
Ride 1
40
Agogo 2
75
Darbuka5
110
DoorCreak
Ride 2
41
Whistle 1
76
Darbuka6
111
DoorSlam
China
42
Whistle 2
77
Darbuka7
112
CarEngine
Ride Bell
43
Sh. Guiro
78
Darbuka8
113
Car Stop
Splash
44
LongGuiro
79
DoufRimAk
114
Car Pass
10
RevCymbal
45
Cuica 1
80
Tef 1
115
Car Crash
11
DragonGng
46
Cuica 2
81
Tef 2
116
Crickets
12
OrchCymb1
47
Triangle1
82
Tef 3
117
Train
13
OrchCymb2
48
Triangle2
83
Tef 4
118
Helicopt
14
OrcSdRoll
49
88Cowbell
84
Tef 5
119
Gun Shot
15
OrchSnare
50
TimbLow
85
Tef 6
120
MachinGun
16
Timpani 1
51
TimbHi
86
Rik 1
121
Laser Gun
17
Timpani 2
52
TimbRim1
87
Rik 2
122
Explosion
18
Timpani 3
53
TimbRim2
88
Rik 3
123
Dog
19
Timpani 4
54
CongaLow
89
RekDomAk
124
H. Gallop
20
Orch. Hit
55
CongaHi
90
OpenBells
125
Birds 1
21
BrassFall
56
CongaSlap
91
Sagat 1
126
Birds 2
22
Ch. Bell
57
CongaMute
92
Sagat 2
127
Thunder
23
JingleBel
58
Tamb.Acc1
93
Davul
128
Sea Shore
24
WindChim1
59
Tamb.Acc2
94
Ramazan 1
129
River
25
WindChim2
60
Tamb.Push
95
Ramazan 2
130
Bubble
26
WindChim3
61
TambOpen
96
Ramazan 3
131
Cat
27
VibraSlap
62
Castanet1
97
Kup 1
132
Lion
28
RainStick
63
Castanet2
98
Kup 2
133
PhoneRing
29
Scratch 1
64
Aah !
99
Kup 3
134
Applause
30
Scratch 2
65
Uuh !
100
Kup 4
135
Wind
31
Scratch 3
66
Yeah ! 1
101
Baya 1
136
Starship
32
Scratch 4
67
Yeah ! 2
102
Baya 2
137
Jetplane
33
Scratch 5
68
Hit It !
103
Laughing
138
Siren
34
Scratch 6
69
Hollo 1
104
Scream
139
Cosmic
35
DistSlid1
70
Hollo 2
105
Punch
Assignable parameters
227
Meaning
StyleUp
StylDown
PerfUp
PerfDown
ProgUp
ProgDown
PunchI/O
FxA Mute
FxB Mute
FxC Mute
FxD Mute
Fx Mute
Upp1Mute
Upp2Mute
Upp3Mute
Low Mute
DrumMute
PercMute
BassMute
Acc1Mute
Acc2Mute
Acc3Mute
Acc4Mute
Acc5Mute
Acc Mute
Mel.Mute
Drum&Bas
QuarterT
Fx CC12
Standard FX controllers
Fx CC13
SCALES
The following is a list of scales (or tunings) you can
select in Style Play (Scale on page44) and Global
(Scaleonpage125)modes.
Equal
Equaltuning,thestandardscaleformod
ernWesternmusic.Itismadeof12identi
calsemitones.
PureMajor Major chords in the selected key are per
fectlytuned.
PureMinor Minorchordsintheselectedkeyareper
fectedtuned.
Arabic
Anarabicscale,usingquartersoftone.Set
theKeyparameterasfollow:
CfortherastC/bayatiDscale
DfortherastD/bayatiEscale
FfortherastF/bayatiGscale
GfortherastG/bayatiAscale
A#fortherastBb/bayatiCscale
PythagoreanPythagorean scale, based on the music
theories of the great Greek philosopher
and matematician. It is most suitable for
melodies.
Werckmeister
LateBaroque/ClassicAgescale.Verysuit
ableforXVIIICenturymusic.
Kirnberger Harpsichord scale, very common during
theXVIIICentury.
Slendro
Scale of the Indonesian Gamelan. The
octaveisdividedin5notes(C,D,F,G,A).
The remaining notes are tuned as in the
Equaltuning.
Pelog
Scale of the Indonesian Gamelan. The
octave is divided in 7 notes (all white
keys,whenKeyis=C).Theblackkeysare
tunedasintheEqualtuning.
Stretch
Simulates the stretched tuning of an
acousticpiano. Basically an equal tuning,
the lowest notes are slightly lower, while
the highest notes are slightly higher than
thestandard.
User
User scale, i.e. scale programmed by the
user for the Style Play, Backing Sequence
andSongPlaymodes.Theuserscalecan
be saved to a Performance, Style Perfor
mance, STS or Song. You cant select a
UserscaleinGlobalmode.
MIDI Controllers
228
CC#
CC Name
microARRANGER Function
72
Release
Release time
73
Attack
Attack time
CC Name
microARRANGER Function
74
F.CutOff
Bank Select
Program selection
75
Decay T.
Decay time
Mod1 (Y+)
Joystick forward
76
Lfo1 Sp.
Vibrato speed
Mod2 (Y-)
Joystick backward
77
Lfo1 Dpt
Vibrato depth
Lfo1 Dly
Undef. ctl
78
Foot ctl
79
FilterEg
Port.time
80
Gen.pc.5
Data ent.
81
Gen.pc.6
Volume
82
Gen.pc.7
Balance
83
Gen.pc.8
Undef. ctl
84
Port.ctl
10
Pan Pot
Track volume
Track panning
Undef. ctl
91
Fx A/C
11
Expression
12
Fx Ctl 1
92
Fx 2 ctl
13
Fx Ctl 2
93
Fx B/D
Undef. ctl
94
Fx 4 ctl
16
Gen.pc.1
95
Fx 5 ctl
17
Gen.pc.2
96
Data Inc
18
Slider
97
Data Dec
19
Gen.pc.4
98
NRPN Lsb
Undef. ctl
99
NRPN Msb
100
RPN Lsb
101
RPN Msb
1415
2031
Expression
8590
Control Change #3263 are the LSB (Least Significant Bytet) of Control
Change #031, i.e. the MSB (Most Significant Byte), and are changed
according to their MSB counterparts.
64
Damper
65
Portamento
66
Sostenuto
67
Soft pedal
68
Legato
69
Hold 2
70
Sustin level
71
F.Res.Hp
Damper pedal
Sostenuto pedal
Soft pedal
Filter resonance
102119
Undefined ctl
120
AllSOff
121
Res Ctl
122
LocalCt
123
NoteOff
124
OmniOff
125
Omni On
126
Mono On
127
Poly On
MIDI Controllers
229
KORG microARRANGER
OS Version 1.0 - Aug. 10, 2011
Transmitted
Recognized
Default
116
116
Changed
116
116
Remarks
Memorized
Basic Channel
Default
Mode
Note
Number:
Messages
Altered
****************
0127
0127
True Voice
****************
0127
Note On
Note Off
Poly (Key)
*A
Mono (Channel)
*A
9n, V=1127
9n, V=1127
Velocity
V=64
Aftertouch
O
0, 32
*A
1, 2
Modulations
*A
64
Damper
*A
*A
38
*A
7, 11
Volume, Expression
*A
10, 91, 93
*A
71, 72, 73
*A
74, 75
*A
76, 77, 78
*A
98, 99
100, 101
120, 121
Pitch Bend
Control
Change
Program
Change
O
True #
System Exclusive
System
Common
System
Real Time
Aux
Messages
Notes
O
0127
****************
0127
*A,
*A, 1
*A
*A
0127
*2
Song Position
Song Select
Tune
Clock
*3
Commands
*3
Local On/Off
O (123127)
Active Sense
Reset
*A: Sent and received when MIDI Filters In and Out are set to Off in Global mode.
*1: LSB, MSB = 00,00: Pitch Bend range, =01,00: Fine Tune, =02,00: Course Tune.
*2: Includes Inquiry and Master Volume messages.
*3: Transmitted only when the Clock Send parameter (Global page 6) is set to Midi.
Mode 2:OMNI ON, MONO
Mode 4:OMNI OFF, MONO
O: Yes
X: No
230
Parameters
21. PARAMETERS
Control panel and operating modes parameters
ThefollowingtableshowstheparametersyoucansavetomemorywhenpressingtheWRITEbuttoninthevarious
operatingmodesandeditenvironments.
Page Parameter
Control Panel
Performance
Single Touch
Setting (STS)
Style
Performance
Global
Seq1+Seq2
Setup
Assignable Slider
(function)
Selected Mode
Memory
Bass Inversion
Manual Bass
Note
Split Point
Groove Quantize
Tempo Lock
Single Touch
Selected Style Number
General parameter
Keyboard Mode
Style Change
Perf./Program
Program Change
Octave Transpose
Master Transpose
Tempo
Display Hold
(A, B, C, D)
(A/B, C/D)
(A/B, C/D)
(A/B, C/D)
(C, D)
(C/D)
(C/D)
(C/D)
(A, B)
(A/B)
(A/B)
(A/B)
Program (Original/On)
Wrap Around
Keyboard Range (Original/Off)
Synchro Start/Stop
Fade In/Out
Style Element
(V1, V2, V3, V4, Fill 1/2,
Count In, Intro 1/2, Ending 1/2)
Ensemble On/Off
Chord Scanning
21
General parameters
Separate tracks
General parameters
Separate tracks
General parameters
Separate tracks
General parameters
Separate tracks
General parameters
Parameters
Page Parameter
Pad 14
Volume
22 Pan
C Send Level
D Send Level
Pad Lock
Scale Lock
23
Auto Octave Lock
Master Transpose Lock
Chord Recognition Mode
Scale Mode
24
Memory Mode
Velocity Control
Song Play Mode
Main Program
Play/Mute status
1
Volume
2
Pan
3
FX Send Level
FX Select (A, B, C, D)
4
Modulating Track
B>A (or D>C) Send
56 FX Parameters (A, B, C, D)
7
Track Mode
8
Track Internal/External
9
Jukebox
Link Mode
10 S2 FX Mode
Performance FX Mode
Song Mode
Song data
Global Edit Environment
Velocity Curve
Master Tune
Scale
1
Key
Speakers On/Off
Metronome Volume
Master Transpose on
Style/Realtime tracks
Seq 1/2
2
Midi In
Scale Transpose Position
Pedal/Switch Function
Assignable Slider Function
3
Damper Polarity
Footswitch Polarity
4
MIDI Setup Preset
Local On/Off
5
Clock
Clock Send
6
Midi In Channels (116)
Chord 1 Channel
Chord 2 Channel
7
Velocity Input
Upper Octave
Lower Octave
8
Octave Transp. on the Midi In
Mute In
9
Midi In Filters (18)
10 Midi Out Channels (116)
11
Midi Out Filters (18)
Card Edit Environment
Global Protect
Factory Styles Protect
Single Touch
Setting (STS)
Style
Performance
Performance
Seq1+Seq2
Setup
Global
Note
General parameters
Separate tracks
General parameters
Separate tracks
List saved to card
General parameters
Separate tracks
General parameters
General parameters
Set to On at startup
General parameters
Set to On at startup
Set to Int at startup
General parameters
Separate tracks
General parameters
231
232
Parameters
Header
Style
Tracks
Master Track
Header
Song
Tracks
Master Track
Programs(b)
Note On/Off
Pitch Bend
After Touch
Control Change(c)
Quarter Tone(a)
Quarter Tone Reset(a)
Chord Variation Length
Original Key/Chord
NTT
Expression
Keyboard Range
Chord Variation Table
Retrigger Mode
Tension
Play/Mute status(a)
Master Transpose(a)
Volume
Pan
FX Block(a)
FX Send
Detune
Scale(a)
Key
Note
Detune
Scale Yes/No(a)
Pitch Bend Range
Modulation Track(a)
Track Mode(a)
Internal/External Mode
Recognized chords
233
Major 6th
Major
3-note
T
2-note
2-note
4-note
T
Major 7th
4-note
3-note
2-note
T
T
Sus 2
Sus 4
3-note
2-note
3-note
3-note
2-note
T
T
Dominant 7th
4-note
T
T
T
T
T
4-note
4-note
T
Major 7th 5
Dominant 7th 5
3-note
T
T
234
Recognized chords
Minor
Minor 6th
3-note
2-note
4-note
Minor 7th
Minor-Major 7th
4-note
3-note
Diminished
3-note
4-note
3-note
4-note
T
T
Minor 7th 5
4-note
Augmented
3-note
T
T
No 3rd
2-note
Augmented 7th
4-note
T
No 3rd, no 5th
1-note
235
Error messages
General
Another Command Is Running (Press Exit)
Youcantexecuteacommanduntiltheonethatisrun
ningiscompleted.
Are you sure? (Enter/Exit)
Thisisaconfirmationrequestbeforemanyoperations.
PressENTER/YEStoconfirm,EXIT/NOtoabort.
Generic error
Someundefinederrorhashappened.
Record Aborted
ThereisnotenoughmemorytoentertheStyleRecord,
SongRecord,orBackingSequencerRecordmode.
Style Play
Corrupted Style Perform. Save It Again
microARRANGERwasnotabletocompletetheopera
tion.
Style Record
Arranger is Running! (Press Exit)
WhileinStyleRecordmode,thismessagemayappear
whenyoutrytoselectadifferenttrack,orexecutean
editoperation,whiletheArrangerisrunning.
Song Play
Cannot Load JBX File to Seq 2 (Press Exit)
YoucantloadaJukebox(JBX)filetoSequencer2.Juke
boxfilescanonlybeloadedtoSequencer1.
Juke Box List Empty! (Press Exit)
YouaretryingtostartplayingbackaJukeboxlist,but
thelistisempty.PleaseaddsomeSongstothelist.
Juke Box List Full! (Press Exit)
AJukeboxlistmaycontainupto127Songs.Youwere
tryingtoaddoneSongmore.
Save Song List: Insert Card and Press Enter
YouaresavingalistofSongs.Pleaseinsertacardand
pressENTER.
Save JBX List: Insert Card and Press Enter
YouaresavingalistofSongsasaJBXfile.Pleaseinsert
acardandpressENTER.
Wait Please
Youweretryingtoloadafile,whilemicroARRANGER
isstillloadinganotherone.
Song
Too Many Events
ThememorylimitforaSong(300KB)hasbeenreached.
Low memory!
Incompatible Meter
ThespaceintheSSD(thespacewhereUserStylesare
stored)isgoinglow.ExitRecord,thenloadsomebanks
ofsmallerStylesbeforeenteringRecordagain.
Youweretryingtocopyatrackonatrackwithadiffer
entmeter.
Sequencer is Running! (Press Exit)
WhileinSongRecordmode,thismessagemayappear
whenyoutry toselectadifferenttrack,orexecutean
editoperation,whiletheSequencerisrunning.
microARRANGERwasnotabletocompletetheCopy
operation.
Style Delete Failed (Press Exit)
microARRANGERwasnotabletocompletetheDelete
operation.
YoucanloadaJukeboxfileonlyonSequencer1.
microARRANGERwasnotabletocompletetheselec
tion.
TheStandardMIDIFileyouaretryingtoloadisdam
aged,andcannotbeplayedback.
236
YoutriedtodeleteaSonginanemptyJukeboxlist,or
tosaveanemptyJukeboxlist.
Jukebox list is full
TheJukeboxlistalreadycontains127Songs.
Theselectedmedium(card)isfull.Deletefilesyouare
not interested to keep, or replace the card with an
emptyone.Then,tryagain.
TheselectedfileisnotaStandardMIDIFile,andcan
not be played back. Select a .MID or .KAR file.
microARRANGERcanplaybackStandardMIDIFiles
in0and1format.
Standard Midi File format 2
YouhavetriedtoreadaFormat2StandardMIDIFile.
microARRANGER cant playthis kindof file.Select a
StandardMIDIFilesin0and1format.
Program
Overwrite Program? (Enter/Exit)
YouaretryingtostoreaProgramtoamemorylocation
alreadyoccupiedbyaProgram.PressENTERtoover
writeit,orEXITtoabort.
DuringaBackup,youinsertedacardcontainingsome
data. Please replace it with an empty one, or press
SHIFT+ENTERtostartformattingthecard.
Card write-protected
Thecardiswriteprotected.Movetheprotectiontabto
closethehole,andtryagain.Besuretherearentdata
you dont want to overwrite. Otherwise, replace the
cardwithanemptyone.
Erase Failed! (Press Exit)
Card mode
Cant Read Card! (Press Exit)
Thefileyouaretryingtoload,copy,eraseorrenameis
damaged,orhasanullsize(0kb),thuscantberead.
ThismessageduringaNewDiroperationmeansthere
are problems on the card. Try loading the file from a
differentcard.
Copy Failed! (Press Exit)
The.SETfileyoujustloadedincludedsomebanksof
FactoryStyles.SincetheFactoryStyleProtectflagwas
switchedon,FactoryStylebankswerenotloaded.(See
FactoryStyleProtectonpage142).
TheFastFormatprocedurefailed.PressENTERtogo
onwithaFullFormatprocedure(slower).
Thefileyouaretryingtocopyalreadyexistsontarget.
Youhavetriedtowriteoverareadonlyorsystemfile.
microARRANGER cant write over this kind of files.
Shouldyouneedtowriteoveroneofthesefile,usea
personalcomputertochangethefilesproperties,then
tryagain.Readyourcomputersusersmanual.
Youreachedthemaximumfoldernumberfortheroot
of the selected card. Delete some files, or replace the
card.
DuringaRenameorNewDiroperation,youweretry
ingtouseanexistingname.Useadifferentname.
Thefileyoutriedtodeleteisinusebyanotherproce
dure.Waitfortheproceduretobecompleted,thentry
again.
File is protected
237
Error messages
Thereisnomorespacetoload,saveorcopydata.The
card operation will be aborted. Replace the card, and
useanemptycardtosaveyourdata.Shouldthismes
sageappearduringloading,theSSD(SolidStateDisk)
basedinternalmemoryisfull.
Therearenoitemstorename.
Youweretryingtooverwriteaprotectedfile.
Youarewritingdataonanexisting.SETfolder,oron
afileoftype.MIDor.JBX.
Formattinghasbeensuccessfullycompleted.
PressENTER/YEStooverwritefilescarryingthesame
nameonthetargetdevice,orEXIT/NOtoavoidover
writinganyfile.
Formatoperationaborted.
PressENTER/YEStooverwritefilescarryingthesame
name on the target device (Press Exit)/NO to avoid
overwriting any file. File that are not yet on card are
alwayscopied.
ThenameisnotallowedonmicroARRANGER.
Insert an SD card and press Enter
Thecopyoperationwasnotpossible.Maybeyouwere
tryingtocopyafileoveritself,orcopyingnestedfold
ers.
Load Failed! (Press Exit)
Protectedfilescannotusuallybeoverwritten.Bypress
ingENTER,youcanoverwritethemduringthecurrent
operation.
Rename: Invalid Name (Press Exit)
You cant use the name you entered. Please retry and
selectadifferentname.
Rename: New Name Must Be a \".SET\
Youcantmodifya.SETfolderextension.
Rename Failed! (Press Exit)
TheLoadprocedurehasnotbeenexecuted.Tryagain,
ortrywithdifferentfiles.
ThismessagemayappearattheendofaRestoreopera
tion.SomeUserfilemaybemissing.Thisisnotaprob
lemfortheFactoryDataintegrity.
Eitherthereisnocardinthedrive,orthecardisunfor
matted. Insert a card, and try again, or press
SHIFT+ENTERtostartformattingthecard.
Not a Pa-series or Corrupted File
AnerroroccurredduringSave.Saveoperationaborted.
Youweretryingtoaccessastoragedevicenotavailable
onyourinstrument.
Unformatted medium
Youhaveselectedamedium(card)thatisnotyetfor
matted, or is in a format that microARRANGER cant
recognize.FormatthemediumusingtheFormatproce
dure(seePage5Formatonpage140).
Wait
microARRANGERisbusywithacardoperation.
238
TROUBLESHOOTING
Problem
Solution
Page
General problems
Power does not turn on
Make sure that (1) the power cable is plugged into the outlet, (2) the cable is plugged into the connector on
the back of the instrument, (3) and is not damaged, (4) there are no problems with the mains.
Is the power switch turned ON?
If the power still does not turn on, contact your dealer or the nearest KORG Service Center.
No sound
Is a jack connected to the HEADPHONES connector? This would disable the internal speakers.
22
22
Make sure that all the components of the amplifying system are turned on.
Are the MASTER VOLUME or ASSIGN.SLIDER sliders of the microARRANGER set to a position other than
0?
12
127
125
Is the Attack parameter value too high? Set it to a lower value, to let the sound start faster. Is the Volume
parameter too low? Set it to a higher value.
43
45
When the SPLIT button is lit up, the keyboard will be divided into the Lower part (low notes, below the split
point) and the Upper part (high notes, above the split point). Is the Lower track muted? Unmute it.
24
Wrong sounds
Do the USER banks contain modified data? Load the appropriate data for the Song or the Style you wish to
playback.
133
Has one of the USER Drum Kits been modified? Load the appropriate Drum Kits.
133
Have the Styles or Performances been modified? Load the appropriate data (Styles or Performances).
133
Make sure that the damper switch polarity parameter is set correctly.
126
Make sure that the Clock parameter is set to Int. If you are using the MIDI Clock of another device, you must
set the MIDI Clock parameter to MIDI, and make sure that the external device transmits MIDI Clock data.
127
22
Make sure that the external device is transmitting through MIDI channels enabled to receive in the microARRANGER.
47
79
Make sure that the MIDI IN Filters of the microARRANGER do not prevent the reception of messages.
129
Make sure that the Percussion and Drum Track is set to Drum Mode and the
external device has not transposition applied.
46
78
The selected Performance, Style or STS recalled the effect 15 Analog Record, simulating the noise of a old
vinyl recording.
130
140
130
130
131
Technical specifications
239
Operating System
KORG OPOS (Objective Portable Operating System). Multitasking, Load-While-Play feature. SSD (Solid
State Disk)-resident. Upgradable from SD card.
Display
Data storage
8MB (>20MB equivalent) Internal Solid State Disk (SSD), SD/MMC card slot.
Polyphony
Multitimbricity
Sound memory
Programs
662 (Single Oscillator, Double Oscillator), including a Stereo Piano and GM Level 2-compatible Programs.
33 Drum Kits, 128 User Programs, 64 User Drum Kits. Easy and Full Program Editing.
Effects
Performances
160 Realtime Performance memories. Up to 304 Styles Performances with 4 Single Touch Setting each.
Styles
Up to 304 Styles, Solid State Disk-resident, freely reconfigurable. 8 Style tracks, 4 Single Touch Settings
per-Style, 48 User Styles, programmable Style Performances and Single Touch Settings. Direct Card
reading feature. Compatible with old i-Series Styles. Style Record with Edit functions, Step Edit, Event
Edit.
Style controls
General controls
Master Volume, Ensemble, Octave Transpose, Master Transpose, Split Point, Style Change, Tracks Volume, Quarter of Tone, Assignable Slider, Joystick, Dial.
Pads
Song Play
Easy Record function. Full featured sequencer. 16 tracks. SMF native format.
Pedals
Realtime controllers
MIDI
Audio Inputs
Line impedance
Audio Outputs
2 Main (L/Mono, R)
Main Amplifier
2 5 Watt Amplifier
Speakers
2 10 cm speakers
Power Consumption
9 Watt
Dimensions (W x D x H)
Weight
Accessories
Options
XVP-10 (Exp/Volume Pedal), EXP-2 (Foot Controller),DS-1H (damper pedal), PS-1/PS-3 (Pedal switch)
*Specificationsandappearancearesubjecttochangewithoutnoticeforimprovement.
240
Alphabetical Index
Acc/SeqVolume10,12
AMS (Alternate Modulation
Source)
Resonance112
ArabicScale34
AssignableSlider126
Attack119
AttackLevel
AmpEG119
AttackTime
FilterEG116
AudioInputs11
AudioOutputs11
EditEnvironment21
Effects
Songmode95,97
SongPlaymode71,76
StylePlaymode43,44
Ending14
Ensemble48
Level
Program
B
Backing Sequence mode 30, 82
87
Backup9,141
Balance10,18,32
BankSelect37
BPM
MIDI/TempoSync.,LFO121
F
F1F4buttons16,19
Fade
LFO121
Fill14
Filter
CutoffFrequency113
FilterType112
LowPass&HighPass112
LowPassResonance112
Footswitch126
Polarity126
Format140
G
C
ChordRecognitionMode51
ChordScanning17
CutoffFrequency113
GeneralMIDI35
Global125129
Globalchannel35
GrooveQuantize71
Damper11,47
Polarity126
DecayTime
FilterEG116
Delay
LFO121
Demo11
DirectSD40
Disk130142
Backup141
Format140
Display1921
F1F4buttons16,19
Pagebuttons19
Volume/Valuebuttons15,19
DisplayHold16
DoubleSequencer31,70
Drummode78
Drumtracks46,99
Inputs11
Intro14
J
Joystick47
Jukebox74,79
K
KeyboardMode17
Keyboardsettings24
Trim112
LFO
Waveform,LFOwaveform
120
LocalOff37,127
Lock50
LowPass&HighPass112
LowPassResonance112
Lyrics73,74
M
MasterTranspose17,126
MasterTune125
MasterVolume10,12
Menu15
Messagewindow21
MIDI
Chordchannels128
Clock70,127
GeneralMIDI35
Globalchannel35
INchannels127
Interface22,37
OUTchannels129
SettingatrackforMIDI79,99
Setup36,126
StandardMIDIFile70,88
MIDIinterface22,37
MIDISetup36,126
Midifile35,70,88
Mode
BackingSequence8287
Program105124
SongPlay7081
StylePlay4051
Mute16,24
O
OctaveTranspose18
Offset
Offset,LFO121
OperatingModes12,20
OS(OperatingSystem)
Backup9,141
Update9
Outputs11
Alphabetical Index
P
Pads17,50
Lock50
Page15,19
Pedal126
Performance40
Selecting17,25
PitchBend44,97
Portamento
AMS123
Program
Editing45,98
Selecting17,25
ProgramChange37
Programmode105124
StyleChange25
StylePlaymode4051
Sync.
KeySync.,LFO121
MIDI/Tempo,LFO121
SynchroStart/Stop14
T
TapTempo15
Tempo40
Tempo/Valuesection16
TrackSelect16,73,74
Tracks
Drummode78
Drum/Percussion46,99
Keyboard/Realtime tracks 24,
40,70
R
Resonance112
S
Scale
Lock50
Mainscale125
Selectinginrealtime34
Select
MFXEffectSelect122
SelectingWindows21
Sequencer
Linkmode80
Selectingandswitching73
Sequencer173
Sequencer273
Sequencer2effectsmode80
Transportcontrols18
Shift16
SingleTouch13,16,26
SingleTouchSettings(STS)16
Selecting26
Song
Editing32
Playbackfromdisk28,31,74,
84,89
Recording30,82
Selecting74,84,89
StandardMIDIFile35
SongPlaymode7081
SpeakersOn/Off125
SplitPoint13,36
StandardMIDIFile35,70,88
Style
Ending14
Fill14
Intro14
Recording5269
Selecting13,26
StylePerformance40
Variation14
OctaveTranspose18
Programs17
Selecting15,24,73
Volume19,43
Transpose17,18
Tune
Tune,Program108
U
UserInterface20
EditEnvironments21
OperatingModes20
SelectingWindows21
V
VALUEslider
AMS123
Variation14
Velocity
AMS123
Velocity Intensity, Amp Mod.
118
Velocity,FilterEG114
VelocityCurve125
Volume
Acc/Seq10,12,71,88
Balance10
Individual tracks (Song Play)
76
Individualtracks(Song)95
Individual tracks (Style Play)
43
Master10,12,71,88
Volume/Valuesection15,19
W
Write15
Global125
StylePlaymode42
241